The Virginia Register OF
REGULATIONS is an official state publication issued every other week
throughout the year. Indexes are published quarterly, and are cumulative for
the year. The Virginia Register has several functions. The new and
amended sections of regulations, both as proposed and as finally adopted, are
required by law to be published in the Virginia Register. In addition,
the Virginia Register is a source of other information about state
government, including petitions for rulemaking, emergency regulations,
executive orders issued by the Governor, and notices of public hearings on
regulations.
ADOPTION,
AMENDMENT, AND REPEAL OF REGULATIONS
An
agency wishing to adopt, amend, or repeal regulations must first publish in the
Virginia Register a notice of intended regulatory action; a basis, purpose,
substance and issues statement; an economic impact analysis prepared by the
Department of Planning and Budget; the agency’s response to the economic impact
analysis; a summary; a notice giving the public an opportunity to comment on
the proposal; and the text of the proposed regulation.
Following
publication of the proposal in the Virginia Register, the promulgating agency
receives public comments for a minimum of 60 days. The Governor reviews the
proposed regulation to determine if it is necessary to protect the public
health, safety and welfare, and if it is clearly written and easily
understandable. If the Governor chooses to comment on the proposed regulation,
his comments must be transmitted to the agency and the Registrar no later than
15 days following the completion of the 60-day public comment period. The
Governor’s comments, if any, will be published in the Virginia Register.
Not less than 15 days following the completion of the 60-day public comment
period, the agency may adopt the proposed regulation.
The
Joint Commission on Administrative Rules (JCAR) or the appropriate standing
committee of each house of the General Assembly may meet during the
promulgation or final adoption process and file an objection with the Registrar
and the promulgating agency. The objection will be published in the Virginia
Register. Within 21 days after receipt by the agency of a legislative
objection, the agency shall file a response with the Registrar, the objecting
legislative body, and the Governor.
When
final action is taken, the agency again publishes the text of the regulation as
adopted, highlighting all changes made to the proposed regulation and
explaining any substantial changes made since publication of the proposal. A
30-day final adoption period begins upon final publication in the Virginia
Register.
The
Governor may review the final regulation during this time and, if he objects,
forward his objection to the Registrar and the agency. In addition to or in
lieu of filing a formal objection, the Governor may suspend the effective date
of a portion or all of a regulation until the end of the next regular General
Assembly session by issuing a directive signed by a majority of the members of
the appropriate legislative body and the Governor. The Governor’s objection or
suspension of the regulation, or both, will be published in the Virginia
Register. If the Governor finds that changes made to the proposed
regulation have substantial impact, he may require the agency to provide an
additional 30-day public comment period on the changes. Notice of the
additional public comment period required by the Governor will be published in
the Virginia Register.
The
agency shall suspend the regulatory process for 30 days when it receives
requests from 25 or more individuals to solicit additional public comment,
unless the agency determines that the changes have minor or inconsequential
impact.
A
regulation becomes effective at the conclusion of the 30-day final adoption
period, or at any other later date specified by the promulgating agency, unless
(i) a legislative objection has been filed, in which event the regulation,
unless withdrawn, becomes effective on the date specified, which shall be after
the expiration of the 21-day objection period; (ii) the Governor exercises his
authority to require the agency to provide for additional public comment, in
which event the regulation, unless withdrawn, becomes effective on the date
specified, which shall be after the expiration of the period for which the
Governor has provided for additional public comment; (iii) the Governor and the
General Assembly exercise their authority to suspend the effective date of a
regulation until the end of the next regular legislative session; or (iv) the
agency suspends the regulatory process, in which event the regulation, unless
withdrawn, becomes effective on the date specified, which shall be after the
expiration of the 30-day public comment period and no earlier than 15 days from
publication of the readopted action.
A
regulatory action may be withdrawn by the promulgating agency at any time
before the regulation becomes final.
FAST-TRACK
RULEMAKING PROCESS
Section
2.2-4012.1 of the Code of Virginia provides an exemption from certain
provisions of the Administrative Process Act for agency regulations deemed by
the Governor to be noncontroversial. To use this process, Governor's
concurrence is required and advance notice must be provided to certain
legislative committees. Fast-track regulations will become effective on the
date noted in the regulatory action if no objections to using the process are
filed in accordance with § 2.2-4012.1.
EMERGENCY
REGULATIONS
Pursuant
to § 2.2-4011 of the Code of Virginia, an agency, upon consultation
with the Attorney General, and at the discretion of the Governor, may adopt
emergency regulations that are necessitated by an emergency situation. An
agency may also adopt an emergency regulation when Virginia statutory law or
the appropriation act or federal law or federal regulation requires that a
regulation be effective in 280 days or less from its enactment. The emergency regulation becomes operative upon its
adoption and filing with the Registrar of Regulations, unless a later date is
specified. Emergency regulations are limited to no more than 18 months in
duration; however, may be extended for six months under certain circumstances
as provided for in § 2.2-4011 D. Emergency regulations are published as
soon as possible in the Register.
During
the time the emergency status is in effect, the agency may proceed with the
adoption of permanent regulations through the usual procedures. To begin
promulgating the replacement regulation, the agency must (i) file the Notice of
Intended Regulatory Action with the Registrar within 60 days of the effective
date of the emergency regulation and (ii) file the proposed regulation with the
Registrar within 180 days of the effective date of the emergency regulation. If
the agency chooses not to adopt the regulations, the emergency status ends when
the prescribed time limit expires.
STATEMENT
The
foregoing constitutes a generalized statement of the procedures to be followed.
For specific statutory language, it is suggested that Article 2 (§ 2.2-4006
et seq.) of Chapter 40 of Title 2.2 of the Code of Virginia be examined
carefully.
CITATION
TO THE VIRGINIA REGISTER
The Virginia
Register is cited by volume, issue, page number, and date. 34:8 VA.R.
763-832 December 11, 2017, refers to Volume 34, Issue 8, pages 763 through
832 of the Virginia Register issued on
December 11, 2017.
The
Virginia Register of Regulations is
published pursuant to Article 6 (§ 2.2-4031 et seq.) of Chapter 40 of Title 2.2
of the Code of Virginia.
Members
of the Virginia Code Commission: John
S. Edwards, Chair; James A. "Jay" Leftwich; Ryan T.
McDougle; Rita Davis; Leslie L. Lilley; E.M. Miller, Jr.; Thomas M.
Moncure, Jr.; Christopher R. Nolen; Charles S. Sharp; Samuel T. Towell; Mark J.
Vucci.
Staff
of the Virginia Register: Karen
Perrine, Registrar of Regulations; Anne Bloomsburg, Assistant
Registrar; Alexandra Stewart-Jonte, Regulations Analyst; Rhonda Dyer,
Publications Assistant; Terri Edwards, Senior Operations Staff
Assistant.
PUBLICATION SCHEDULE AND DEADLINES
Vol. 35 Iss. 1 - September 03, 2018
October 2018 through August 2019
Volume: Issue
|
Material Submitted By Noon*
|
Will Be Published On
|
35:3
|
September 12, 2018
|
October 1, 2018
|
35:4
|
September 26, 2018
|
October 15, 2018
|
35:5
|
October 10, 2018
|
October 29, 2018
|
35:6
|
October 24, 2018
|
November 12, 2018
|
35:7
|
November 7, 2018
|
November 26, 2018
|
35:8
|
November 19, 2018 (Monday)
|
December 10, 2018
|
35:9
|
December 5, 2018
|
December 24, 2018
|
35:10
|
December 14, 2018 (Friday)
|
January 7, 2019
|
35:11
|
January 2, 2019
|
January 21, 2019
|
35:12
|
January 16, 2019
|
February 4, 2019
|
35:13
|
January 30, 2019
|
February18, 2019
|
35:14
|
February 13, 2019
|
March 4, 2019
|
35:15
|
February 27, 2019
|
March 18, 2019
|
35:16
|
March 13, 2019
|
April 1, 2019
|
35:17
|
March 27, 2019
|
April 15, 2019
|
35:18
|
April 10, 2019
|
April 29, 2019
|
35:19
|
April 24, 2019
|
May 13, 2019
|
35:20
|
May 8, 2019
|
May 27, 2019
|
35:21
|
May 22, 2019
|
June 10, 2019
|
35:22
|
June 5, 2019
|
June 24, 2019
|
35:23
|
June 19, 2019
|
July 8, 2019
|
35:24
|
July 3, 2019
|
July 22, 2019
|
35:25
|
July 17, 2019
|
August 5, 2019
|
35:26
|
July 31, 2019
|
August 19, 2019
|
*Filing deadlines are Wednesdays
unless otherwise specified.
PETITIONS FOR RULEMAKING
Vol. 35 Iss. 1 - September 03, 2018
TITLE 18. PROFESSIONAL AND OCCUPATIONAL LICENSING
BOARD OF
FUNERAL DIRECTORS AND EMBALMERS
Initial
Agency Notice
Title of Regulation: 18VAC65-30. Regulations for Preneed
Funeral Planning.
Statutory Authority: § 54.1-2400 and Chapter 28 of Title 54.1 of the Code
of Virginia.
Name of Petitioner: Jessica Watkins.
Nature of Petitioner's Request: To amend regulations for preneed contracts to prevent
circumstances, such as the closure of a funeral establishment, that result in
the loss of funding for a family member's funeral.
Agency Plan for Disposition of
Request: The petition will be published on
September 3, 2018, in the Virginia Register of Regulations and posted on the
Virginia Regulatory Town Hall to receive public comment ending October 2, 2018.
The matter will be on the board's agenda for its first meeting after the
comment period, which is scheduled for October 16, 2018. The petitioner will be
informed of the board's decision after that meeting.
Public Comment Deadline: October 2, 2018.
Agency Contact: Corie Tillman Wolf, Executive Director, Department of
Health Professions, 9960 Mayland Drive, Suite 300, Richmond, VA 23233,
telephone (804) 367-4479, or email fanbd@dhp.virginia.gov.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-02; Filed August 6, 2018, 11:23 a.m.
REGULATIONS
Vol. 35 Iss. 1 - September 03, 2018
TITLE 1. ADMINISTRATION
COMMISSION ON LOCAL GOVERNMENT
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 1VAC50-20. Organization and
Regulations of Procedure (amending 1VAC50-20-5, 1VAC50-20-40, 1VAC50-20-50,
1VAC50-20-140, 1VAC50-20-142, 1VAC50-20-150, 1VAC50-20-180, 1VAC50-20-230,
1VAC50-20-270, 1VAC50-20-310, 1VAC50-20-350, 1VAC50-20-382, 1VAC50-20-384,
1VAC50-20-390, 1VAC50-20-540, 1VAC50-20-560, 1VAC50-20-570, 1VAC50-20-590,
1VAC50-20-605, 1VAC50-20-614, 1VAC50-20-620, 1VAC50-20-630).
Statutory Authority: § 15.2-2903 of the Code of
Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: David Conmy, Local Government Policy
Administrator, Department of Housing and Community Development, 600 East Main
Street, Suite 300, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 371-8010, FAX (804)
371-7090, or email david.conmy@dhcd.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 15.2-2903 of the Code of Virginia
authorizes the Commission on Local Government to promulgate regulations,
including rules of procedure for the conducting of hearings.
Purpose: All of the proposed amendments to the
regulations are minor in nature and include items such as (i) updating
definitions and regulations to correspond to changes in the Code of Virginia,
including removal of references to "Commonwealth Calendar" and
addition of the right to counsel in rulemaking proceedings (Chapter 795 of the
2012 Acts of Assembly), (ii) updating terminology to be gender-neutral, (iii)
generalizing the commission's regular meeting regulations to allow more meeting
flexibility but remaining consistent with § 15.2-2904 of the Code of Virginia,
and (iv) other minor changes. None of the proposed amendments to the
regulations are substantive in nature.
The regulations are essential to protect the health, safety,
and welfare of citizens because they support the commission's purpose to ensure
that all of the Commonwealth's "localities are maintained as viable
communities in which their citizens can live" (§ 15.2-2900 of the Code of
Virginia).
The goal of this action is to update the regulations for
greater clarity and consistency based upon a review by the commission and its
staff at the conclusion of the periodic review.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
rulemaking is expected to be noncontroversial because the proposed amendments
are minor in nature and include items such as (i) updating definitions and
regulations to correspond to changes in the Code of Virginia, including removal
of references to "Commonwealth Calendar" and adding the right to
counsel in rulemaking proceedings (Chapter 795 of the 2012 Acts of Assembly),
(ii) adding Oxford commas for greater clarity, (iii) updating terminology to be
gender-neutral, (iv) generalizing the commission's regular meeting regulations
to allow more meeting flexibility but remaining consistent with § 15.2-2904 of
the Code of Virginia, and (v) making other minor changes. None of the proposed
amendments to the regulations are substantive in nature, nor do they have an
impact on small businesses or individual citizens.
Furthermore, this rulemaking is expected to be noncontroversial
because no comments were received during the opportunity for public comment
period, which ran from June 12, 2017, to July 3, 2017, and was published in the
Virginia Register of Regulations on June 12, 2017 (Volume 33, Issue 21).
Substance: None of the proposed amendments to the
regulations are substantive in nature.
Issues: The advantages of the amendments to the
regulations are that they are all minor in nature but, overall, allow for
greater clarity and consistency with recent changes to the Code of Virginia,
which is advantageous for the public and the Commonwealth.
There are no anticipated disadvantages to the public or the
Commonwealth.
Small Business Impact Review Report of Findings: This
fast-track regulatory action serves as the report of the findings of the
regulatory review pursuant to § 2.2-4007.1 of the Code of Virginia.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. As the result
of a periodic review, the Commission on Local Government (Commission) proposes
to amend its public participation guidelines and its regulation that sets
procedure for the operation of the Commission. The Commission proposes many
clarifying and updating changes as well as one change to give the Commission
greater flexibility in the scheduling of public meetings.
Result of Analysis. Benefits likely outweigh costs for all proposed
changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. Many of the changes that are
proposed by the Commission in this action are meant to update regulatory
language to account for statutory changes and to make the language in these
regulations gender neutral. For instance, the Commission proposes to change
references to "the Commonwealth Calendar" to "a calendar
maintained by the Commonwealth" because that language more closely
resembles relevant statutory language. The Commission also proposes to change
references to "chairman" to "chair" because it is gender
neutral. Changes such as these do not add any extra requirements for regulated
entities. Consequently, no affected entities are likely to incur costs on
account of these changes. To the extent that these changes remove language that
is different from what is in statute, they provide the benefit of eliminating
possible confusion.
Current regulation requires that the Commission's meetings be
held in January, March, May, July, September and November each year. Relevant
statute, however, only mandates that the Commission meet at least six times
each year. In order to have greater flexibility in setting meetings, the
Commission now proposes to change this language so that meetings are held at
least once every two months without specifying when they will be held. As all
meetings will still be subject to notification requirements, no affected
entities are likely to incur costs or suffer any harm on account of this
change. The Commission will benefit from the additional flexibility that this
proposed change will provide.
Businesses and Entities Affected. This regulatory action will
affect all localities as well as the Commission. Commission staff reports that
there are there are 95 counties, 190 towns and 38 cities in the Commonwealth.
Localities Particularly Affected. No locality will be
particularly affected by this regulatory action.
Projected Impact on Employment. These proposed regulatory
changes are unlikely to affect employment in the Commonwealth.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. These
proposed regulatory changes are unlikely to affect the use or value of private
property in the Commonwealth.
Real Estate Development Costs. These proposed regulatory
changes are unlikely to affect real estate development costs in the
Commonwealth.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. No small businesses are likely to
incur any additional costs on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. No small
businesses are likely to incur any additional costs on account of these
proposed regulatory changes.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. No businesses are likely to incur any additional
costs on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Localities. Localities in the Commonwealth are unlikely to see
any adverse impacts on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Other Entities. No other entities are likely to be adversely
affected by these proposed changes.
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Commission on Local Government staff concurs with the economic impact analysis.
Summary:
The amendments include (i) permitting greater meeting
flexibility while remaining consistent with the Code of Virginia, (ii) updating
definitions and regulatory language to reflect the Code of Virginia, and (iii)
updating terminology to be gender-neutral.
1VAC50-20-5. Definitions.
The following words and terms when used in this regulation
chapter shall have the following meanings unless the context clearly
indicates otherwise:
"Chairman" "Chair" means
the Chairman Chair of the Commission on Local Government.
"Commission" means the Commission on Local
Government.
"County or counties" means one or more
than one a county in the Commonwealth of Virginia.
"Local government or local governments"
means one or more than one a county, city, or town in the
Commonwealth of Virginia.
"Locality or localities" means one or
more than one a county, city, or town in the Commonwealth of
Virginia.
"Municipality" means a city or town in the
Commonwealth of Virginia.
"Party or parties" means a local
government or local governments, voters, or property owners
initiating a proposed annexation, voters of any community requesting that their
community be incorporated as a town, voters petitioning for the transition of a
city to town status, or a committee appointed by the circuit court to act for
and in lieu of a local government to perfect a consolidation agreement.
1VAC50-20-40. Officers.
The commission shall elect from its membership at its regular
January meeting, or as soon thereafter as possible, a chairman chair
and a vice chairman chair, who shall serve terms of one year, or
until their successors are elected. In the event of a vacancy occurring in the
office of chairman chair or vice chairman chair,
for any cause, the commission shall fill the same by election for the unexpired
term. The chairman chair shall preside at all meetings,
presentations, and public hearings held by the commission unless absent. In the
absence of the chairman chair, the vice chairman chair
shall preside at any meeting or other assembly of the commission and shall
exercise all powers and duties of the chairman chair. In the
event that neither the chairman chair nor and
vice chairman chair is present are absent for a
meeting or other assembly of the commission, the remaining members of the
commission shall elect a temporary chairman chair who shall
exercise all powers and duties of the chairman chair for the
duration of the meeting or assembly.
1VAC50-20-50. Powers and duties of chairman chair.
In addition to any other powers or duties placed upon the chairman
chair by law, these regulations this chapter, or other
action of the commission, the chairman chair shall be authorized
to:
1. Request one or more members of the commission or its staff
to represent the commission before local governing bodies, before state
agencies and legislative committees, or before any other entity where the
representation of the commission is requested or where the chairman chair
deems appropriate;
2. Select or change sites for oral presentations and public
hearings;
3. Defer and reschedule issues the chairman chair
deems appropriate upon consultation with the commission;
4. Act on behalf of the commission in efforts to resolve
disputes between the parties to an issue relative to the production and sharing
of data, or with respect to related concerns bearing on the commission's review
of an issue; and
5. Establish upon consultation with the parties an equitable
distribution of time for public presentations and to make other arrangements
the chairman chair deems appropriate and consistent with the
requirements of law and these regulations this chapter for the
conduct of the commission's oral presentations and public hearings.
Part II
General Administration
1VAC50-20-140. Regular meetings.
The commission's regular meetings commission
shall be held in January, March, May, July, September, and November in
Richmond fix the time and place for holding regular meetings, which
shall be held at least once every two months. Changes in the schedule and
location of the regular meetings may be made by the commission, but the changes
shall be duly announced in the Virginia Register of Regulations published by
the Virginia Code Commission and posted on the Virginia Regulatory Town
Hall.
1VAC50-20-142. Special meetings.
Special meetings of the commission may be called by any
member on such occasions as may be reasonably necessary to carry out the duties
of the commission. Except in instances where a special meeting is scheduled at
a regular meeting, the chairman chair shall cause to be mailed -
including by electronic means - to all members, at least five days in
advance of a special meeting, a written notice specifying the time, place,
and purpose of the special meeting. Notice of special meetings shall be
announced appropriately on the Virginia Regulatory Town Hall and on a
calendar maintained by the Commonwealth Calendar.
1VAC50-20-150. Minutes of meetings and hearings.
Minutes shall be recorded for each public meeting held by the
commission. The minutes shall include a brief summary of comments on major
issues under consideration and concise and specific statements of all action
taken by the commission. The minutes shall be provided to each commission
member for reading and editing prior to approval at a subsequent commission
meeting. There need be no actual reading of the minutes at the meeting, but a
vote shall be taken for the formal approval of the minutes as written or
amended. Copies of the minutes of public meetings shall be made available to
any interested party at a price sufficient to cover the expense incurred or on
the Virginia Regulatory Town Hall and the commission's Internet website webpage.
Part III
Mandatory Commission Reviews
1VAC50-20-180. Notice to commission of proposed action as
required by § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia.
A. Notice of a proposed action as required by § 15.2-2907 of
the Code of Virginia to the commission shall be accompanied by resolution of
the governing body of the locality providing the notice evidencing its support
of such action. Notice to the commission shall indicate the name, title,
address, phone number, and, where available, fax number and email
address of the individual who shall serve as designated contact with the
commission regarding the issue presented. All notices required to be given the
commission under the provisions of § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia
shall also indicate the other local governments given notice of the proposed
action pursuant to subsection C of this section.
1. Notice of a proposed annexation initiated by voters or
property owners shall be accompanied by the original or certified petition
signed by 51% of the voters of any territory adjacent to any municipality or
51% of the owners of real estate in number and land area in a designated area.
Notice to the commission shall indicate the name, title, address, and phone
number, and, where available, fax number and email address of the
individual who shall serve as designated contact with the commission regarding
the issue presented. All notices required to be given to the commission under
the provisions of § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia shall also indicate
the other local governments given notice of the proposed action pursuant to
subsection C of this section.
2. Notice of a petition for the proposed transition of a city
to town status that has been referred to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-4102
of the Code of Virginia shall indicate the name, title, address, phone number,
and, where available, fax number and email address of the individual who shall
serve as designated contact with the commission regarding the issue referred.
All notices required to be given the commission under the provisions of
§ 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia shall also indicate the other local
governments given notice of the proposed action pursuant to subsection C of
this section.
3. Notice to the commission by a committee of citizens that
has been appointed by the circuit court to act for and in lieu of a governing
body to perfect a consolidation agreement pursuant to § 15.2-3531 of the
Code of Virginia shall indicate the name, title, address, phone number,
and, where available, fax number and email address of the individual who shall
serve as designated contact with the commission regarding the proposed
consolidation. All notices required to be given to the commission under the
provisions of § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia shall also indicate the
other local governments given notice of the proposed action pursuant to
subsection C of this section.
B. Any party giving notice to the commission of a proposed
action pursuant to § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia may submit with the
notice as much data, exhibits, documents, or other supporting materials as it
deems appropriate; however, the submissions should be fully responsive to all
relevant elements of the applicable section of Part IV (1VAC50-20-540 et seq.)
of this chapter.
C. Any party giving notice to the commission of a proposed
action as required by § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia shall also give
notice to each Virginia local government located within or contiguous to, or
sharing functions, revenue, or tax sources with the local government proposing
the action. All notices to the local governments shall include an annotated
listing of all documents, exhibits, and other material submitted to the
commission in support of the proposed action.
1. Any voters or property owners giving notice to the
commission of a proposed annexation as required by § 15.2-2907 of the Code
of Virginia shall also give notice to each Virginia local government located
within or contiguous to, or sharing functions, revenue, or tax sources with the
municipality to which annexation is sought. All notices to the immediately
affected local governments shall include copies of all documents, exhibits, and
other material submitted to the commission in support of the proposed action,
and notice to other localities may include, in lieu of copies of the
submissions, an annotated listing of the material.
2. Any voters whose petition for the proposed transition of a
city to town status that has been referred to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-4102
of the Code of Virginia shall also give notice to each Virginia local
government located within or contiguous to, or sharing functions, revenue, or
tax sources with the city proposed for town status. All notices to the
immediately affected local governments shall include copies of all documents,
exhibits, and other material submitted to the commission in support of the
proposed action, and notice to other localities may include, in lieu of copies
of the submissions, an annotated listing of the material.
3. A committee of citizens that has been appointed by the
circuit court to act for and in lieu of a governing body to perfect a
consolidation agreement pursuant to § 15.2-3531 of the Code of Virginia
shall also give notice to each Virginia local government located within or
contiguous to, or sharing functions, revenue, or tax sources with the local
governments that are proposed to be consolidated. All notices to the
immediately affected local governments shall include copies of all documents,
exhibits, and other material submitted to the commission in support of the
proposed action, and notice to other localities may include, in lieu of copies
of the submissions, an annotated listing of the material.
D. Any local government receiving notice pursuant to
subsection C of this section or any other affected party may submit data,
exhibits, documents, or other material for commission review and consideration
as it deems appropriate. The submissions should, however, be responsive to all
relevant elements of the applicable section of Part IV (1VAC50-20-540 et seq.)
of this chapter. Any party submitting material to the commission for review
pursuant to this section shall also designate an individual as principal
contact for the commission and shall furnish the individual's title, address,
phone number, and, where available, fax number and email address. An
annotated listing of all documents, exhibits, or other material submitted to
the commission pursuant to this section shall be provided to the party
initiating the proceeding before the commission. The commission may establish a
time by which all submissions by respondent parties must be received.
E. Upon its receipt of notice of a proposed action pursuant
to subsection A of this section, the commission shall, subsequent to discussion
with representatives of the party submitting the notice and other appropriate
parties, schedule a review of the proposed action. The commission shall also
concurrently extend the services of its office to the parties in an endeavor to
promote a negotiated settlement of the issue and, further, may designate, with
the agreement of the parties, an independent mediator to assist in the
negotiations.
The commission's review of a notice of a proposed annexation
as required by § 15.2-2907 of the Code of Virginia filed by voters or
property owners shall be terminated upon receipt of an ordinance, duly adopted
by a majority of the elected members of the governing body of the affected city
or town, rejecting the annexation proposed by the notice.
1VAC50-20-230. Referral to commission of proposed voluntary
settlement agreements.
A. Referral of a proposed voluntary settlement agreement to
the commission under the provisions of § 15.2-3400 of the Code of Virginia
shall be accompanied by resolutions, joint or separate, of the governing bodies
of the localities that are parties to the proposed agreement requesting the
commission to review the agreement. The resolution or resolutions shall
also state the intention of the governing bodies to adopt the agreement subsequent
to the commission's review and shall indicate the name, title, address, and
phone number, and, where available, fax number and email address of the
individual who shall serve as each locality's principal contact with the
commission during the period of its review. Referrals to the commission
pursuant to § 15.2-3400 of the Code of Virginia shall also be accompanied
by a listing of local governments receiving notice of the referral under
subsection C of this section.
B. Any party or parties referring a proposed voluntary
settlement agreement to the commission for review pursuant to § 15.2-3400 of
the Code of Virginia may submit with the proposed agreement as much data,
exhibits, documents, or other supporting materials as deemed appropriate; however,
the submissions should be fully responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-610.
C. Whenever a proposed voluntary settlement agreement is
referred to the commission for review pursuant to subsection A of this section,
the parties to the proposed agreement shall concurrently give notice of the
referral to each Virginia local government with which any of the parties is
contiguous, or with which any of the parties shares any function, revenue, or
tax source. All such notices of referral shall be accompanied by a copy of the
proposed voluntary settlement agreement, or a descriptive summary thereof, and
an annotated listing of all documents, exhibits, and other materials submitted
to the commission in support of the proposed agreement.
D. Any local government receiving notice of referral pursuant
to subsection C of this section, or any other party, may submit data, exhibits,
documents, or other supporting materials relevant to the commission's review as
it deems appropriate; however, the submissions should be responsive to all
relevant elements of 1VAC50-20-610. Any party submitting materials to the
commission pursuant to this chapter shall also designate an individual who
shall serve as principal contact with the commission during the period of its
review and shall furnish the individual's title, address, phone number,
and, where available, fax number and email address. The commission may
establish a time by which all submissions by respondent parties must be
received. Any party submitting materials to the commission pursuant to this
chapter shall also provide an annotated listing of the material to the parties
to the proposed voluntary settlement agreement.
1VAC50-20-270. Referral to commission of proposed town-county
agreement defining annexation rights.
A. Referral to the commission of a proposed town-county
agreement defining annexation rights pursuant to § 15.2-3231 of the Code of
Virginia shall be accompanied by resolutions, joint, or separate, of the
governing bodies of the town and county requesting the commission to review the
agreement. The resolution or resolutions shall also state the intention
of the governing bodies to adopt the agreement subsequent to the commission's
review and shall indicate the name, title, address, and phone number,
and, where available, fax number and email address of the individual who shall
serve as each locality's principal contact with the commission during the
period of its review. Referrals to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-3231
of the Code of Virginia shall also be accompanied by a listing of local
governments receiving notice of such referral under subsection C of this
section.
B. Any party or parties referring a proposed agreement
to the commission for review pursuant to § 15.2-3231 of the Code of
Virginia may submit with the proposed agreement as much data, exhibits,
documents, or other supporting materials as deemed appropriate; however,
submissions should be fully responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-560.
C. Whenever a proposed agreement is referred to the
commission for review pursuant to subsection A of this section, the parties to
the proposed agreement shall concurrently give notice of the referral to each
Virginia local government with which either party is contiguous or with which
either party shares any function, revenue, or tax source. All notices of
referral shall be accompanied by a copy of the proposed agreement, or a
descriptive summary thereof, and an annotated listing of all documents, exhibits,
and other materials submitted to the commission in support of the proposed
agreement.
D. Any local government receiving notice of referral pursuant
to subsection C of this section, or any other party, may submit data, exhibits,
documents, or other supporting materials relevant to the commission's review as
they deem appropriate; however, the submissions should be responsive to all
relevant elements of 1VAC50-20-560. Any party submitting materials to the
commission pursuant to these regulations this chapter shall also
designate an individual who shall serve as principal contact with the
commission during the period of its review, and shall furnish the
individual's title, address, phone number, and, where available, fax
number and email address. The commission may establish a time by which all
submissions by respondent parties must be received. Any party submitting
materials to the commission pursuant to this chapter shall also provide an
annotated listing of the material to the parties to the proposed agreement.
1VAC50-20-310. Referral to commission of town petition for
order establishing annexation rights.
A. Any town unable to reach an agreement with its county as
to future annexation rights may, pursuant to § 15.2-3234 of the Code of
Virginia, adopt an ordinance petitioning the commission for an order
establishing its rights to annex territory in such county. The petition to the
commission shall include the terms of a proposed order establishing the town's
annexation rights and shall indicate the name, title, address, and phone
number, and, where available, fax number and email address of the individual
who shall serve as the town's principal contact with the commission. Petitions
to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-3234 of the Code of Virginia shall also be
accompanied by a copy of the ordinance and by a listing of all local
governments being served or receiving notice of the town's petition pursuant to
subsection C of this section.
B. Any town petitioning the commission under the authority of
§ 15.2-3234 of the Code of Virginia may submit with the petition as much data,
exhibits, documents, or other supporting materials as deemed appropriate;
however, the submissions should be fully responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-616.
C. Any town petitioning for an order establishing its
annexation rights under the authority of § 15.2-3234 of the Code of
Virginia shall serve a copy of the petition and ordinance on the Commonwealth's
attorney, or the county attorney if there be one, and on the chairman of the
board of supervisors of the county whose territory would be affected by the
town's proposed annexation order. The town shall also give notice of its
petition to all other towns located within the affected county and to each
Virginia local government adjoining such county. The service in the county and
the notice to other localities shall be accompanied by an annotated listing of
all materials submitted to the commission pursuant to subsection B of this
section.
D. A county served with a copy of a town's petition pursuant
to subsection C of this section shall file its response to such petition with
the commission within 60 days after receipt of the service. Any other party
receiving notice pursuant to subsection C of this section, may also submit materials
to the commission for consideration with respect to the town's petition within
60 days of their receipt of the notice. Responses and submissions to the
commission pursuant to this chapter may include data, exhibits, documents, or
other materials as the submitting party deems appropriate; however, such
responses and submissions should be responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-616. Any party submitting materials to the commission for review
pursuant to this chapter shall also designate an individual who shall serve as
principal contact with the commission, and shall furnish the
individual's title, address, phone number, and, where available, fax
number and email address. Any party submitting materials to the commission
pursuant to this chapter shall also provide an annotated listing of the
material to the town petitioning the commission.
1VAC50-20-350. Referral to commission of boundary line
adjustment.
A. Whenever a court refers a proposed boundary line
adjustment to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-3109 of the Code of Virginia,
the localities proposing the boundary line adjustment shall, upon receipt of
notification of the referral, provide the commission with a copy of their
petition to the court and shall designate an individual for each locality who
shall serve as principal contact with the commission and shall furnish the
individual's title, address, phone number, and, where available, fax
number and email address. Referrals to the commission pursuant to § 15.2-3109
of the Code of Virginia shall also be accompanied by a listing of local
governments receiving notice of the referral under subsection C of this
section.
B. The two localities proposing a boundary line adjustment
pursuant to § 15.2-3109 of the Code of Virginia may, jointly or independently,
submit to the commission with their petition as much data, exhibits, documents,
or other supporting materials as they deem appropriate; however, such
submissions should be fully responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-600.
C. Whenever a proposed boundary line adjustment is referred
to the commission for review pursuant to § 15.2-3109 of the Code of
Virginia, the localities proposing the adjustment shall concurrently give
notice of the proposed adjustment as well as notice of the referral of the
issue to the commission to each Virginia local government with which either
party is contiguous and to any other Virginia local government deemed by the
localities proposing the adjustment to be potentially affected by the proposed
adjustment. The notice shall include a copy of the petition requesting the
boundary line adjustment, or an informative summary thereof, and an annotated
listing of all documents, exhibits, and other materials submitted to the
commission for review pursuant to subsection B of this section.
D. Any local government receiving notice of a proposed
boundary line adjustment pursuant to subsection C of this section, or any other
party, may submit data, exhibits, documents, or other supporting materials
relevant to the commission's review as they deem appropriate; however, such
submissions should be responsive to all relevant elements of 1VAC50-20-600. Any
party submitting materials to the commission pursuant to this chapter shall
also designate an individual who shall serve as principal contact with the
commission during the period of its review, and shall furnish the
individual's title, address, phone number, and, where available, fax
number and email address. The commission may establish a time by which all
submissions by respondent parties must be received. Any party submitting
materials to the commission pursuant to this chapter shall also provide an
annotated listing of the materials to the localities proposing the boundary
line adjustment.
1VAC50-20-382. Referral to commission of proposed economic
growth-sharing agreements.
A. Referral of a proposed economic growth-sharing agreement
to the commission under the provisions of § 15.2-1301 of the Code of
Virginia shall be accompanied by resolution, joint or separate, of the governing
bodies of the localities that are parties to the proposed agreement requesting
the commission to review the agreement. The resolution or resolutions
shall also state the intention of the governing bodies to adopt the agreement
subsequent to the commission's review and shall indicate the name, title,
address, and phone number, and, where available, fax number and
email address of the individual who shall serve as each locality's principal
contact with the commission during the period of its review. Referrals to the
commission pursuant to § 15.2-1301 of the Code of Virginia shall also be
accompanied by a listing of local governments receiving notice of the referral
under subsection C of this section.
B. Any party or parties referring a proposed economic
growth-sharing agreement to the commission for review pursuant to § 15.2-1301
of the Code of Virginia may submit with the proposed agreement as much data,
exhibits, documents, or other supporting materials as deemed appropriate;
however, the submissions should be fully responsive to all relevant elements of
1VAC50-20-612.
C. Whenever a proposed economic growth-sharing agreement is
referred to the commission for review pursuant to subsection A of this section,
the parties to the proposed agreement shall concurrently give notice of the
referral to each Virginia local government with which any of the parties is
contiguous, or with which any of the parties shares any function, revenue, or
tax source. All notices of referral shall be accompanied by a copy of the
proposed agreement, or a descriptive summary thereof, and an annotated listing
of all documents, exhibits, and other materials submitted to the commission in
support of the proposed agreement.
D. Any local government receiving notice of referral pursuant
to subsection C of this section, or any other party, may submit data, exhibits,
documents, or other supporting materials relevant to the commission's review as
it deems appropriate; however, the submissions should be responsive to all
relevant elements of 1VAC50-20-612. Any party submitting materials to the
commission pursuant to this chapter shall also designate an individual who
shall serve as principal contact with the commission during the period of its
review, and shall furnish the individual's title, address, phone number,
and, where available, fax number and email address. Any party submitting
materials to the commission pursuant to this chapter shall also provide an
annotated listing of the material to the parties to the proposed agreement.
1VAC50-20-384. Determination of continued eligibility for city
status.
A. The commission shall review each decennial census of
population released by the United States Bureau of the Census to determine
whether any city has failed to meet the criteria for city status established by
Article VII, Section 1 of the Constitution of Virginia. In any instance where
the census indicates that a city may not meet the constitutional criteria, the
commission shall conduct an investigation of the city's population, assets,
liabilities, rights, and obligations and shall certify its findings to
the governing body of such city.
B. In the conduct of its investigation, the commission shall
request the assistance of the city in the provision of relevant data and
information. The city may submit as much data, exhibits, documents, or
other material as it deems appropriate; however, the submissions should be
responsive to all relevant elements of 1VAC50-20-614.
1VAC50-20-390. General provisions applicable to mandatory
commission reviews.
A. Any local government or other party appearing before the
commission relative to any mandatory review may be represented by counsel.
B. The commission shall generally schedule for consideration
issues in the order in which received; however, the commission reserves the
right to consider issues in other sequence where it deems appropriate. Where
notices are received of related or competitive actions affecting the same locality
or localities, the commission may, where appropriate, consider the issues
and render the reports or a consolidated report concurrently.
C. Subsequent to its receipt of an issue for a mandatory
review the commission shall meet, or otherwise converse, with representatives
of the principally affected parties for purposes of establishing a schedule for
its review of the issue. The schedule shall include dates (i) for the
submission of responsive materials from affected jurisdictions, (ii) for tours
of affected areas and oral presentations if any are desired by the commission,
(iii) for a public hearing, and (iv) for the issuance of the commission's
report, as well as other dates the commission deems appropriate.
D. The commission may continue or defer its proceedings with
respect to an issue at any time it deems appropriate; however, no continuance
or deferral shall result in an extension of the commission's reporting deadline
beyond any time limit imposed by law, except by agreement of the parties or in
accordance with other statutory procedures. The commission shall also accept
requests for continuances or deferrals from any party at any time during its proceedings
but shall not grant or deny any such requests until all parties have had an
opportunity to comment on the requests. In any instance where the commission
grants a continuance or a deferral, the continuance or deferral may be
conditioned upon an appropriate extension of the commission's reporting
deadline with respect to the issue under review.
E. The commission may confront the necessity of continuing or
deferring its proceedings as a result of statutory requirement or court order.
In such instances, the commission shall reschedule its proceedings, upon
consultation with the parties, in a manner that permits an expeditious
conclusion of its review. The parties should anticipate, however, that the
duration of the continuance or stay shall result in a commensurate delay in the
issuance of the commission's report.
F. In addition to any meeting, presentation, public hearing,
or other gathering of the parties specified by this chapter, the commission
may, where it deems necessary for an analysis of material or for a discussion
or clarification of the issues before it, schedule other meetings of
appropriate parties.
G. No party or parties to a proceeding before the
commission for mandatory review shall communicate in any manner with any member
of the commission with respect to the merits of the issue under review except
as is authorized by this chapter, or as may be otherwise authorized by the
commission or its chairman chair.
H. In addition to the submissions authorized by 1VAC50-20-180
through 1VAC50-20-384, the commission may allow supplemental submissions deemed
necessary or appropriate by the commission for the provision of current and
complete data. Where supplemental submissions are authorized pursuant to this
subsection, copies of all submissions shall be provided by the submitting party
to all principal parties. The commission shall endeavor to establish dates for
the filing of all supplemental submissions which will allow an opportunity for
their review and critical analysis by other affected parties. However, the
commission may accept supplemental submissions filed after any established
dates if, in the commission's judgment, the submissions assist the commission
in the discharge of its statutory responsibilities.
I. Any material submitted to the commission by the parties in
conjunction with or relative to any notice filed pursuant to any mandatory
review covered by 1VAC50-20-180 through 1VAC50-20-384, except materials presented
in the context of negotiations or mediation of a confidential nature as
authorized by law, shall be considered public documents and made available by
the submitting party for review by any other interested party or by the public.
Any interested party or member of the public may request copies of any such
material which shall be provided promptly by the party submitting the material
to the commission at a price sufficient to cover the expense incurred.
J. Each document, exhibit, or other material submitted to the
commission shall bear a title, the date of preparation, a detailed citation of
the sources from which all data are obtained, and the name of the entity which
submitted the document, exhibit, or other material. All material submitted to the
commission by a local government shall be, as nearly as practicable, in the
same form as the material would subsequently be submitted to the courts. The
commission may refuse to accept for review and consideration any exhibit,
document, or other material unless the person preparing it, or a representative
of the entity responsible for its submission, shall be willing to appear before
the commission for purposes of answering questions concerning the material.
K. Unless otherwise requested, wherever the regulations of
the commission call for the projection of data, the projections should be made
for a 10-year period. In each instance where projections are given, the method
and bases of the projections should be indicated.
L. All data, exhibits, documents, or other material submitted
to the commission on the initiative of a party or pursuant to a request from
the commission shall be certified by the submitting party (i) as to source and
(ii) as to the fact that the material is correct within the knowledge of the
submitting party.
M. Any party or parties filing notice or making
submissions to the commission shall provide at least eight copies of all
submissions, unless the commission agrees that a lesser number would be
sufficient for its review and analysis. The commission may make provisions for
the electronic filing of submissions, including facsimile.
N. At any time during the course of the commission's review
of any issue, the commission's staff may solicit additional data, documents,
records, or other materials from the parties as is deemed necessary for proper
analysis of any issue. Where such materials are solicited from a party, the
commission's staff, where practicable, shall make the request in writing, with
copies of the request being provided to other principal parties. Copies of all
materials submitted to the commission pursuant to this chapter shall
concurrently be provided to each principal party, or shall be made
available to the parties in a manner acceptable to the commission. The
commission shall be given written notification by the submitting party of each
principal party provided a copy of the material or of arrangements proposed for
making the material available to the principal parties.
O. The commission shall not be limited in its analysis of any
issue to the materials submitted by the parties but shall undertake independent
research as it deems appropriate in order to assure a full and complete
investigation of each issue.
P. The commission shall request all parties to cooperate
fully in the development and timely sharing of data relative to the issue under
review. The commission considers the cooperation among parties vital to the
discharge of its responsibilities.
Q. The commission may allow the parties to correct the data,
exhibits, documents, or other material submitted to the commission prior to the
date established for the closing of the record pursuant to 1VAC50-20-640 B.
Where corrections are authorized pursuant to this chapter, copies of all
corrections shall be provided by the submitting party to all principal parties.
If, in the commission's judgment, the corrections are of a substantive nature
as to significantly alter the scope or character of the issue under review, the
commission may delay its proceedings for an appropriate amount of time to
provide an opportunity for other parties to respond to the corrected data,
exhibits, documents, or other material.
R. Following the receipt of a notice, the commission may
request the party initiating the proposed action to prepare and file testimony
in support of the proposed action. The testimony of the party initiating the
proposed action may refer to all data, exhibits, documents, or other material
previously submitted to the commission or filed with the testimony. In all
proceedings in which the initiating party files testimony, the affected party or
parties shall be permitted and may be requested by the commission to file,
on or before a date established by the commission, testimony in response to the
proposed action. The testimony of the affected party or parties may
refer to all data, exhibits, documents, or other material previously submitted
to the commission or filed with the testimony. Any affected party or parties
that who chooses not to file testimony by the date established by
the commission may not thereafter present testimony except by permission of the
commission, but may otherwise fully participate in the proceeding and engage
only in cross-examination of the testimony of other parties. Failure to comply
with the directions of the commission, without good cause shown, may result in
rejection of the testimony by the commission. The commission may permit the
parties to correct or supplement any prepared testimony before or during the
oral presentations as called for in 1VAC50-20-620. Eight copies of prepared
testimony shall be filed unless otherwise specified by the commission.
Part IV
Information, Data, and Factors Relative to Mandatory Commission Reviews
1VAC50-20-540. Annexation.
In developing its findings of fact and recommendations with
respect to a proposed annexation, the commission shall consider the
information, data, and factors listed in this section. Any city or town filing
notice with the commission that it proposes to annex territory shall submit
with the notice data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in
this section that it deems relevant to the proposed annexation. Any voters or
property owners filing notice pursuant to § 15.2-2907 of the Code of
Virginia with the commission seeking annexation to a municipality shall submit
with the notice data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in
this section that they deem relevant to the proposed annexation, except that
subdivision 1 of this section is required to be included in the notice filed
with the commission.
1. A written metes and bounds description of the boundaries of
the area proposed for annexation having, as a minimum, sufficient certainty to
enable a layman to identify the proposed new boundary. The description may make
reference to readily identifiable monuments such as public roads, rivers,
streams, railroad rights of way, and similar discernible physical features.
2. A map or maps showing (i) the boundaries of the area
proposed for annexation and their geographic relationship to existing political
boundaries; (ii) identifiable unincorporated communities,; (iii)
major streets, highways, schools, and other major public facilities,;
(iv) significant geographic features, including mountains and bodies of water;
(v) existing uses of the land, including residential, commercial, industrial,
and agricultural; and (vi) information deemed relevant as to the possible
future use of the property within the area sought for annexation.
3. A land-use table showing both the acreage and percentage of
land currently devoted to the various categories of land use in the
municipality, the county, and the area proposed for annexation.
4. The past, the estimated current, and the projected
population of the municipality, the county affected by the proposed annexation,
and the area of the county proposed for annexation.
5. The past, the estimated current, and the projected future
number of public school students enrolled in the public schools and the number
of school-age children living in the municipality, the county affected by the
proposed annexation, and the area of the county proposed for annexation.
6. The assessed property values, by major classification, and
if appropriate, the ratios of assessed values to true values for real property,
personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, and public service
corporation property for the current year and the preceding 10 years for the
municipality, and the county affected by the proposed annexation, and
similar data for the current year for the area of the county proposed for
annexation.
7. The current local property and nonproperty tax rates and
the tax rates for the preceding 10 years, applicable within the municipality,
the county affected by the proposed annexation, and the area of the county
proposed for annexation.
8. The estimated current local revenue collections and
intergovernmental aid, the collections and aid for the previous 10 years, and
projections of the collections and aid (including tax receipts from real
property, personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, business
and professional license, consumer utility, and sales taxes) within the
municipality, and the county affected by the proposed annexation, and similar
data for the past year for the area of the county proposed for annexation.
9. The amount of long-term indebtedness and the purposes for
which all long-term debt has been incurred by the municipality and the county
affected by the proposed annexation.
10. The need in the area proposed for annexation for urban
services, including but not limited to those listed below in
this subdivision, the level of services provided by the municipality and by
the county affected by the proposed annexation, and the ability of the
municipality and the county to provide the services in the area proposed for
annexation:
a. Sewage treatment;
b. Water;
c. Solid waste collection and disposal;
d. Public planning;
e. Subdivision regulation and zoning;
f. Crime prevention and detection;
g. Fire prevention and protection;
h. Public recreational facilities;
i. Library facilities;
j. Curbs, gutters, and sidewalks;
k. Storm drains;
l. Street lighting;
m. Snow removal;
n. Street maintenance;
o. Schools;
p. Housing; and
q. Public transportation.
11. Efforts made by the municipality and the county affected
by the proposed annexation to comply with applicable state policies with
respect to environmental protection, public planning, education, public
transportation, housing, and other state service policies promulgated by the
General Assembly.
12. The community of interest which (i) may exist between the
municipality and the area proposed for annexation and its citizens and which
(ii) may exist between that area and its citizens and the rest of the county;
the term "community of interest" may include, but not be limited
to, consideration of natural neighborhoods, natural and manmade boundaries,
the similarity of service needs, and economic and social bonds.
13. Any arbitrary prior refusal to cooperate by the governing
body of the municipality or of the county affected by the proposed annexation,
if such has occurred, to enter into cooperative agreements providing for joint
activities which that would have benefited citizens of both
localities.
14. The need for the municipality to expand its tax resources,
including its real estate and personal property tax base.
15. The need of the municipality to obtain land for
industrial, commercial, and residential development.
16. The adverse effect on the county affected by the proposed
annexation resulting from the loss of areas suitable and developable for
industrial, commercial, or residential use.
17. The adverse effect on the county of the loss of tax
resources and public facilities necessary to provide services to those persons
in the remaining areas of the county after the proposed annexation.
18. The adverse impact of the proposed annexation on
agricultural operations located in the area proposed for annexation.
19. The terms and conditions upon which the municipality
proposes to annex, its plans for the improvement of the annexed territory
during the 10-year period following annexation, including the extension of
public utilities and other services, and the means by which the municipality
shall finance the improvements and extension of services.
20. Data pertinent to a determination of the appropriate
financial settlement between the municipality and the affected county as
required by § 15.2-3211 of the Code of Virginia and other applicable provisions
of the Code of Virginia.
21. The commission's staff shall endeavor to assist parties
contemplating or involved in annexation proceedings by identifying additional
data elements considered by the commission to be relevant in the disposition of
annexation issues.
1VAC50-20-560. Town-county agreements defining annexation
rights.
In developing its findings of fact and recommendations with
respect to a proposed town-county annexation agreement, the commission shall
consider the information, data, and factors listed in this section. Any town or
county presenting proposed annexation agreements to the commission under the
provisions of § 15.2-3231 of the Code of Virginia shall submit with the
proposed agreement data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in
this section that it deems relevant.
1. A written metes and bounds description of those areas of
the county made eligible for annexation under the proposed agreement having as
a minimum, sufficient certainty to enable a layman to identify those areas. The
description may make reference to readily identifiable monuments such as public
roads, rivers, streams, railroad rights of way, and similar discernible
physical features.
2. A map or maps showing: (i) the boundaries of
the various areas eligible for annexation under the proposed agreement and
their relationship to existing political boundaries; (ii) identifiable
unincorporated communities; (iii) major streets, highways, schools, and other
major public facilities; (iv) significant geographic features, including
mountains and bodies of water; (v) existing uses of the land, including
residential, commercial, industrial, and agricultural; and (vi)
information deemed relevant as to the possible future use of the property in
the areas affected by the proposed agreement.
3. A land-use table showing both the acreage and percentage of
land currently devoted to the various categories of land use in the town, the
county, and the areas of the county affected by the agreement.
4. The past, the estimated current, and the projected
population of the town, the county, and those areas of the county affected by
the proposed agreement.
5. The past, the estimated current, and the projected number
of public school students enrolled in the public schools and the number of
school-age children living in the town, the county, and those areas of the
county affected by the proposed agreement.
6. The assessed property values, by major classification and,
if appropriate, the ratios of assessed values to true values for real property,
personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, and public service
corporation property for the current and preceding 10 years for the town, and
the county, and similar data for the current year in those areas of the county
affected by the proposed agreement.
7. The need of the municipality to expand its tax resources,
including its real estate and personal property tax base.
8. The need of the municipality to obtain land for industrial,
commercial, and residential development.
9. The current and prospective need for additional urban
services in the areas of its county subject to annexation under the agreement.
10. Plans for the immediate and future improvement of areas
annexed under the terms of the agreement, including the extension of public
utilities and other services.
11. The commission's staff shall endeavor to assist localities
contemplating or involved in town-county agreements defining annexation rights
by identifying additional data elements considered by the commission to be
relevant in the disposition of the issues.
1VAC50-20-570. Town incorporation.
In developing its findings of fact and recommendations with
respect to a proposed town incorporation, the commission shall consider the
information, data, and factors listed in this section. Any party or parties
Parties filing notice with the commission that they propose to have a
community incorporated as a town, or whose petition for incorporation has been
referred to the commission by the court pursuant to § 15.2-3601 of the
Code of Virginia, shall submit with such notice or subsequent to the court
referral data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in this
section that they deem relevant to the proposed incorporation.
1. A petition signed by not less fewer than 100
duly qualified voters residing within the boundaries of the proposed town
supporting the proposed incorporation.
2. A written metes and bounds description of the area proposed
for incorporation as a town having, as a minimum, sufficient certainty to
enable a layman to identify the proposed town boundary. The description may
make reference to readily identifiable monuments such as public roads, rivers,
streams, railroad rights of way, and similar discernible physical features.
3. A map or maps showing: (i) the boundaries of
the proposed town and their relationship to existing political boundaries; (ii)
identifiable unincorporated communities; (iii) major streets, highways,
schools, and other major public facilities; (iv) significant geographic
features, including mountains and bodies of water; and (v) existing uses of the
land, including residential, commercial, industrial, and agricultural.
4. A land-use table showing both the acreage and percentage of
land currently devoted to the various categories of land use in the area
proposed for incorporation.
5. The estimated past, the estimated current, and the
projected population of the area proposed for incorporation and the county
within which the town would be situated.
6. Information indicating: (i) why the proposed
incorporation is desired and in the interest of the inhabitants; (ii) how the
general good of the community is served by the incorporation; and (iii) why the
services needed within the proposed town cannot be provided by the
establishment of a sanitary district, through the extension of existing county
services, or by other arrangements provided by law.
7. The commission shall endeavor to assist communities
contemplating or involved in proposed town incorporations by identifying
additional data elements considered by the commission to be relevant in the
disposition of incorporation issues.
1VAC50-20-590. County-city transitions.
In developing its findings of fact and recommendations with
respect to a proposed county to city transition, the commission shall consider
the information, data, and factors listed in this section. Any county filing
notice with the commission that it proposes to become a city shall submit with
the notice data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in this
section that it deems relevant to the proposed transition.
1. A map, or maps, showing: (i) the location of
all towns situated within the county; (ii) all adjoining and adjacent
localities; (iii) identifiable unincorporated communities within the county;
(iv) the population density of the various areas of the county; (v) the areas
of the county served by urban services; (vi) major streets, highways, schools,
and other major public facilities; (vii) significant geographic features,
including mountains and bodies of water; (viii) existing uses of the land,
including residential, commercial, industrial, and agricultural; and (ix)
information deemed relevant as to the possible future use of the property
within the county.
2. A land-use table showing both the acreage and percentage of
land currently devoted to the various categories of land use in the county.
3. The past, the estimated current, and the projected future
population of the county, each town within the county, and of the major densely
populated unincorporated communities within the county.
4. The past, the estimated current, and the projected future
number of public school students enrolled in the public schools and the number
of school-age children living in the county and in each town therein within
the county.
5. The assessed values, by major classification and if
appropriate, the ratios of assessed values to true values for real property,
personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, and public service
corporation property for the current year and the preceding 10 years for the
county and each town within the county.
6. The current local property and nonproperty tax rates, and
the tax rates for the preceding 10 years, within the county and all towns
within the county.
7. The estimated current local revenue collections and
intergovernmental aid, the collections and aid for the previous 10 years, and
projections of the collections and aid (including tax receipts from real
property, personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, business
and professional license, consumer utility, and sales taxes) within the
county and within each town within the county.
8. The amount of long-term indebtedness of the county and each
town within the county and the amount and purpose for which that debt has been
incurred.
9. Data regarding: (i) the urban-type services
presently provided by the county; (ii) the level of those services; (iii) the
areas of the county served by those services; (iv) the additional services to
be provided and the additional cost to be borne by the proposed city; and (v) the
means by which the proposed city shall finance the additional services and
costs.
10. The fiscal capacity of the county to function as an
independent city and to provide appropriate services.
11. The impact of the proposed transition on compliance with
and the promotion of applicable state policies with respect to environmental
protection, public planning, education, public transportation, housing, and
other state service policies declared by the General Assembly.
12. The commission's staff shall endeavor to assist localities
contemplating or involved in proposed county-city transitions by identifying
additional data elements considered by the commission to be relevant in the
disposition of county to city transition issues.
1VAC50-20-605. County-city consolidations.
In developing its findings of fact and recommendations with
respect to a proposed consolidation of a county and a city that would establish
an independent city, the commission shall consider the information, data, and
factors listed in this section. Local governments filing notice proposing the
consolidation of a city and a county to establish an independent city, or any
committee of citizens that has been appointed by the circuit court to act for
and in lieu of a governing body to perfect a consolidation agreement pursuant
to § 15.2-3531 of the Code of Virginia shall, separately or jointly, submit to
the commission data and other evidence responsive to each element listed in
this section that they deem relevant to the proposed consolidation.
1. Copy of the consolidation agreement.
2. A map or maps showing (i) the location of all
municipalities situated within the proposed consolidated city; (ii) all
adjoining and adjacent localities; (iii) identifiable unincorporated
communities within the proposed consolidated city; (iv) major streets,
highways, schools, and other major public facilities; (v) significant
geographic features, including mountains and bodies of water; (vi) existing
uses of the land, including residential, commercial, industrial, and
agricultural; and (vii) information deemed relevant as to the possible future
use of the property within the proposed consolidated city and as to its future
viability.
3. The past, the estimated current, and the projected
population of each locality proposing to consolidate.
4. The population density of the proposed consolidated city
based on the most recent U.S. United States decennial census or
as estimated by the Weldon Cooper Center for Public Service at the University
of Virginia.
5. A land-use table showing both the acreage and percentage of
land currently devoted to the various categories of land use in the proposed
consolidated city.
6. The estimated current and a five-year projection of the
future number of public school students enrolled in the public schools in each
locality proposing to consolidate and the number of school-age children living
in the proposed consolidated city.
7. The assessed values, by major classification for real
property, personal property, machinery and tools, merchants' capital, and
public service corporation property for the current year and the preceding 10
years for the county and the city proposing to consolidate and the proposed
consolidated city.
8. The estimated local property and nonproperty tax rates that
will be applicable within the proposed consolidated city.
9. The estimated local revenue collections including, but
not limited to, tax receipts from real property, personal property,
machinery and tools, merchants' capital, business and professional license,
consumer utility, and sales taxes and intergovernmental aid, such
collections and aid for the preceding 10 years, and projections of the
collections and aid within each of the localities proposing to consolidate.
10. The amount of long-term indebtedness of each of the
localities proposing to consolidate and the amount and purpose for which that
debt has been incurred.
11. Data regarding: (i) the urban-type services
presently provided by each of the localities proposing to consolidate, (ii) the
level of those services to be provided in the proposed consolidated city, (iii)
the additional services to be provided and the additional cost to be borne by
the proposed consolidated city, and (iv) the means by which the proposed
consolidated city shall finance the additional services and costs.
12. The fiscal capacity of the proposed consolidated city to
function as an independent city and to provide appropriate services.
13. The impact of the proposed consolidation on compliance
with and the promotion of applicable state policies with respect to
environmental protection, public planning, education, public transportation,
housing, and other state service policies declared by the General Assembly.
14. The impact of the proposed consolidation on the interest
of the Commonwealth in promoting strong and viable units of government in the
area.
15. The commission's staff shall endeavor to assist the
parties involved in proceedings for the consolidation of a county and a city
that would establish an independent city by identifying additional data
elements considered by the commission to be relevant in the disposition of
city-county consolidation issues.
1VAC50-20-614. Determination of continued eligibility for city
status.
In undertaking its investigation with respect to whether a
city continues to meet the requirements for city status as prescribed by
Article VII, Section 1 of the Constitution of Virginia, the commission shall
consider the information and data listed in this section. Any city subject to
investigation as prescribed by Chapter 40 (§ 15.2-4000 et seq.) of Title
15.2 of the Code of Virginia shall be requested to submit information and data
responsive to each element listed in this section and any other information and
data as the city deems relevant to the continued eligibility for city status.
1. Any official correspondence with the United States Bureau
of the Census regarding the accuracy of the most recent United States decennial
census of the population of the city under investigation.
2. Any data or other evidence produced by the city under
investigation or any other entity bearing on the accuracy of the most recent
United States decennial census of the population of the city under
investigation.
3. Any data or other evidence produced by the city under
investigation or any other entity indicating the current population and
projected future population of the city under investigation.
4. Contingent upon the commission's findings with respect to
the population of the city under investigation, a listing of all of the city's
assets, liabilities, rights, and obligations.
5. The commission's staff shall endeavor to assist the city
under investigation by identifying additional data elements considered by the
commission to be relevant to the continued eligibility for city status.
Part V
Formal Commission Reviews
1VAC50-20-620. Oral presentations by parties.
A. In the course of its analysis of any issue the commission
may schedule oral presentations for purposes of permitting the parties to
amplify their submissions, to critique and to offer comment upon the
submissions and evidence offered by other parties, and to respond to questions
relative to the issue from the commission. The presentations, if scheduled,
shall extend for a period of time as the commission may deem appropriate.
B. If oral presentations are scheduled by the commission, the
chairman chair shall select, subsequent to the receipt of
recommendations from the parties, an appropriate site for the presentations.
Recommendations by the parties regarding the sites should be based upon the
adequacy of space for the display and movement of exhibits; the adequacy of
seating arrangements for the commission, its staff, representatives of the
parties, a court reporter, and the public; the adequacy of security at the site
to permit materials to be left unattended during recesses; and the adequacy of
the acoustical characteristics of the site to facilitate communications or the
availability of a public address system.
C. Local governments or other parties desiring to present
exhibits or data requiring special equipment should be prepared to provide
such.
D. The commission may, where it deems appropriate,
consolidate two or more interlocal issues before it for purpose of oral
presentations.
E. The commission shall, within the requirements of law,
conduct the oral presentations in the manner it considers best suited for
reaching a decision in the best interest of the parties and in the best
interest of the Commonwealth.
F. The chairman chair, or other member the
commission designated to preside during any oral presentations, may allocate
time to the various parties as the chairman chair or presiding
member deems appropriate. The allocation of time shall be based upon the needs
of the commission to review data, to examine witnesses, and to obtain an
understanding of the relevant factors affecting the issue under review.
G. The sequence in which testimony will be received by the
commission during any oral presentations shall be established by the chairman
chair or presiding member but shall generally be as follows:
1. A brief opening statement by each party, if desired;
2. Presentation by the party initiating the issue before the
commission;
3. Presentations by the local governments immediately affected
by the action proposed by the initiating party, in an order established by the chairman
chair or presiding member;
4. Presentations by other parties, in an order established by
the chairman chair or presiding member;
5. Rebuttal where requested by a party and agreed to by the chairman
chair or presiding member.
H. The chairman chair or presiding member may,
to the extent he the chair or presiding member deems appropriate,
permit parties to question witnesses regarding submissions, their testimony, or
other facts relevant to the issues before the commission. Where a party is
represented by counsel, such questioning may be conducted by counsel.
Where the parties have prefiled testimony at the commission's
request pursuant to 1VAC50-20-390 R, the questioning of individuals whose
testimony has been prefiled shall be limited to a cross-examination of such
testimony. The commission may accept additional oral testimony from individuals
whose testimony has been prefiled during the presentations where good cause is
shown. Where additional oral testimony is accepted by the commission, the
commission shall provide an opportunity for other parties to respond to the
testimony and to cross-examine the individual offering such testimony.
I. The chairman chair or presiding member may,
during or at the conclusion of the oral presentations, permit or request oral
argument on the issues before the commission.
J. The commission, and its staff, may question any witness or
representative of any party during the oral presentations regarding any
submission, testimony, or other fact which the commission considers relevant to
the issues before it. The chairman chair or presiding member
shall endeavor to call for commission questioning in a manner designed to
expedite the presentations.
K. The commission may accept depositions from persons unable
to attend an oral presentation. Depositions shall only be accepted under
conditions deemed acceptable by the commission, including conditions assuring
an opportunity for all affected local governments to be present and to examine
adequately the witness during the taking of depositions.
L. The parties or their counsel shall be expected to confer
in advance of the time and date set for presentations in order to inform one
another of their prospective witnesses and the order of their anticipated
appearance. All material, data, or exhibits proposed for presentation to the
commission during the oral presentations and not previously made available to
the other parties shall be exchanged or made available to the parties prior to
presentation to the commission, subject to the qualifications in subsection M
of this section.
M. The commission requires that all materials, data, and
exhibits be presented to it and made available to other parties in advance of
the commencement of the onsite component of the commission's review. The
commission may accept additional materials, data, and exhibits during the
onsite component of its review upon unanimous consent of the members present.
Where late submissions are accepted by the commission, the commission shall
provide an opportunity for other parties to respond to the filings.
N. The commission may record by mechanical device, unless
other recording arrangements are made by the parties, all testimony given
during the oral presentations but shall prepare a transcript of the recording
only when deemed appropriate. The commission shall provide, upon request, any
party a duplicate copy of the transcript or recording, if made, at a price
sufficient to cover the expense incurred. In lieu of recording by the
commission, the parties may arrange to provide a court reporter at their
expense. Where a court reporter is utilized, the commission shall receive one
copy of the transcript.
1VAC50-20-630. Public hearing.
A. In all cases where a public hearing is required by law,
the commission shall conduct the public hearing at which any interested person
or party may testify. The commission shall generally schedule the public hearing
in conjunction with the oral presentations held, if any, with respect to the
issue; however, public hearings regarding proposed town incorporations required
pursuant to § 15.2-3601 of the Code of Virginia shall be held no sooner than 30
days after receipt of the court request for commission review.
B. Prior to holding the public hearing the commission shall
publish notice of the pending hearing as required by law.
In addition to the notice of public hearing required by this
subsection, a town that is a party to an agreement defining annexation rights
negotiated pursuant to § 15.2-3231 of the Code of Virginia shall give
written notice of the commission's hearing at least 10 days before the hearing
to the owner, owners, or their agent of each parcel of land
included in the area proposed for annexation under the terms of the agreement.
One notice sent by first-class mail to the last known address of the owner,
owners, or their agent as shown on the current county real estate tax
assessment books or current county real estate tax assessment records shall be
deemed adequate compliance with this requirement, provided that the clerk of
the town shall make an affidavit that the mailings have been made and file the
affidavit with the commission.
C. The commission shall request the party initiating the
issue before it and the other principally affected parties to place on public
display in or adjacent to the office of the chief administrative officer of
each principally affected local government copies of all materials which are
available to them and which have been submitted to the commission for
consideration with respect to the issue. The material should be made
conveniently available to the public during normal working hours. The
commission also encourages the parties to make available to the public other
copies of the material at libraries, educational facilities, or other public
places in order that the public might have ample opportunity to study the
material prior to the public hearing. The commission's advertisements published
under subsection B of this section shall announce the availability of the
material at the offices of the administrators and at other facilities as may be
selected by the parties for display purposes.
D. The commission shall request the chief administrative
officer (or other official) of each jurisdiction or jurisdictions
principally affected by the issue before the commission to make suitable
arrangements in or adjacent to their offices for the registration of speakers
at the public hearing. The commission shall furnish appropriate registration
forms for that purpose. The commission's advertisements under subsection B of
this section shall advise the public that registration to speak at the public
hearing may be accomplished at the offices of the local administrators or,
alternatively, through the offices of the commission in Richmond. The
commission may also permit speakers to register at the site and at the time of
the public hearing and shall request the assistance of the local administrative
officers in making suitable arrangements for such registration.
E. The chairman chair or other member of the
commission designated to preside over the proceedings shall select the site for
the public hearing subsequent to the receipt of recommendations from the
parties. Recommendations from the parties should be based upon a site's
accessibility to residents of the areas and jurisdictions principally affected,
its seating capacity, the adequacy of parking facilities, the availability of a
public address system, and seating arrangements permitting the commission to
have proper visual contact with the public.
F. The commission shall request the parties to cooperate in
the preparation of the site for the public hearing and shall request that a minimum
number of maps and exhibits be placed on display at the site in order that
persons testifying may identify their residences, property, businesses, or
other concerns in relation to the proposed issue.
G. The commission shall request the local jurisdiction within
which the site for the public hearing is situated to make appropriate
arrangements in order to assure the security and the orderliness of the
proceedings.
H. The chairman chair or the presiding member
shall determine the sequence of speakers at a public hearing, but the sequence
shall ordinarily conform to the sequence of their registration. The chairman
chair or presiding member may, however, vary the sequence of speakers in
order that persons from all affected jurisdictions and areas, and those
representing different perspectives, might have equal opportunity for the
timely presentation of their comments.
I. The commission shall endeavor to allow any person or party
wishing to speak at a public hearing an opportunity to do so. The chairman
chair or presiding member may establish time limits for the presentation
of testimony as he the chair or presiding member deems
appropriate. The chairman chair or presiding member may also rule
testimony irrelevant, immaterial, or unduly repetitious. Proponents and
opponents of a proposed action are encouraged to designate a chief
spokesman for economy of time and for the avoidance of repetitious comment.
J. Any person or party testifying before the commission at
the public hearing may extend their remarks in written form for subsequent
submission. During the course of the public hearing, the commission
shall establish a date by which the extended written comment must be received
for consideration.
K. The commission may record by mechanical device, unless
other arrangements are made, all testimony given during the public hearing but
shall prepare a transcript of the recording only when it deems appropriate. The
commission shall provide any person or party with a copy of the transcript or
recording, if made, at a price sufficient to cover the expense incurred. The
parties may arrange to provide a court reporter, at their expense. Where a
court reporter is utilized, the commission shall receive one copy of the
transcript.
L. The commission may, where it deems appropriate,
consolidate two or more interlocal issues for purposes of a public hearing.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5291; Filed August 9, 2018, 9:37 a.m.
TITLE 3. ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGES
ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGE CONTROL AUTHORITY
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 3VAC5-10. Procedural Rules for
the Conduct of Hearings before the Board and its Hearing Officers (amending 3VAC5-10-160).
Statutory Authority: §§ 4.1-103 and 4.1-111 of the
Code of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 22, 2018.
Agency Contact: LaTonya D. Hucks, Legal Liaison,
Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control, 2901 Hermitage Road, Richmond, VA
23220, telephone (804) 213-4698, FAX (804) 213-4574, or email
latonya.hucks@abc.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 4.1-101 of the Code of Virginia
establishes the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority and the Board of
Directors of the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority.
Section 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia enumerates the powers
of the board, which include the authority to adopt regulations and to do all
acts necessary or advisable to carry out the purposes of Title 4.1 of the Code
of Virginia. Subdivision 7 of § 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia permits board
to delegate or assign any duty or task to be performed by the authority to any
officer or employee of the authority. Subdivision 24 of § 4.1-103 permits the
board to promulgate regulations in accordance with the Administrative Process
Act and § 4.1-111 of the Code of Virginia.
Section 4.1-111 A provides the board with the authority to
adopt reasonable regulations that it deems necessary to carry out the
provisions of Title 4.1 and to amend or repeal such regulations.
Purpose: As the Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
transitions into an authority, it was necessary to make amendments to the
regulations dealing with procedural rules of the conduct of hearings before the
board and hearings officers to make the process more efficient and not
overburden the new part-time board. Approvals that were once subject to board
approval have been delegated to the chief hearing officer. Additionally,
extending the time in which an offer can be submitted is an effort to decrease
the number of hearings and appeals and foster more resolutions through
settlement.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: The
amendments favor licensees and simplify the offer in the compromise process
while extending the time that the licensee has to make an offer in compromise.
Substance: Approvals once subject to board approval have
been delegated to the chief hearing officer thereby accommodating the new
part-time board while not hampering the process for licensees. Also, extending
the time in which offers can be made increases the likelihood that the matter
will be resolved without further hearings or appeals.
Issues: The primary advantage is that the amendment will
make the process for offers in compromise more efficient by allowing the board
to delegate the responsibility of approving the offer instead of having to wait
for board approval, which could delay the settlement as the board will meet
much less frequently under the authority. There are no disadvantages to the
agency or the Commonwealth. Pertinent matters to the regulated community,
government officials, and the public are that offers in compromise will not
always have oversight from the board; however, they will be delegated to chief
hearing officer who may have more intimate knowledge of the case and the
significance of the settlement terms.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The Alcoholic
Beverage Control Board (Board) proposes to: 1) direct that offers in compromise
be addressed to the chief hearing officer, 2) no longer require Board approval
for acceptance of offers in compromise, 3) remove the limit on the number of
offers in compromise that licensees may make, and 4) allow licensees more time
to present an offer in compromise.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. Following notice of a disciplinary
proceeding, a licensee may be afforded opportunity for the submission of an
offer in compromise in lieu of suspension or in addition thereto, or in lieu of
revocation of his license. The current regulation specifies that such an offer
be summited to the secretary of the Board and be subject to Board approval.
As of January 15, 2018, the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control
Authority (ABCA) became successor in interest to the Department of Alcoholic
Beverage Control and the Alcoholic Beverage Control Board.1 ABCA
consists of the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Board of Directors
(Authority Board), the Chief Executive Officer, and the agents and employees of
the Authority.
Members of the Board prior to the establishment of ABCA worked
full time. Positions on the Authority Board are considered part time; the
Authority Board meets much less frequently than the Board has historically.
Consequently, the Board proposes to amend the regulation to specify that offers
in compromise be submitted to the chief hearing officer, and acceptance is not
subject to Board (or Authority Board) approval. The proposal to have offers in
compromise be submitted to the chief hearing officer and to allow the chief
hearing officer to approve such offers without waiting for Board approval would
help prevent significant delays. This would be beneficial for regulated entities
and the public.
The current regulation limits licensees to two offers of
compromise. The Board proposes to remove this limitation and extend the
timeframe within which licensees may submit offers in compromise. Since these
proposed changes are potentially beneficial for affected licenses, and do not
produce significant cost for ABCA, they would likely produce a net benefit.
Businesses and Entities Affected. All 13,000+ licensees could
potentially be subject to disciplinary proceedings, and thus could be affected
by the proposed amendments.2 ABCA issues: licenses for
manufacturers, wholesalers and shippers of alcoholic beverages; retail licenses
for the sale of alcohol at restaurants, hotels, convenience stores, grocery
stores, etc.; and banquet licenses to allow persons or groups to host events
such as wedding receptions, tastings or fundraisers, where alcohol is served in
an unlicensed location or club premise.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendments do
not disproportionately affect particular localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed amendments do not
significantly affect employment.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The proposed
amendments do not significantly affect the use and value of private property.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendments do not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendments do not
significantly affect costs for small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendments do not adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
other entities.
____________________________
1See Virginia Code § 4.1-101 B
2Data source: Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority concurs with the Department of
Planning and Budget's economic impact analysis.
Summary:
The amendments (i) require that offers in compromise be
addressed to the chief hearing officer, (ii) remove the board approval
requirement for acceptance of offers, (iii) remove the limit on the number of
offers that licensees may make, and (iv) extend the time in which an offer can
be made.
3VAC5-10-160. Offers in compromise.
Following notice of a disciplinary proceeding, a
licensee may be afforded opportunity for the submission of an offer in
compromise in lieu of suspension or in addition thereto, or in lieu of
revocation of his license, where in the discretion of the board, the nature of
the proceeding and the public interest permit. Such offer should be addressed
to the secretary to the board chief hearing officer. Upon
approval by the board, acceptance Acceptance of the offer in
compromise shall constitute an admission of the alleged violation of the A.B.C.
laws or regulations, and shall result in a waiver of the right to a formal
hearing and the right to appeal or otherwise contest the charges. The reason
for the acceptance of such an offer shall be made a part of the record of the
proceeding. Unless good cause be shown, continuances for purposes of
considering an offer in compromise will not be granted, nor will a decision
be rendered prior to a hearing if received within three days of the
scheduled hearing date, nor will more than two offers be entertained during the
proceeding. Further, no offers shall be considered by the board if received
more than 15 calendar days after the date of mailing of the initial decision or
the proposed decision, whichever is later. An offer may be made at the
appeal hearing, but none shall be considered after the conclusion of such
hearing. Offers in compromise may be submitted anytime following notice
of a disciplinary proceeding and before the conclusion of an appeal hearing.
Any such offer may not be accepted at the informal conference and no offer
shall be submitted after the conclusion of the appeal hearing. The board
may waive any provision of this section for good cause shown.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5363; Filed August 9, 2018, 8:31 a.m.
TITLE 3. ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGES
ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGE CONTROL AUTHORITY
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 3VAC5-10. Procedural Rules for
the Conduct of Hearings before the Board and its Hearing Officers (amending 3VAC5-10-220).
Statutory Authority: §§ 4.1-103 and 4.1-111 of the Code
of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 22, 2018.
Agency Contact: LaTonya D. Hucks, Legal Liaison,
Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control, 2901 Hermitage Road, Richmond, VA
23220, telephone (804) 213-4698, FAX (804) 213-4574, or email latonya.hucks@abc.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 4.1-101 of the Code of Virginia
establishes the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority and the Board of
Directors of the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority.
Section 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia enumerates the powers
of the board, which include the authority to adopt regulations and to do all
acts necessary or advisable to carry out the purposes of Title 4.1 of the Code
of Virginia. Subdivision 7 of § 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia permits the
board to delegate or assign any duty or task to be performed by the authority
to any officer or employee of the authority. Subdivision 24 of § 4.1-103
permits the board to promulgate regulations in accordance with the
Administrative Process Act and § 4.1-111 of the Code of Virginia.
Section 4.1-111 A authorizes the board to adopt reasonable
regulations that it deems necessary to carry out the provisions of Title 4.1
and to amend or repeal such regulations.
Purpose: The purpose of this regulatory action is to
clarify that the authority has the ability, including through alternate dispute
resolution options, to agree to license suspensions or revocations prior to a
formal hearing and to update a citation to the Code of Virginia. The advantage
to the public welfare is that the change to the regulation corrects an
out-of-date reference to the Code of Virginia and ensures that the public is
receiving up-to-date guidance.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: The
regulatory action updates the Code of Virginia reference and provides clarity
that the authority has the ability, including through alternate dispute
resolution options, to agree to license suspensions or revocations prior to a
formal hearing.
Substance: The changes update a citation to the Code of
Virginia, remove the requirement that license suspension or revocation be
preceded by a formal hearing, and remove the language referencing an offer of
settlement. The amendments also provide that any initial decision will include
a summary of the informal conference.
Issues: The primary advantage to this regulatory action
is that it corrects the statutory reference and provides additional clarity on
the powers of the authority. There are no disadvantages to the agency or the
Commonwealth. Pertinent matters to the regulated community, government
officials, and the public are that the most up to date references to the Code
of Virginia will be included in the regulation and there will not be any
confusion to the powers of the authority as it relates to informal conferences.
Department of Planning and
Budget's Economic Impact Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The Alcoholic
Beverage Control Board (Board) proposes to: 1) update a citation to the Code of
Virginia, 2) remove obsolete language, and 3) amend language for improved
clarity.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. The regulation states that an
"informal conference will be conducted when an applicant for a license or a
licensee who is the subject of a disciplinary proceeding does not waive its
right to such a conference." Section 220 of the regulation further
describes attributes and requirements related to informal conferences.
The Board proposes amendments that would update a Code of
Virginia citation, eliminate obsolete language, and change text to improve
clarity. None of the proposed amendments change requirements in practice;
nevertheless, the proposals would be beneficial in that they may reduce the
likelihood of misunderstandings among readers of the regulation.
Businesses and Entities Affected. All 13,000+ licensees could
potentially be subject to disciplinary proceedings, and thus could be affected
by the proposed amendments.1 ABC issues: licenses for manufacturers,
wholesalers and shippers of alcoholic beverages; retail licenses for the sale
of alcohol at restaurants, hotels, convenience stores, grocery stores, etc.;
and banquet licenses to allow persons or groups to host events such as wedding
receptions, tastings or fundraisers, where alcohol is served in an unlicensed
location or club premise.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendments do
not disproportionately affect particular localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed amendments do not
affect employment.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The proposed
amendments do not affect the use and value of private property.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendments do not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendments do not affect
costs for small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendments do not adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
other entities.
_____________________________________
1Data source: Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority concurs with the Department of
Planning and Budget's economic impact analysis.
Summary:
The amendments (i) clarify that an agreement for license
suspension or revocation may be made prior to a formal hearing, (ii) provide
that any initial decision include a summary of the informal conference, and (iii)
update citations to the Code of Virginia.
3VAC5-10-220. Informal conferences.
A. An informal conference will be conducted when an applicant
for a license or a licensee who is the subject of a disciplinary proceeding
does not waive its right to such a conference. A waiver may be verbal or in
writing. Unless the parties are advised otherwise, the agency will
automatically waive the informal conference when the applicant or licensee does
so. When the applicant or licensee is offered an informal conference and fails
to respond within 10 calendar days after the date of such offer, the informal
conference will be deemed to be waived.
B. The informal conference will be conducted for the reasons
set forth in § 9-6.14:11 2.2-4019 of the Code of Virginia;
however, inasmuch as the Code of Virginia continues to require that license
suspension or revocation be preceded by a formal hearing (see § 4.1-227 of the
Code of Virginia), the. The informal conference may not be used for
purposes of agreement fixing a period of suspension or license revocation,
although an offer of settlement shall be received for board consideration.
The informal conference will serve as a vehicle to acquaint the interested
party, in a general way, with the nature of the charges or objections, the
evidence in support thereof and to hear any matters relevant thereto presented
by the interested parties and to explore whether (i) administrative proceedings
or objections should be terminated or (ii) the case should proceed to formal
hearing and stipulations can be reached. The conference will be open to the
public, but participation will be limited to the interested parties, their
attorneys-at-law or other qualified representatives, and designated board
representatives. The conference will be held, when practical, at the county or
city in which the establishment of the applicant or licensee is located.
Reasonable notice of administrative charges or objections and the date, time
and place of the conference shall be given to the participants. The failure of
the applicant or licensee to appear at a scheduled conference will be deemed a
waiver of the informal conference. The informal proceeding will not be
recorded. Sworn testimony will not be taken, nor will subpoenas be issued. At
the conclusion of the informal conference, the designated board representative
will complete a disposition form to be included in the case file or will
announce the results at the beginning of the formal hearing to be included in
the record. Any initial decision will include a summary of the informal
conference.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5364; Filed August 9, 2018, 8:29 a.m.
TITLE 3. ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGES
ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGE CONTROL AUTHORITY
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 3VAC5-10. Procedural Rules for
the Conduct of Hearings before the Board and its Hearing Officers (amending 3VAC5-10-290).
Statutory Authority: §§ 4.1-103 and 4.1-111 of the Code
of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 22, 2018.
Agency Contact: LaTonya D. Hucks, Legal Liaison,
Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control, 2901 Hermitage Road, Richmond, VA
23220, telephone (804) 213-4698, FAX (804) 213-4574, or email
latonya.hucks@abc.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 4.1-101 of the Code of Virginia
establishes the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority and the Board of
Directors of the Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority.
Section 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia enumerates the powers
of the board, which include the authority to adopt regulations and to do all
acts necessary or advisable to carry out the purposes of Title 4.1 of the Code
of Virginia. Subdivision 7 of § 4.1-103 of the Code of Virginia permits the
board to delegate or assign any duty or task to be performed by the authority
to any officer or employee of the authority. Subdivision 24 of § 4.1-103
permits the board to promulgate regulations in accordance with the
Administrative Process Act and § 4.1-111 of the Code of Virginia.
Section 4.1-111 A authorizes the board to adopt reasonable
regulations that it deems necessary to carry out the provisions of Title 4.1
and to amend or repeal such regulations.
Purpose: The purpose of this action is to accommodate
the new part-time board. As the Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
transitions into an authority, it was necessary to make amendments to the
regulations dealing with procedural rules to make the process more efficient
and not overburden the new part-time board. Previously the appeal panel
consisted solely of members of the board, but with the transition to an
authority and the switch from a full-time board to a part-time board, the
appeal panel may consist of board members or other officers or employees. As
such, the regulation needed to be changed to reflect the possibility that there
may or may not be a board member on the appeal panel.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: The
amendments are expected to be noncontroversial because the licensees'
responsibilities are not changed, and there is no monetary impact.
Substance: Additional evidence may be introduced at an
appeal hearing upon unanimous consent of the appeal panel.
Issues: The primary advantage to the amendment is that
it contemplates the possibility that an appeal panel may not consist solely of
board members (a likely scenario given the new part-time board) and allows the
introduction of new evidence upon the unanimous consent of the appeal panel.
There are no disadvantages to the agency or the Commonwealth. The pertinent
matter to the regulated community, government officials, and the public is that
the introduction of additional evidence will require the consent of the appeal panel,
which may or may not have board representation.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The Alcoholic
Beverage Control Board (Board) proposes to amend the regulation to indicate
that an appeal panel will make evidentiary decisions at appeal hearings rather
than a board.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. Section 290 of the regulation
concerns evidence for hearings. Under current language in Section 290, the
Board determines at appeal hearings whether it is necessary or desirable that
additional evidence be taken. If it decides that such additional evidence
should be taken, it may: 1) direct that a hearing officer fix a time and place
for the taking of such evidence, and 2) upon unanimous agreement of the Board
members permit the introduction of after-discovered or new evidence at the
appeal hearing.
Chapters 381 and 7302 of the 2015
Virginia Acts of Assembly eliminated, with a delayed effective date of July 1,
2018, the Board and the Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control (ABC) and
replaced them with the newly created Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control
Authority. The legislation also, with the delayed effective date, created a
Board of Directors of the Authority (Authority Board).
Members of the current Board work full time. Positions on the
Authority Board will be considered part time, and the full Authority Board will
often not be present for hearings.3 Instead, there will be an appeal
panel. The appeal panel will usually include a portion of the Authority Board
members, but may include non-Authority Board members as well.4
Consequently, the Board proposes to amend the regulation to indicate that the
appeal panel will make the evidentiary decisions at the appeal hearings.
Requiring the full Authority Board to make the evidentiary
decisions would likely delay the occurrence of hearings and potentially delay
results. The proposal to allow the appeal panel to make these decisions is thus
beneficial in that it prevents these potential delays.
Businesses and Entities Affected. All 13,000+ licensees could
potentially be subject to disciplinary proceedings, and thus could be affected
by the proposed amendments.5 ABC issues: licenses for manufacturers,
wholesalers and shippers of alcoholic beverages; retail licenses for the sale
of alcohol at restaurants, hotels, convenience stores, grocery stores, etc.;
and banquet licenses to allow persons or groups to host events such as wedding
receptions, tastings or fundraisers, where alcohol is served in an unlicensed
location or club premise.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendments do
not disproportionately affect particular localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed amendments do not
significantly affect employment.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The proposed
amendments do not significantly affect the use and value of private property.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendments do not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition
Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia, small
business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates, that
(i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. Requiring the full Authority Board to
make the evidentiary decisions would likely delay the occurrence of hearings
and potentially delay results. The proposed amendments eliminate these
potentially delays, and consequently eliminate potential costs that the delays
may create for small businesses licensed by ABC.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendments do not adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
other entities.
____________________________________________
1See http://lis.virginia.gov/cgi-bin/legp604.exe?151+ful+CHAP0038
2See http://lis.virginia.gov/cgi-bin/legp604.exe?151+ful+CHAP0730
3Source: Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
4Ibid
5Data source: Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Virginia Alcoholic Beverage Control Authority concurs with the Department of
Planning and Budget's economic impact analysis.
Summary:
The amendments permit the introduction of additional
evidence at an appeal hearing upon unanimous consent of the appeal panel.
3VAC5-10-290. Evidence.
A. Generally. Subject to the exceptions permitted in this
section, and to any stipulations agreed to by all interested parties, all
evidence should be introduced at hearings before hearing officers.
B. Additional evidence. Should the board appeal
panel determine at an appeal hearing, either upon motion or otherwise, that
it is necessary or desirable that additional evidence be taken, the board
appeal panel may:
1. Direct that a hearing officer fix a time and place for the
taking of such evidence within the limits prescribed by the board and in
accordance with 3VAC5-10-180; and
2. Upon unanimous agreement consent of the board
members appeal panel, permit the introduction of after-discovered or
new evidence at the appeal hearing.
If the initial decision indicates that the qualifications of
the establishment of an applicant or licensee are such as to cast substantial
doubt upon the eligibility of the place for a license, evidence may be received
at the appeal hearing limited to the issue involved and to the period of time
subsequent to the date of the hearing before the hearing officer.
C. Board examination Examination. Any board
appeal panel member may examine a witness upon any question relevant to
the matters in issue.
D. Cross-examination. The right to cross-examine and the
submission of rebuttal evidence as provided in 3VAC5-10-90 shall be allowed in
any appeal hearing where the introduction of additional evidence is permitted.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5367; Filed August 9, 2018, 8:27 a.m.
TITLE 12. HEALTH
STATE BOARD OF HEALTH
Final Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
State Board of Health is claiming an exemption from Article 2 of the
Administrative Process Act in accordance with § 2.2-4006 A 4 a of the Code
of Virginia, which excludes regulations that are necessary to conform to
changes in Virginia statutory law where no agency discretion is involved. The
State Board of Health will receive, consider, and respond to petitions by any
interested person at any time with respect to reconsideration or revision.
Title of Regulation: 12VAC5-421. Food Regulations (amending 12VAC5-421-10, 12VAC5-421-1380,
12VAC5-421-2830, 12VAC5-421-3310, 12VAC5-421-3560, 12VAC5-421-4035).
Statutory Authority: §§ 35.1-11 and 35.1-14 of the Code
of Virginia.
Effective Date: October 3, 2018.
Agency Contact: Julie Henderson, Director of Food and
General Environmental Services, Virginia Department of Health, 109 Governor
Street, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 864-7455, FAX (804) 864-7475, TTY
(800) 828-1120, or email julie.henderson@vdh.virginia.gov.
Summary:
Pursuant to Chapter 450 of the 2018 Acts of Assembly, the
amendments update the regulatory definition of a "bed and breakfast
operation" and expand the times during which a bed and breakfast operation
may offer food service to its guests without a food establishment permit by
removing the requirement that breakfast be the only meal offered.
Part I
Definitions, Purpose and Administration
12VAC5-421-10. Definitions.
The following words and terms when used in this chapter shall
have the following meanings unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.
"Accredited program" means a food protection
manager certification program that has been evaluated and listed by an
accrediting agency as conforming to national standards that certify
individuals. "Accredited program" refers to the certification process
and is a designation based upon an independent evaluation of factors such as
the sponsor's mission; organizational structure; staff resources; revenue
sources; policies; public information regarding program scope, eligibility
requirements, recertification, discipline and grievance procedures; and test
development and administration. "Accredited program" does not refer
to training functions or educational programs.
"Additive" means either a (i) "food
additive" having the meaning stated in the Federal Food, Drug, and
Cosmetic Act, § 201(s) and 21 CFR 170.3(e)(1) or (ii) "color
additive" having the meaning stated in the Federal Food, Drug, and
Cosmetic Act, § 201(t) and 21 CFR 70.3(f).
"Adulterated" has the meaning stated in the Federal
Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, § 402.
"Agent" means a legally authorized representative
of the owner.
"Agent of the commissioner" means the district or
local health director, unless otherwise stipulated.
"Approved" means acceptable to the department based
on a determination of conformity with principles, practices, and generally
recognized standards that protect public health.
"Approved water system" means a permitted
waterworks constructed, maintained, and operated pursuant to 12VAC5-590; or a
private well constructed, maintained, and operated pursuant to 12VAC5-630.
"Asymptomatic" means without obvious symptoms; not
showing or producing indications of a disease or other medical condition, such
as an individual infected with a pathogen but not exhibiting or producing any
signs or symptoms of vomiting, diarrhea, or jaundice. Asymptomatic includes not
showing symptoms because symptoms have resolved or subsided, or because
symptoms never manifested.
"aw" means water activity that is a
measure of the free moisture in a food, is the quotient of the water vapor
pressure of the substance divided by the vapor pressure of pure water at the
same temperature, and is indicated by the symbol aw.
"Balut" means an embryo inside a fertile egg that
has been incubated for a period sufficient for the embryo to reach a specific
stage of development after which it is removed from incubation before hatching.
"Bed and breakfast operation" means a tourist
home that serves meals residential-type establishment that provides (i)
two or more rental accommodations for transient guests and food service to a
maximum of 18 transient guests on any single day for five or more days in any
calendar year or (ii) at least one rental accommodation for transient guests
and food service to a maximum of 18 transient guests on any single day for 30
or more days in any calendar year.
"Beverage" means a liquid for drinking, including
water.
"Board" means the State Board of Health.
"Bottled drinking water" means water that is sealed
in bottles, packages, or other containers and offered for sale for human
consumption, including bottled mineral water.
"Building official" means a representative of the
Department of Housing and Community Development.
"Casing" means a tubular container for sausage
products made of either natural or artificial (synthetic) material.
"Catering operation" means a person who contracts
with a client to prepare a specific menu and amount of food in an approved and
permitted food establishment for service to the client's guests or customers at
a service location different from the permitted food establishment. Catering
may also include cooking or performing final preparation of food at the service
location.
"Catering operation" does not include:
1. A private chef or cook who, as the employee of a consumer,
prepares food solely in the consumer's home.
2. Delivery service of food by an approved and permitted food
establishment to an end consumer.
"Certification number" means a unique combination
of letters and numbers assigned by a shellfish control authority to a molluscan
shellfish dealer according to the provisions of the National Shellfish
Sanitation Program.
"CFR" means Code of Federal Regulations. Citations
in this chapter to the CFR refer sequentially to the title, part, and section
number, such as 40 CFR 180.194 refers to Title 40, Part 180, Section 194.
"CIP" means cleaned in place by the circulation or
flowing by mechanical means through a piping system of a detergent solution,
water rinse, and sanitizing solution onto or over equipment surfaces that
require cleaning, such as the method used, in part, to clean and sanitize a
frozen dessert machine. CIP does not include the cleaning of equipment such as
band saws, slicers or mixers that are subjected to in-place manual cleaning
without the use of a CIP system.
"Commingle" means:
1. To combine shellstock harvested on different days or from
different growing areas as identified on the tag or label; or
2. To combine shucked shellfish from containers with different
container codes or different shucking dates.
"Comminuted" means reduced in size by methods
including chopping, flaking, grinding, or mincing. "Comminuted"
includes (i) fish or meat products that are reduced in size and restructured or
reformulated such as gefilte fish, gyros, ground beef, and sausage and (ii) a
mixture of two or more types of meat that have been reduced in size and
combined, such as sausages made from two or more meats.
"Commissary" means a catering establishment, food
establishment, or any other place in which food, food containers, or supplies
are kept, handled, prepared, packaged, or stored for distribution to satellite
operations.
"Commissioner" means the State Health Commissioner,
his duly designated officer, or his agent.
"Conditional employee" means a potential food
employee to whom a job offer is made with employment dependent upon responses
to subsequent medical questions or examinations designed to identify potential
food employees who may be suffering from a disease that can be transmitted
through food and done in compliance with Title 1 of the Americans with
Disabilities Act of 1990.
"Confirmed disease outbreak" means a foodborne
disease outbreak in which laboratory analysis of appropriate specimens
identifies a causative organism or chemical and epidemiological analysis
implicates the food as the source of the illness.
"Consumer" means a person who is a member of the
public, takes possession of food, is not functioning in the capacity of an
operator of a food establishment or food processing plant, and does not offer
the food for resale.
"Core item" means a provision in this chapter that
is not designated as a priority item or a priority foundation item. Core item
includes an item that usually relates to general sanitation, operational
controls, sanitation standard operating procedures (SSOPs), facilities or
structures, equipment design, or general maintenance.
"Corrosion-resistant materials" means a material
that maintains acceptable surface cleanability characteristics under prolonged
influence of the food to be contacted, the normal use of cleaning compounds and
sanitizing solutions, and other conditions of the use environment.
"Counter-mounted equipment" means equipment that is
not portable and is designed to be mounted off the floor on a table, counter,
or shelf.
"Critical control point" means a point or procedure
in a specific food system where loss of control may result in an unacceptable
health risk.
"Critical limit" means the maximum or minimum value
to which a physical, biological, or chemical parameter must be controlled at a
critical control point to minimize the risk that the identified food safety
hazard may occur.
"Cut leafy greens" means fresh leafy greens whose
leaves have been cut, shredded, sliced, chopped, or torn. The term "leafy
greens" includes iceberg lettuce, romaine lettuce, leaf lettuce, butter
lettuce, baby leaf lettuce (i.e., immature lettuce or leafy greens), escarole,
endive, spring mix, spinach, cabbage, kale, arugula, and chard. The term
"leafy greens" does not include herbs such as cilantro or parsley.
"Dealer" means a person who is authorized by a
shellfish control authority for the activities of a shellstock shipper,
shucker-packer, repacker, reshipper, or depuration processor of molluscan
shellfish according to the provisions of the National Shellfish Sanitation
Program and is listed in the U.S. Food and Drug Administration's Interstate Certified
Shellfish Shippers List, updated monthly (U.S. Food and Drug Administration).
"Delicatessen" means a store where ready to eat
products such as cooked meats, prepared salads, etc. are sold for off-premises
consumption.
"Department" means the Virginia Department of
Health.
"Director" means the district or local health
director.
"Disclosure" means a written statement that clearly
identifies the animal derived foods that are, or can be ordered, raw,
undercooked, or without otherwise being processed to eliminate pathogens in
their entirety, or items that contain an ingredient that is raw, undercooked,
or without otherwise being processed to eliminate pathogens.
"Dry storage area" means a room or area designated
for the storage of packaged or containerized bulk food that is not
time/temperature control for safety food and dry goods such as single-service
items.
"Easily cleanable" means a characteristic of a
surface that:
1. Allows effective removal of soil by normal cleaning
methods;
2. Is dependent on the material, design, construction, and
installation of the surface; and
3. Varies with the likelihood of the surface's role in
introducing pathogenic or toxigenic agents or other contaminants into food
based on the surface's approved placement, purpose, and use.
"Easily cleanable" includes a tiered application of
the criteria that qualify the surface as easily cleanable as specified above to
different situations in which varying degrees of cleanability are required such
as:
1. The appropriateness of stainless steel for a food
preparation surface as opposed to the lack of need for stainless steel to be
used for floors or for tables used for consumer dining; or
2. The need for a different degree of cleanability for a
utilitarian attachment or accessory in the kitchen as opposed to a decorative
attachment or accessory in the consumer dining area.
"Easily movable"
means:
1. Portable; mounted on casters, gliders, or rollers; or
provided with a mechanical means to safely tilt a unit of equipment for
cleaning; and
2. Having no utility connection, a utility connection that
disconnects quickly, or a flexible utility connection line of sufficient length
to allow the equipment to be moved for cleaning of the equipment and adjacent
area.
"Egg" means the shell egg of avian species such as
chicken, duck, goose, guinea, quail, ratite, or turkey. Egg does not include a
balut; egg of the reptile species such as alligator; or an egg product.
"Egg product" means all, or a portion of, the
contents found inside eggs separated from the shell and pasteurized in a food
processing plant, with or without added ingredients, intended for human
consumption, such as dried, frozen, or liquid eggs. Egg product does not
include food that contains eggs only in a relatively small proportion such as
cake mixes.
"Employee" means the permit holder, person in
charge, food employee, person having supervisory or management duties, person
on the payroll, family member, volunteer, person performing work under
contractual agreement, or other person working in a food establishment.
"EPA" means the U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency.
"Equipment" means an article that is used in the
operation of a food establishment. "Equipment" includes, but is
not limited to, items such as a freezer, grinder, hood, ice maker, meat
block, mixer, oven, reach-in refrigerator, scale, sink, slicer, stove, table,
temperature measuring device for ambient air, vending machine, or warewashing
machine. Equipment does not include apparatuses used for handling or storing
large quantities of packaged foods that are received from a supplier in a cased
or overwrapped lot, such as hand trucks, forklifts, dollies, pallets, racks,
and skids.
"Exclude" means to prevent a person from working as
an employee in a food establishment or entering a food establishment as an
employee.
"°F" means degrees Fahrenheit.
"FDA" means the U.S. Food and Drug Administration.
"Fish" means fresh or saltwater finfish,
crustaceans, and other forms of aquatic life (including alligator, frog,
aquatic turtle, jellyfish, sea cucumber, and sea urchin and the roe of such
animals) other than birds or mammals and all mollusks, if such animal life is
intended for human consumption and includes any edible human food product
derived in whole or in part from fish, including fish that has been processed
in any manner.
"Food" means (i) a raw, cooked, or processed edible
substance, ice, beverage, or ingredient used or intended for use or for sale in
whole or in part for human consumption or (ii) chewing gum.
"Foodborne disease outbreak" means the occurrence
of two or more cases of a similar illness resulting from the ingestion of a
common food.
"Food-contact surface" means a surface of equipment
or a utensil with which food normally comes into contact, or a surface of
equipment or a utensil from which food may drain, drip, or splash into a food,
or onto a surface normally in contact with food.
"Food employee" means an individual working with
unpackaged food, food equipment or utensils, or food-contact surfaces.
"Food establishment" means an operation that (i)
stores, prepares, packages, serves, or vends food directly to the consumer or
otherwise provides food to the public for human consumption, such as a
restaurant, satellite or catered feeding location, catering operation if the
operation provides food directly to a consumer or to a conveyance used to
transport people, market, vending location, conveyance used to transport
people, institution, or food bank, and (ii) relinquishes possession of food to
a consumer directly or indirectly through a delivery service, such as home
delivery of grocery orders or restaurant takeout orders, or delivery service
that is provided by common carriers.
"Food establishment" includes (i) an element of the
operation such as a transportation vehicle or a central preparation facility
that supplies a vending location or satellite feeding location; (ii) an
operation that is conducted in a mobile, stationary, temporary, or permanent
facility or location where consumption is on or off the premises and regardless
of whether there is a charge for the food; and (iii) a facility that does not
meet the exemption criteria identified in subdivision 6 of this definition or a
facility that meets the exemption requirements but chooses to be regulated
under this chapter.
For the purpose of implementing this chapter, the following
places are also included in the definition of a "food establishment"
as defined in subdivision 9 of § 35.1-1 of the Code of Virginia:
1. Any place where food is prepared for service to the public
on or off the premises, or any place where food is served. Examples of such
places include but are not limited to, including lunchrooms, short
order places, cafeterias, coffee shops, cafes, taverns, delicatessens, dining
accommodations of public or private clubs, kitchen facilities of hospitals and
nursing homes, dining accommodations of public and private schools and
colleges, and kitchen areas of local correctional facilities subject to
standards adopted under § 53.1-68 of the Code of Virginia.
2. Any place or operation that prepares or stores food for
distribution to persons of the same business operation or of a related business
operation for service to the public. Examples of such places or operations
include but are not limited to, including operations preparing or
storing food for catering services, push cart operations, hotdog stands, and
other mobile points of service. Such mobile points of service are also
deemed to be restaurants unless the point of service and of consumption is in a
private residence.
3. Mobile points of service to which food is distributed by
a place or operation described in subdivision 2 of this definition, unless the
point of service and of consumption is in a private residence.
"Food establishment" does not include:
1. An establishment that offers only prepackaged food that is
not time/temperature control for safety food;
2. A produce stand that only offers whole, uncut fresh fruits
and vegetables;
3. A food processing plant, including those that are located
on the premises of a food establishment;
4. A kitchen in a private home if only food that is not
time/temperature control for safety food is prepared for sale or service at a
function such as a religious or charitable organization's bake sale if allowed
by law and if the consumer is informed by a clearly visible placard at the
sales or service location that the food is prepared in a kitchen that is not
subject to regulation and inspection by the regulatory authority;
5. An area where food that is prepared as specified in subdivision
4 of this definition is sold or offered for human consumption;
6. A kitchen in a private home, such as, but not limited to, a
family day-care provider or a home for adults, serving 12 or fewer recipients;
or a bed-and-breakfast operation that prepares and offers food only to guests
if the premises of the home is owner or owner-agent occupied, breakfast is the
only meal offered, the number of guests served does not exceed 18, and the
consumer is informed by statements contained in published advertisements,
mailed brochures, and placards posted at the registration area that the food is
prepared in a kitchen that is, by this chapter, exempt from this chapter;
7. A private home that receives catered or home-delivered
food; or
8. Places manufacturing packaged or canned foods that are
distributed to grocery stores or other similar food retailers for sale to the
public.
For the purpose of implementing this chapter, the following
are also exempt from the definition of a "food establishment" in this
chapter, as defined in §§ 35.1-25 and 35.1-26 of the Code of Virginia:
1. Boarding houses that do not accommodate transients;
2. Cafeterias operated by industrial plants for employees
only;
3. Churches, fraternal, school and social organizations and
volunteer fire departments and rescue squads that hold dinners and bazaars not
more than one time per week and not in excess of two days duration at which
food prepared in homes of members or in the kitchen of the church or
organization and is offered for sale to the public;
4. Grocery stores, including the delicatessen that is a part
of a grocery store, selling exclusively for off-premises consumption and places
manufacturing or selling packaged or canned goods;
5. Churches that serve meals for their members as a regular part
of their religious observance; and
6. Convenience stores or gas stations that are subject to the
State Board of Agriculture and Consumer Services' Retail Food Establishment
Regulations (2VAC5-585) or any regulations subsequently adopted and that (i) have
15 or fewer seats at which food is served to the public on the premises of the
convenience store or gas station and (ii) are not associated with a national or
regional restaurant chain. Notwithstanding this exemption, such convenience
stores or gas stations shall remain responsible for collecting any applicable
local meals tax; and
7. Any bed and breakfast operation that prepares food for
and offers food to guests, regardless of the time the food is prepared and
offered, if (i) the premises of the bed and breakfast operation is a home that
is owner occupied or owner-agent occupied, (ii) the bed and breakfast operation
prepares food for and offers food to transient guests of the bed and breakfast
only, (iii) the number of guests served by the bed and breakfast operation does
not exceed 18 on any single day, and (iv) guests for whom food is prepared and
to whom food is offered are informed by statements contained in published
advertisements, mailed brochures, and placards posted at the registration area that
the food is prepared in a kitchen that is not licensed as a restaurant and is
not subject to the regulations governing restaurants.
"Food processing plant" means a commercial
operation that manufactures, packages, labels, or stores food for human consumption
and provides food for sale or distribution to other business entities such as
food processing plants or food establishments. Food processing plant does not
include a food establishment.
"Game animal" means an animal, the products of
which are food, that is not classified as (i) livestock, sheep, swine, goat,
horse, mule, or other equine in 9 CFR 301.2; (ii) poultry; or (iii) fish.
"Game animal" includes mammals such as reindeer,
elk, deer, antelope, water buffalo, bison, rabbit, squirrel, opossum, raccoon,
nutria, or muskrat and nonaquatic reptiles such as land snakes.
"Game animal" does not include ratites such as
ostrich, emu, and rhea.
"General use pesticide" means a pesticide that is
not classified by EPA for restricted use as specified in 40 CFR 152.175.
"Grade A standards" means the requirements of the
Grade "A" Pasteurized Milk Ordinance, 2013 Revision, (U.S. Food and
Drug Administration), with which certain fluid and dry milk and milk products
comply.
"HACCP Plan" means a written document that
delineates the formal procedures for following the Hazard Analysis Critical
Control Point principles developed by The National Advisory Committee on
Microbiological Criteria for Foods.
"Handwashing sink" means a lavatory, a basin or
vessel for washing, a wash basin, or a plumbing fixture especially placed for
use in personal hygiene and designed for the washing of hands. Handwashing sink
includes an automatic handwashing facility.
"Hazard" means a biological, chemical, or physical
property that may cause an unacceptable consumer health risk.
"Health practitioner" means a physician licensed to
practice medicine, or if allowed by law, a nurse practitioner, physician
assistant, or similar medical professional.
"Hermetically sealed container" means a container that
is designed and intended to be secure against the entry of microorganisms and,
in the case of low acid canned foods, to maintain the commercial sterility of
its contents after processing.
"Highly susceptible population" means persons who
are more likely than other people in the general population to experience
foodborne disease because they are:
1. Immunocompromised, preschool age children, or older adults;
and
2. Obtaining food at a facility that provides services such as
custodial care, health care, or assisted living, such as a child or adult day
care center, kidney dialysis center, hospital or nursing home, or nutritional
or socialization services such as a senior center.
"Imminent health hazard" means a significant threat
or danger to health that is considered to exist when there is evidence
sufficient to show that a product, practice, circumstance, or event creates a
situation that requires immediate correction or cessation of operation to
prevent injury based on the number of potential injuries, and the nature,
severity, and duration of the anticipated injury.
"Injected" means manipulating meat to which a
solution has been introduced into its interior by processes such as
"injecting," "pump marinating," or "stitch
pumping."
"Juice" means the aqueous liquid expressed or
extracted from one or more fruits or vegetables, purées of the edible portions
of one or more fruits or vegetables, or any concentrate of such liquid or
purée. Juice does not include, for purposes of HACCP, liquids, purées, or concentrates
that are not used as beverages or ingredients of beverages.
"Kitchenware" means food preparation and storage
utensils.
"Law" means applicable local, state, and federal
statutes, regulations, and ordinances.
"Linens" means fabric items such as cloth hampers,
cloth napkins, table cloths, wiping cloths, and work garments including cloth
gloves.
"Major food allergen" means milk, egg, fish (such
as bass, flounder, cod, and including crustacean shellfish such as crab,
lobster, or shrimp), tree nuts (such as almonds, pecans, or walnuts), wheat,
peanuts, and soybeans; or a food ingredient that contains protein derived from
one of these foods. Major food allergen does not include any highly refined oil
derived from a major food allergen in this definition and any ingredient
derived from such highly refined oil or any ingredient that is exempt under the
petition or notification process specified in the Food Allergen Labeling and
Consumer Protection Act of 2004 (P.L. 108-282).
"Meat" means the flesh of animals used as food
including the dressed flesh of cattle, swine, sheep, or goats and other edible
animals, except fish, poultry, and wild game animals as specified under
12VAC5-421-330 A 2 and A 3.
"Mechanically tenderized" means manipulating meat
with deep penetration by processes which may be referred to as "blade
tenderizing," "jaccarding," "pinning,"
"needling," or using blades, pins, needles, or any mechanical device.
"Mechanically tenderized" does not include processes by which
solutions are injected into meat.
"mg/L" means milligrams per liter, which is the
metric equivalent of parts per million (ppm).
"Mobile food unit" means a food establishment
mounted on wheels (excluding boats in the water) readily moveable from place to
place at all times during operation and shall include, but not be limited
to, pushcarts, trailers, trucks, or vans. The unit, all operations, and all
equipment must be integral to and be within or attached to the unit.
"Molluscan shellfish" means any edible species of
fresh or frozen oysters, clams, mussels, and scallops or edible portions
thereof, except when the scallop product consists only of the shucked adductor
muscle.
"Noncontinuous cooking" means the cooking of food
in a food establishment using a process in which the initial heating of the
food is intentionally halted so that it may be cooled and held for complete
cooking at a later time prior to sale or service. "Noncontinuous
cooking" does not include cooking procedures that only involve temporarily
interrupting or slowing an otherwise continuous cooking process.
"Occasional" means not more than one time per week,
and not in excess of two days duration.
"Packaged" means bottled, canned, cartoned, bagged,
or wrapped, whether packaged in a food establishment or a food processing plant.
Packaged does not include wrapped or placed in a carry-out container to protect
the food during service or delivery to the consumer, by a food employee, upon
consumer request.
"Permit" means a license issued by the regulatory
authority that authorizes a person to operate a food establishment.
"Permit holder" means the entity that is legally
responsible for the operation of the food establishment such as the owner, the
owner's agent, or other person, and possesses a valid permit to operate a food
establishment.
"Person" means an association, a corporation,
individual, partnership, other legal entity, government, or governmental
subdivision or agency.
"Person in charge" means the individual present at
a food establishment who is responsible for the operation at the time of
inspection.
"Personal care items" means items or substances
that may be poisonous, toxic, or a source of contamination and are used to
maintain or enhance a person's health, hygiene, or appearance. Personal care
items include items such as medicines; first aid supplies; and other items such
as cosmetics, and toiletries such as toothpaste and mouthwash.
"pH" means the symbol for the negative logarithm of
the hydrogen ion concentration, which is a measure of the degree of acidity or
alkalinity of a solution. Values between 0 and 7.0 indicate acidity and values
between 7.0 and 14 indicate alkalinity. The value for pure distilled water is
7.0, which is considered neutral.
"Physical facilities" means the structure and
interior surfaces of a food establishment including accessories such as soap
and towel dispensers and attachments such as light fixtures and heating or air
conditioning system vents.
"Plumbing fixture" means a receptacle or device
that is permanently or temporarily connected to the water distribution system
of the premises and demands a supply of water from the system or discharges
used water, waste materials, or sewage directly or indirectly to the drainage
system of the premises.
"Plumbing system" means the water supply and distribution
pipes; plumbing fixtures and traps; soil, waste, and vent pipes; sanitary and
storm sewers and building drains, including their respective connections,
devices, and appurtenances within the premises; and water-treating equipment.
"Poisonous or toxic materials" means substances
that are not intended for ingestion and are included in four categories:
1. Cleaners and sanitizers, that include cleaning and
sanitizing agents and agents such as caustics, acids, drying agents, polishes,
and other chemicals;
2. Pesticides, except sanitizers, that include substances such
as insecticides and rodenticides;
3. Substances necessary for the operation and maintenance of
the establishment such as nonfood grade lubricants, paints, and personal care
items that may be deleterious to health; and
4. Substances that are not necessary for the operation and
maintenance of the establishment and are on the premises for retail sale, such
as petroleum products and paints.
"Potable water" means water fit for human
consumption that is obtained from an approved water supply and that is (i)
sanitary and normally free of minerals, organic substances, and toxic agents in
excess of reasonable amounts and (ii) adequate in quantity and quality for the
minimum health requirements of the persons served (see Article 2 (§ 32.1-167 et
seq.) of Chapter 6 of Title 32.1 of the Code of Virginia). Potable water is
traditionally known as drinking water and excludes such nonpotable forms as
"boiler water, "mop water," "rainwater,"
"wastewater," and "nondrinking water."
"Poultry" means any domesticated bird (chickens,
turkeys, ducks, geese, guineas, ratites, or squabs), whether live or dead, as
defined in 9 CFR 381.1, and any migratory waterfowl, game bird, pheasant,
partridge, quail, grouse, or pigeon whether live or dead, as defined in 9 CFR
362.1.
"Premises" means the physical facility, its
contents, and the contiguous land or property under the control of the permit
holder; or the physical facility, its contents, and the land or property which
are under the control of the permit holder and may impact food establishment
personnel, facilities, or operations, if a food establishment is only one
component of a larger operation such as a health care facility, hotel, motel,
school, recreational camp, or prison.
"Primal cut" means a basic major cut into which
carcasses and sides of meat are separated, such as a beef round, pork loin,
lamb flank or veal breast.
"Priority foundation item" means a provision in
this chapter whose application supports, facilitates, or enables one or more
priority items. "Priority foundation item" includes an item that
requires the purposeful incorporation of specific actions, equipment, or
procedures by industry management to attain control of risk factors that contribute
to foodborne illness or injury such as personnel training, infrastructure or
necessary equipment, HACCP plans, documentation or record keeping, and labeling
and is denoted in this regulation with a superscript PfPf.
"Priority item" means a provision in this chapter
whose application contributes directly to the elimination, prevention or
reduction to an acceptable level of hazards associated with foodborne illness
or injury and there is no other provision that more directly controls the
hazard. "Priority item" includes items with a quantifiable measure to
show control of hazards such as cooking, reheating, cooling, and handwashing
and is denoted in this chapter with a superscript Pp.
"Private well" means any water well constructed for
a person on land that is owned or leased by that person and is usually intended
for household, groundwater source heat pump, agricultural use, industrial use,
or other nonpublic water well.
"Pure water" means potable water fit for human
consumption that is (i) sanitary and normally free of minerals, organic
substances, and toxic agents in excess of reasonable amounts and (ii) adequate
in quantity and quality for the minimum health requirements of the persons
served (see §§ 32.1-167 and 32.1-176.1 of the Code of Virginia and 12VAC5-590
and 12VAC5-630-370). Potable water is traditionally known as drinking
water, and excludes such nonpotable forms as "boiler water,"
"mop water," "rainwater," "wastewater," and
"nondrinking water."
"Pushcart" means any wheeled vehicle or device
other than a motor vehicle or trailer that may be moved with or without the
assistance of a motor and that does not require registration by the department
of motor vehicles.
"Ratite" means a flightless bird such as an emu,
ostrich, or rhea.
"Ready-to-eat food" means food that:
1. Is in a form that is edible without additional preparation
to achieve food safety, as specified under 12VAC5-421-700 A, B, and C,
12VAC5-421-710 or 12VAC5-421-730;
2. Is a raw or partially cooked animal food and the consumer
is advised as specified under 12VAC5-421- 700 D 1 and 3; or
3. Is prepared in accordance with a variance that is granted
as specified under 12VAC5-421-700 D 4.
Ready-to-eat food may receive additional preparation for
palatability or aesthetic, epicurean, gastronomic, or culinary purposes.
"Ready-to-eat food" includes:
1. Raw animal food that is cooked as specified under
12VAC5-421-700, or 12VAC5-421-710 or frozen as specified under 12VAC5-421-730;
2. Raw fruits and vegetables that are washed as specified
under 12VAC5-421-510;
3. Fruits and vegetables that are cooked for hot holding as
specified under 12VAC5-421-720;
4. All time/temperature control for safety food that is cooked
to the temperature and time required for the specific food under 12VAC5-421-700
and cooled as specified in 12VAC5-421-800;
5. Plant food for which further washing, cooking, or other
processing is not required for food safety, and from which rinds, peels, husks,
or shells, if naturally present, are removed;
6. Substances derived from plants such as spices, seasonings,
and sugar;
7. A bakery item such as bread, cakes, pies, fillings, or
icing for which further cooking is not required for food safety;
8. The following products that are produced in accordance with
USDA guidelines and that have received a lethality treatment for pathogens:
dry, fermented sausages, such as dry salami or pepperoni; salt-cured meat and
poultry products, such as prosciutto ham, country cured ham, and Parma ham; and
dried meat and poultry products, such as jerky or beef sticks; and
9. Food manufactured according to 21 CFR Part 113.
"Reduced oxygen packaging" means the reduction of
the amount of oxygen in a package by removing oxygen; displacing oxygen and
replacing it with another gas or combination of gases; or otherwise controlling
the oxygen content to a level below that normally found in the atmosphere
(approximately 21% at sea level); and a process as specified in this definition
that involves a food for which the hazards Clostridium botulinum or Listeria
monocytogenes require control in the final packaged form. Reduced oxygen
packaging includes:
1. Vacuum packaging, in which air is removed from a package of
food and the package is hermetically sealed so that a vacuum remains inside the
package;
2. Modified atmosphere packaging, in which the atmosphere of a
package of food is modified so that its composition is different from air, but
the atmosphere may change over time due to the permeability of the packaging
material or the respiration of the food. Modified atmosphere packaging includes
reduction in the proportion of oxygen, total replacement of oxygen, or an
increase in the proportion of other gases such as carbon dioxide or nitrogen;
3. Controlled atmosphere packaging, in which the atmosphere of
a package of food is modified so that until the package is opened, its
composition is different from air, and continuous control of that atmosphere is
maintained, such as by using oxygen scavengers or a combination of total
replacement oxygen, nonrespiring food, and impermeable packaging material;
4. Cook chill packaging, in which cooked food is hot filled
into impermeable bags that have the air expelled and are then sealed or crimped
closed. The bagged food is rapidly chilled and refrigerated at temperatures
that inhibit the growth of psychrotrophic pathogens; or
5. Sous vide packaging, in which raw or partially cooked food
is vacuum packaged in an impermeable bag, cooked in the bag, rapidly chilled,
and refrigerated at temperatures that inhibit the growth of psychrotrophic
pathogens.
"Refuse" means solid waste not carried by water
through the sewage system.
"Regulatory authority" means the Virginia
Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services, the Virginia Department of
Health or their authorized representative having jurisdiction over the food
establishment.
"Reminder" means a written statement concerning the
health risk of consuming animal foods raw, undercooked, or without otherwise
being processed to eliminate pathogens.
"Reservice" means the transfer of food that is
unused and returned by a consumer after being served or sold and in the
possession of the consumer, to another person.
"Restrict" means to limit the activities of a food
employee so that there is no risk of transmitting a disease that is
transmissible through food and the food employee does not work with exposed
food, clean equipment, utensils, linens, and unwrapped single-service or
single-use articles.
"Restricted egg" means any check, dirty egg,
incubator reject, inedible, leaker, or loss as defined in 9 CFR Part 590.
"Restricted use pesticide" means a pesticide
product that contains the active ingredients specified in 40 CFR 152.175 and
that is limited to use by or under the direct supervision of a certified
applicator.
"Risk" means the likelihood that an adverse health
effect will occur within a population as a result of a hazard in a food.
"Safe material" means an article manufactured from
or composed of materials that shall not reasonably be expected to result,
directly or indirectly, in their becoming a component or otherwise affecting
the characteristics of any food; an additive that is used as specified in § 409
of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (21 USC § 348); or other materials
that are not additives and that are used in conformity with applicable regulations
of the Food and Drug Administration.
"Sanitization" means the application of cumulative
heat or chemicals on cleaned food-contact surfaces that, when evaluated for
efficacy, yield a reduction of five logs, which is equal to a 99.999%
reduction, of representative disease microorganisms of public health
importance.
"Sealed" means free of cracks or other openings
that permit the entry or passage of moisture.
"Service animal" means an animal such as a guide
dog, signal dog, or other animal individually trained to provide assistance to
an individual with a disability.
"Servicing area" means an operating base location
to which a mobile food establishment or transportation vehicle returns
regularly for such things as vehicle and equipment cleaning, discharging liquid
or solid wastes, refilling water tanks and ice bins, and boarding food.
"Sewage" means liquid waste containing animal or
vegetable matter in suspension or solution and may include liquids containing
chemicals in solution. Sewage includes water-carried and non-water-carried
human excrement or kitchen, laundry, shower, bath, or lavatory waste separately
or together with such underground surface, storm, or other water and liquid
industrial wastes as may be present from residences, buildings, vehicles,
industrial establishments, or other places.
"Shellfish control authority" means a state,
federal, foreign, tribal or other government entity legally responsible for
administering a program that includes certification of molluscan shellfish
harvesters and dealers for interstate commerce such as the Virginia Department
of Health Division of Shellfish Sanitation.
"Shellstock" means raw, in-shell molluscan
shellfish.
"Shiga toxin-producing Escherichia coli" or
"STEC" means any E. coli capable of producing Shiga toxins (also
called verocytotoxins). STEC infections can be asymptomatic or may result in a
spectrum of illness ranging from mild nonbloody diarrhea, to hemorrhagic
colitis (i.e., bloody diarrhea) to hemolytic uremic syndrome (HUS), which is a
type of kidney failure). Examples of serotypes of STEC include E. coli
0157:H7, E. coli 0157:NM, E. coli 026:H11; E. coli 0145NM, E. coli 0103:H2, and
E. coli 0111:NM. STEC are sometimes referred to as VTEC (verocytotoxigenic E.
coli) or as EHEC (Enterohemorrhagic E. coli). EHEC are a subset of STEC that
can cause hemorrhagic colitis or HUS.
"Shucked shellfish" means molluscan shellfish that
have one or both shells removed.
"Single-service articles" means tableware,
carry-out utensils, and other items such as bags, containers, placemats,
stirrers, straws, toothpicks, and wrappers that are designed and constructed
for one time, one person use after which they are intended for discard.
"Single-use articles" means utensils and bulk food
containers designed and constructed to be used once and discarded. Single-use
articles includes items such as wax paper, butcher paper, plastic wrap, formed
aluminum food containers, jars, plastic tubs or buckets, bread wrappers, pickle
barrels, ketchup bottles, and number 10 cans which do not meet the materials,
durability, strength and cleanability specifications contained in
12VAC5-421-960, 12VAC5-421-1080, and 12VAC5-421-1100 for multiuse utensils.
"Slacking" means the process of moderating the
temperature of a food such as allowing a food to gradually increase from a
temperature of -10°F (-23°C) to 25°F (-4°C) in preparation for deep-fat frying
or to facilitate even heat penetration during the cooking of previously
block-frozen food such as shrimp.
"Smooth" means a food-contact surface having a
surface free of pits and inclusions with a cleanability equal to or exceeding
that of (100 grit) number three stainless steel; a non-food-contact surface of
equipment having a surface equal to that of commercial grade hot-rolled steel
free of visible scale; and a floor, wall, or ceiling having an even or level
surface with no roughness or projections that render it difficult to clean.
"Substantial compliance" means equipment or
structure design or construction; food preparation, handling, storage,
transportation; or cleaning procedures that will not substantially affect
health consideration or performance of the facility or the employees.
"Tableware" means eating, drinking, and serving
utensils for table use such as flatware including forks, knives, and spoons;
hollowware including bowls, cups, serving dishes, tumblers; and plates.
"Temperature measuring device" means a thermometer,
thermocouple, thermistor, or other device that indicates the temperature of
food, air, or water.
"Temporary food establishment" means a food
establishment that operates for a period of no more than 14 consecutive days in
conjunction with a single event or celebration.
"Time/temperature control for safety food" or
"TCS food" means a food that requires time/temperature control for
safety to limit pathogenic microorganism growth or toxin formation:
1. TCS food includes an animal food that is raw or heat
treated; a plant food that is heat treated or consists of raw seed sprouts, cut
melons, cut leafy greens, cut tomatoes, or mixtures of cut tomatoes that are
not modified in a way so that they are unable to support pathogenic
microorganism growth or toxin formation, or garlic-in-oil mixtures that are not
modified in a way so that they are unable to support pathogenic microorganism
growth or toxin formation; and except as specified in subdivision 2 d of this
definition, a food that because of the interaction of its Aw and pH
values is designated as product assessment required (PA) in Table A or B of
this definition:
Table A. Interaction of pH and Aw for control of
spores in food heat treated to destroy vegetative cells and subsequently
packaged.
|
Aw values
|
pH values
|
4.6 or less
|
>4.6 - 5.6
|
>5.6
|
=0.92
|
non-TCS food*
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
>0.92 - 0.95
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
PA**
|
>0.95
|
non-TCS food
|
PA
|
PA
|
*TCS food means time/temperature control for safety food
**PA means product assessment required
|
Table B. Interaction of pH and Aw for control of
vegetative cells and spores in food not heat treated or heat treated but not
packaged.
|
Aw values
|
pH values
|
< 4.2
|
4.2 - 4.6
|
> 4.6 - 5.0
|
> 5.0
|
<0.88
|
non-TCS food*
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
0.88 - 0.90
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
PA**
|
>0.90 - 0.92
|
non-TCS food
|
non-TCS food
|
PA
|
PA
|
>0.92
|
non-TCS food
|
PA
|
PA
|
PA
|
*TCS food means time/temperature control for safety food
**PA means product assessment required
|
2. TCS food does not include:
a. An air-cooled hard-boiled egg with shell intact, or an egg
with shell intact that is not hard-boiled, but has been pasteurized to destroy
all viable salmonellae;
b. A food in an unopened hermetically sealed container that is
commercially processed to achieve and maintain commercial sterility under
conditions of nonrefrigerated storage and distribution;
c. A food that because of its pH or Aw value, or
interaction of Aw and pH values, is designated as a non-TCS food in
Table A or B of this definition;
d. A food that is designated as PA in Table A or B of this
definition and has undergone a product assessment showing that the growth or
toxin formation of pathogenic microorganisms that are reasonably likely to
occur in that food is precluded due to:
(1) Intrinsic factors including added or natural
characteristics of the food such as preservatives, antimicrobials, humectants,
acidulants, or nutrients;
(2) Extrinsic factors including environmental or operational
factors that affect the food such as packaging, modified atmosphere such as reduced
oxygen packaging, shelf-life and use, or temperature range of storage and use;
or
(3) A combination of intrinsic and extrinsic factors; or
e. A food that does not support the growth or toxin formation
of pathogenic microorganisms in accordance with one of the subdivisions 2 a
through 2 d of this definition even though the food may contain a pathogenic
microorganism or chemical or physical contaminant at a level sufficient to
cause illness or injury.
"USDA" means the U.S. Department of Agriculture.
"Utensil" means a food-contact implement or
container used in the storage, preparation, transportation, dispensing, sale,
or service of food, such as kitchenware or tableware that is multiuse, single
service, or single use; gloves used in contact with food; temperature sensing
probes of food temperature measuring devices and probe-type price or
identification tags used in contact with food.
"Variance" means a written document issued by the
regulatory authority that authorizes a modification or waiver of one or more
requirements of this chapter if, in the opinion of the regulatory authority, a
health hazard or nuisance will not result from the modification or waiver.
"Vending machine" means a self-service device that,
upon insertion of a coin, paper currency, token, card, or key, or by optional
manual operation, dispenses unit servings of food in bulk or in packages
without the necessity of replenishing the device between each vending
operation.
"Vending machine location" means the room,
enclosure, space, or area where one or more vending machines are installed and
operated and includes the storage areas and areas on the premises that are used
to service and maintain the vending machines.
"Warewashing" means the cleaning and sanitizing of
utensils and food-contact surfaces of equipment.
"Waterworks" means a system that serves piped water
for human consumption to at least 15 service connections or 25 or more
individuals for at least 60 days out of the year. "Waterworks"
includes all structures, equipment and appurtenances used in the storage,
collection, purification, treatment, and distribution of potable water except
the piping and fixtures inside the building where such water is delivered (see
Article 2 (§ 32.1-167 et seq.) of Chapter 6 of Title 32.1 of the Code of
Virginia).
"Whole-muscle, intact beef" means whole muscle beef
that is not injected, mechanically tenderized, reconstructed, or scored and
marinated, from which beef steaks may be cut.
12VAC5-421-1380. Warewashing machines, flow pressure device.
A. Warewashing machines that provide a fresh hot water
sanitizing rinse shall be equipped with a pressure gauge or similar device such
as a transducer that measures and displays the water pressure in the supply
line immediately before entering the warewashing machine.
B. If the flow pressure measuring device is upstream of the
fresh hot water sanitizing rinse control valve, the device shall be mounted in
a one-fourth inch or 6.4 millimeter Iron Pipe Size (IPS) valve.
C. Subsections A and B of this section do not apply to a
machine that uses only a pumped or recirculated sanitizing rinse.
D. Subsections A and B of this section shall not apply to
home model dishwashers used in bed and breakfast facilities operations
serving 18 or fewer customers guests.
12VAC5-421-2830. Floor and wall junctures, coved, and enclosed
or sealed.
A. In food establishments in which cleaning methods other
than water flushing are used for cleaning floors, the floor and wall junctures
shall be coved and closed to no larger than 1/32 inch (1 mm). However, this
subsection shall not apply to floor wall junctures in bed and breakfast facilities
operations serving 18 or fewer customers guests.
B. The floors in food establishments in which water flush
cleaning methods are used shall be provided with drains and be graded to drain,
and the floor and wall junctures shall be coved and sealed.
12VAC5-421-3310. Prohibiting animals.
A. Except as specified in subsections B and C of this
section, live animals shall not be allowed on the premises of a food
establishment.Pf
B. Live animals may be allowed in the following situations if
the contamination of food; clean equipment, utensils, and linens; and unwrapped
single-service and single-use articles cannot result:
1. Edible fish or decorative fish in aquariums, shellfish or
crustacea on ice or under refrigeration, and shellfish and crustacea in display
tank systems;
2. Patrol dogs accompanying police or security officers in
offices and dining, sales, and storage areas, and sentry dogs running loose in
outside fenced areas;
3. In areas that are not used for food preparation and that
are usually open for customers, such as dining and sales areas, service animals
that are controlled by the disabled employee or person if a health or safety
hazard will not result from the presence or activities of the service animal;
4. Pets in the common dining areas of institutional care
facilities such as nursing homes, assisted living facilities, group homes,
residential care facilities, and food establishment bed and breakfast facilities
operations at times other than during meals if:
a. Effective partitioning and self-closing doors separate the
common dining areas from food storage or food preparation areas;
b. Condiments, equipment, and utensils are stored in enclosed
cabinets or removed from the common dining areas when pets are present; and
c. Dining areas including tables, countertops, and similar
surfaces are effectively cleaned before the next meal service;
5. In areas that are not used for food preparation, storage,
sales, display, or dining, in which there are caged animals or animals that are
similarly restricted, such as in a variety store that sells pets or a tourist
park that displays animals; and
6. Dogs in outdoor dining areas if:
a. The outdoor dining area is not fully enclosed with floor to
ceiling walls and is not considered a part of the interior physical facility.
b. The outdoor dining area is equipped with an entrance that
is separate from the main entrance to the food establishment and the separate
entrance serves as the sole means of entry for patrons accompanied by dogs.
c. A sign stating that dogs are allowed in the outdoor dining
area is posted at each entrance to the outdoor dining area in such a manner as
to be clearly observable by the public.
d. A sign within the outdoor dining area stating the
requirements as specified in subdivisions 6 e, 6 f, and 6 g of this subsection
is provided in such a manner as to be clearly observable by the public.
e. Food and water provided to dogs is served using equipment
that is not used for service of food to persons or is served in single-use
articles.
f. Dogs are not allowed on chairs, seats, benches, or tables.
g. Dogs are kept on a leash or within a pet carrier and under
the control of an adult at all times.
h. Establishment provides effective means for cleaning up dog
vomitus and fecal matter.
C. Live or dead fish bait may be stored if contamination of
food; clean equipment, utensils, and linens; and unwrapped single-service and
single-use articles cannot result.
D. In bed and breakfast facilities operations
serving 18 or fewer customers guests, live animals shall be
allowed in the facility but shall not be fed using the same equipment or
utensils that are used to feed humans.
12VAC5-421-3560. Exemptions to regulations.
A. The following are exempt from this chapter as defined in
§§ 35.1-25 and 35.1-26 of the Code of Virginia.
1. Boarding houses that do not accommodate transients;
2. Cafeterias operated by industrial plants for employees
only;
3. Churches, fraternal, school and social organizations and
volunteer fire departments and rescue squads which hold dinners and bazaars of
not more than one time per week and not in excess of two days duration at which
food prepared in homes of members or in the kitchen of the church or
organization and is offered for sale to the public;
4. Grocery stores, including the delicatessen which that
is a part of a grocery store, selling exclusively for off-premises consumption
and places manufacturing or selling packaged or canned goods;
5. Churches which that serve meals for their
members as a regular part of their religious observance; and
6. Convenience stores or gas stations that are subject to the
State Board of Agriculture and Consumer Services' Retail Food Establishment
Regulations (2VAC5-585) or any regulations subsequently adopted and that (i)
have 15 or fewer seats at which food is served to the public on the premises of
the convenience store or gas station and (ii) are not associated with a
national or regional restaurant chain. Notwithstanding this exemption, such
convenience stores or gas stations shall remain responsible for collecting any
applicable local meals tax; and
7. Any bed and breakfast operation that prepares food for and
offers food to guests, regardless of the time the food is prepared and offered,
if (i) the premises of the bed and breakfast operation is a home that is owner
occupied or owner-agent occupied, (ii) the bed and breakfast operation prepares
food for and offers food to transient guests of the bed and breakfast only,
(iii) the number of guests served by the bed and breakfast operation does not
exceed 18 on any single day, and (iv) guests for whom food is prepared and to
whom food is offered are informed by statements contained in published
advertisements, mailed brochures, and placards posted at the registration area
that the food is prepared in a kitchen that is not licensed as a restaurant and
is not subject to regulations governing restaurants.
B. The governing body of any county, city or town may provide
by ordinance that this chapter shall not apply to food booths at fairs and
youth athletic activities, if such booths are promoted or sponsored by
any political subdivision of the Commonwealth or by any charitable nonprofit
organization or group thereof. The ordinance shall provide that the director of
the county, city, or town in which the fair and youth athletic activities are
held, or a qualified person designated by the director, shall exercise such supervision
of the sale of food as the ordinance may prescribe.
12VAC5-421-4035. Exempt facilities that choose to be regulated.
Exempt facilities, as defined in subdivision 6 of
12VAC5-421-10 of the definition of a "food establishment," and
subdivision A 7 of 12VAC5-421-3560, that choose to be regulated by this
chapter, shall be exempt from the following requirements:
1. In lieu of 12VAC5-421-1200 A, home model dishwashers
may be used in lieu of manual cleaning and drying of utensils;
2. 12VAC5-421-1340, the requirement for internal baffles in
warewashing machines does not apply to home model dishwashers;
3. 12VAC5-421-1350, the requirement for temperature measuring
devices does not apply to home model dishwashers;
4. 12VAC5-421-1360, manual warewashing equipment, heaters and
baskets are not required but manual warewashing shall include, as a minimum,
thorough washing with adequate soap or detergent, thorough rinsing, and drying
before storage or use. Drying may be by clean towels used for no other purpose;
5. 12VAC5-421-1370, the requirement for a sanitizer level
indicator does not apply to home model dishwashers;
6. 12VAC5-421-1380, the requirement for flow pressures device
does not apply to home model dishwashers;
7. 12VAC5-421-1460, the requirement for sink compartments does
not apply to exempt facilities. It shall include thorough washing with adequate
soap or detergent, thorough rinsing, and drying before storage or use. Drying
may be by clean towels used for no other purpose;
8. 12VAC5-421-1520, temperature measuring devices for manual
warewashing are not required;
9. 12VAC5-421-1530, sanitizing solutions testing devices are
not required;
10. 12VAC5-421-1620, warewashing sinks in exempt facilities
may be used for handwashing, however, approved dispensers, soap, and single-use
paper towels are provided;
11. 12VAC5-421-1640, clean solutions in warewashing equipment
is not required for exempt facilities. It shall include, as a minimum, thorough
washing with adequate soap or detergent, thorough rinsing, and drying before
storage or use. Drying may be by clean towels used for no other purpose;
12. 12VAC5-421-1660, minimum wash solution temperature for
mechanical warewashing equipment shall not be required for home model
dishwashers;
13. 12VAC5-421-1670, minimum hot water sanitization
temperatures for manual warewashing equipment shall not be required;
14. 12VAC5-421-1680, minimum hot water sanitization
temperatures for mechanical warewashing equipment shall not be required for
home model dishwashers;
15. 12VAC5-421-1690, sanitization pressure for mechanical
warewashing equipment shall not be required;
16. 12VAC5-421-1700, minimum and maximum pressure, pH,
sanitizer concentration, and hardness levels shall not be required for home
model dishwashers;
17. 12VAC5-421-1710, chemical sanitization for manual
warewashing using detergent sanitizers shall not be required;
18. 12VAC5-421-1720, determination of chemical sanitizer
concentration shall not be required;
19. 12VAC5-421-1880 12VAC5-421-1885,
food-contact surfaces and utensils shall not be required to be sanitized;
20. 12VAC5-421-1890, before use after cleaning, utensils and
food-contact surfaces shall not be required to be sanitized;
21. 12VAC5-421-1900, hot water and chemical sanitizing shall
not be required;
22. 12VAC5-421-2790, floors, walls, and ceilings shall be in
good repair and kept clean;
23, 12VAC5-421-2810, floors, walls, and ceilings in exempt
facilities shall not be required to meet the cleanability requirements but
shall be in good repair and kept clean;
24. 12VAC5-421-2820, the prohibition of exposed utility
service lines and pipes shall not apply;
25. 12VAC5-421-2840, floor carpeting in exempt facilities may
be installed in food preparation areas, walk-in refrigerators, warewashing
areas, toilet rooms, refuse storage rooms or other areas, however they shall be
kept in good repair and kept clean;
26. 12VAC5-421-2850, floor covering, mats and duckboards may
be used in exempt facilities, however, they shall be kept clean and in good repair.
27. 12VAC5-421-2870, attachments to walls and ceilings in
exempt facilities shall be kept in good repair and kept clean;
28. 12VAC5-421-3120 12VAC5-421-3130, approved
dispensers, soap and single-use paper towels shall be made available to
accommodate hand washing;
29. 12VAC5-421-3310, live animals may be allowed in the
facility but shall not be fed using the same equipment or utensils that are
used to feed humans.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5439; Filed August 3, 2018, 4:23 p.m.
TITLE 12. HEALTH
DEPARTMENT OF MEDICAL ASSISTANCE SERVICES
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 12VAC30-70. Methods and
Standards for Establishing Payment Rates - Inpatient Hospital Services (adding 12VAC30-70-411).
Statutory Authority: § 32.1-325 of the Code of
Virginia; 42 USC § 1396 et seq.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: Emily McClellan, Regulatory Supervisor,
Policy Division, Department of Medical Assistance Services, 600 East Broad
Street, Suite 1300, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 371-4300, FAX (804)
786-1680, or email emily.mcclellan@dmas.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 32.1-325 of the Code of Virginia grants
to the Board of Medical Assistance Services the authority to administer and
amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance. Section 32.1-324 of the Code of
Virginia authorizes the Director of the Department of Medical Assistance
Services (DMAS) to administer and amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance
according to the board's requirements. The Medicaid authority as established by
§ 1902(a) of the Social Security Act (42 USC § 1396) provides
governing authority for payments for services.
In addition, authority for these changes is provided in Item
306 RRR 1 of Chapter 836 of the the 2017 Acts of Assembly, which states:
"The Department of Medical Assistance Services shall promulgate
regulations to make supplemental Medicaid payments to the primary teaching
hospitals affiliated with a Liaison Committee on Medical Education (LCME)
accredited medical school located in Planning District 23 that is a political
subdivision of the Commonwealth and an LCME accredited medical school located
in Planning District 5 that has a partnership with a public university. The
amount of the supplemental payment shall be based on the reimbursement
methodology established for such payments in Attachments 4.19-A and 4.19-B of
the State Plan for Medical Assistance and/or the department's contracts with
managed care organizations. The department shall have the authority to
implement these reimbursement changes consistent with the effective date in the
State Plan amendment or the managed care contracts approved by the Centers for
Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS) and prior to completion of any regulatory
process in order to effect such changes. No payment shall be made without
approval from CMS."
Approval was received from CMS on December 13, 2017, for an
effective date of July 1, 2017, in State Plan Amendment Transmittal Number
17-006.
Purpose: The purpose of this action is to add a new
section regarding supplemental payments for certain teaching hospitals.
A Liaison Committee on Medical Education (LCME) affiliated
teaching hospital, known as Sentara Norfolk General, and a LCME affiliated
teaching hospital, known as Carilion Medical Center, will receive quarterly
supplemental payments effective July 1, 2017, for inpatient services.
Sentara Norfolk General is located in Planning District 23 and
Carilion Medical Center is located in Planning District 5. The implementation
of these supplemental payments is essential to protect the health, safety, and
welfare of citizens by increasing access to care for the citizens of the
Commonwealth. These two primary teaching hospitals are affiliated with public
medical schools that will transfer the funds to the department for the state
share for these payments.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
regulatory action is being promulgated as a fast-track rulemaking action
because it is not expected to be controversial as it increases access to
medical care without increasing state costs. These changes have already been
approved by CMS and comply with the state Appropriations Act.
Substance: Effective July 1, 2017, supplemental payments
to Sentara Norfolk General and Carilion Medical Center will be made quarterly.
The supplemental payments shall be calculated based on inpatient services
rendered during the quarter equal to the difference between the hospital's
Medicaid payments and the hospital's disproportionate share hospital (DSH)
payment limit for the most recent year for which the DSH payment has been calculated
divided by four.
The maximum aggregate payments to all qualifying hospitals
shall not exceed the available upper payment limit per state fiscal year.
Issues: The primary advantage of this regulatory action
is that it increases access to medical care without increasing state costs.
These changes create no disadvantages to the public, the agency, the
Commonwealth, or the regulated community.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. Chapter 836,
Item 306.RRR.6.a, of the 2017 Acts of Assembly1 requires that the
Department of Medical Assistance Services (DMAS) "promulgate regulations
to make supplemental Medicaid payments to the primary teaching hospitals
affiliated with a Liaison Committee on Medical Education (LCME) accredited
medical school located in Planning District 23 that is a political subdivision
of the Commonwealth and an LCME accredited medical school located in Planning
District 5 that has a partnership with a public university."
Thus, on behalf of the Board of Medical Assistance Services,
the Director of DMAS proposes to add a section to this regulation that
specifies qualifying criteria, reimbursement methodology, and maximum aggregate
payments for such supplemental Medicaid payments.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. The primary teaching hospital
affiliated with an LCME accredited medical school located in Planning District
23 is Sentara Norfolk General, which is affiliated with Eastern Virginia
Medical School. The primary teaching hospital affiliated with an LCME
accredited medical school located in Planning District 5 is Carilion Medical
Center in Roanoke, which is affiliated with Virginia Tech.
According to DMAS, the two hospitals are considered safety net
hospitals for their area, and serve a disproportionate number of patients
without insurance and ability to pay. The supplemental payments are not tied to
providing specific services, but help pay unreimbursed costs such as for
indigent patients.
The proposed action would help Sentara Norfolk General and
Carilion Medical Center obtain approximately $41 million of federal funds
annually without increasing costs for the Commonwealth. As these funds help
provide healthcare services for Virginians without increasing costs for the
state, the proposed action would create a net benefit for the Commonwealth.
Businesses and Entities Affected. The proposed amendments
primarily affect two hospitals: Sentara Norfolk General and Carilion Medical
Center.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendments
particularly affect hospitals located in Norfolk and Roanoke. Thus, the
proposals particularly affect those localities and other nearby localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed action would help
the two hospitals gain significant federal funding that could be used in part
to hire additional staff.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The two
hospitals are private. The proposed action would increase their funding, and
would likely increase their value.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendments do not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia, small
business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates, that
(i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendments do not affect
costs for small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendments do not adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
other entities.
______________________________
1See
https://budget.lis.virginia.gov/item/2017/1/HB1500/Chapter/1/306/
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
agency has reviewed the economic impact analysis prepared by the Department of
Planning and Budget and raises no issues with this analysis.
Summary:
The amendments add language pertaining to supplemental
payments made to primary teaching hospitals affiliated with Liaison Committee
on Medical Education (LCME) accredited medical schools in Planning Districts 5
and 23 effective July 1, 2017.
12VAC30-70-411. Supplemental payments for certain teaching
hospitals.
A. Effective for dates of service on or after July 1,
2017, quarterly supplemental payments will be issued to qualifying private
hospitals for inpatient services rendered during the quarter.
B. Qualifying criteria. The primary teaching hospitals affiliated
with a Liaison Committee on Medical Education (LCME) accredited medical school
located in Planning District 23 that is a political subdivision of the
Commonwealth and an LCME accredited medical school located in Planning District
5 that has a partnership with a public university.
C. Reimbursement methodology. Each qualifying hospital
shall receive quarterly supplemental payments for the inpatient services
rendered during the quarter equal to the difference between the hospital's
Medicaid payments and the hospital's disproportionate share limit (Omnibus
Budget Reconciliation Act 93 disproportionate share hospital limit) for the
most recent year for which the disproportionate share limit has been calculated
divided by four. The supplemental payment amount will be determined prior to the
beginning of the fiscal year.
D. Limit. Maximum aggregate payments to all qualifying
hospitals shall not exceed the available upper payment limit per state fiscal
year.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5393; Filed August 9, 2018, 8:51 a.m.
TITLE 12. HEALTH
DEPARTMENT OF MEDICAL ASSISTANCE SERVICES
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 12VAC30-80. Methods and
Standards for Establishing Payment Rates; Other Types of Care (amending 12VAC30-80-30).
Statutory Authority: § 32.1-325 of the Code of
Virginia; 42 USC § 1396 et seq.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: Emily McClellan, Regulatory Supervisor,
Policy Division, Department of Medical Assistance Services, 600 East Broad
Street, Suite 1300, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 371-4300, FAX (804)
786-1680, or email emily.mcclellan@dmas.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 32.1-325 of the Code of Virginia grants
to the Board of Medical Assistance Services the authority to administer and
amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance. Section 32.1-324 of the Code of
Virginia authorizes the Director of the Department of Medical Assistance Services
(DMAS) to administer and amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance according
to the board's requirements. The Medicaid authority as established by
§ 1902(a) of the Social Security Act (42 USC § 1396) provides
governing authority for payments for services.
In addition, authority for this change is provided in Item 306
B 4 of Chapter 836 of the the 2017 Acts of Assembly, which states: "The
Department of Medical Assistance Service shall have the authority to increase
Medicaid payments for Type One hospitals and physicians consistent with the
appropriations to compensate for limits on disproportionate share hospital
(DSH) payments to Type One hospitals that the department would otherwise
make."
Purpose: The purpose of this action is to update the
physician supplemental payments for Type One physicians. The supplemental
payment calculation amount in the current regulatory text was effective April
8, 2014. This change allows for updated supplemental payments to Type One
physicians, which are expected to improve access to services for Medicaid
recipients.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
regulatory action is being promulgated as a fast-track rulemaking action
because it is not expected to be controversial. The fiscal or budgetary impacts
to DMAS are already provided in the agency's appropriations. These changes have
been mandated by the Appropriations Act and the Centers for Medicare and
Medicaid Services (CMS).
Substance: This regulatory action updates the physician
supplemental payments for physician practice plans affiliated with Type One
hospitals (state academic health systems). A Type One physician is a member of
a practice group organized by or under the control of a state academic health
system or an academic health system that operates under a state authority and
includes a hospital, which has entered into contractual agreements for the
assignment of payments in accordance with 42 CFR 447.10. These payments are
calculated as the difference between the maximum payment allowed and regular
payments. CMS has determined that the maximum allowed is the average commercial
rate (ACR).
This action will update the maximum rate to 256% of the
Medicare rate effective April 1, 2017, and 258% effective May 1, 2017, based on
the most recent information on the ACR furnished by the state academic health
systems and consistent with appropriate prior public notices.
Issues: Updating supplemental payment amounts for Type
One physicians is expected to be advantageous as it will improve access to
services.
These changes create no disadvantages to the public, the
agency, the Commonwealth, or the regulated community. The changes all implement
directives in the state budget and update existing regulations to conform with
the State Plan for Medical Assistance.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The proposed
regulation revises the maximum reimbursement for Type One physicians to 256% of
Medicare rates effective April 1, 2017 and 258% of Medicare rates effective May
1, 2017.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. Federal regulations allow Virginia
Medicaid to make supplemental payments for Type One physicians. A Type One physician
is a member of a practice group organized by or under the control of a state
academic health system or an academic health system that operates under state
authority. Type One physicians affected by this change are the physicians
affiliated with the University of Virginia (UVA) and the Virginia Commonwealth
University (VCU).
Supplemental payments are calculated as the difference between
the maximum payment allowed and regular payments. The maximum payment allowed
by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid (CMS) is the average commercial rate
(ACR). As the payments made by commercial providers change over time so does
the ACR. The ACR has increased from 143% of the Medicare rate in 2002, to
181% in 2012, to 197% of the Medicare rate in 2013, and to 201% of the Medicare
rate in 2014. The current regulation reflects 201% of the Medicare rate.
However, the ACR went up to 256% of the Medicare rate effective April 1, 2017
and 258% of the Medicare rate effective May 1, 2017 and CMS approved these
changes. Pursuant to the 2017 Acts of Assembly, Chapter 836, Item 306.B (4),
the new ACRs have already been applied. The proposed change will incorporate
the new ACRs in the regulations.
The proposed ACRs equate to an $8.4 million increase that
affects what hospitals receive for Type One physicians. Since one-half of
Virginia Medicaid is funded by federal matching funds, the state's share of
this amount is $4.2 million. However, the increase in the supplemental payments
to Type One physicians is offset by an equivalent reduction in the need for the
Disproportionate Share Hospital (DSH) payments Medicaid makes to the teaching
hospitals. In other words, while the composition of the payments made to the
Type One hospitals changes because of the new ACRs, the overall total payment
received by them from Medicaid remains the same absent any other changes. Thus,
the proposed ACRs do not cause an increase in overall payments to the teaching
hospitals.
Even though the new ACRs do not increase the total payment to
the teaching hospitals, the proposed regulation is beneficial in the sense that
it more accurately reflects the components of the total payment Type One
hospitals receive from Medicaid.
Businesses and Entities Affected. The proposed new ACRs apply
to two physician practice plans: one for UVA and one for VCU.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed changes apply to
two teaching hospitals which are located in the City of Richmond and the City
of Charlottesville.
Projected Impact on Employment. No impact on employment is
expected.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. No impact on
the use and value of private property is expected.
Real Estate Development Costs. No impact on real estate
development costs is expected.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendments do not impose
costs or other effects on small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. No adverse
impact on small businesses is expected.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed regulation does not have an impact on
non-small businesses.
Localities. The proposed regulation does not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed regulation does not adversely
affect other entities.
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
agency has reviewed the economic impact analysis prepared by the Department of
Planning and Budget and raises no issues with this analysis.
Summary:
The amendments update the supplemental payment amounts for
Type I physicians effective April 1, 2017, and May 1, 2017.
12VAC30-80-30. Fee-for-service providers.
A. Payment for the following services, except for physician
services, shall be the lower of the state agency fee schedule (12VAC30-80-190
has information about the state agency fee schedule) or actual charge (charge
to the general public). Except as otherwise noted in this section, state
developed fee schedule rates are the same for both governmental and private
individual practitioners. Fee schedules and any annual or periodic adjustments to
the fee schedules are published on the DMAS website at http://www.dmas.virginia.gov/.
1. Physicians' services. Payment for physician services shall
be the lower of the state agency fee schedule or actual charge (charge to the
general public).
2. Dentists' services.
3. Mental health services including: (i) community
mental health services, (ii) services of a licensed clinical psychologist,
(iii) mental health services provided by a physician, or (iv) peer support
services.
a. Services provided by licensed clinical psychologists shall
be reimbursed at 90% of the reimbursement rate for psychiatrists.
b. Services provided by independently enrolled licensed
clinical social workers, licensed professional counselors, or licensed
clinical nurse specialists-psychiatric shall be reimbursed at 75% of the
reimbursement rate for licensed clinical psychologists.
4. Podiatry.
5. Nurse-midwife services.
6. Durable medical equipment (DME) and supplies.
Definitions. The following words and terms when used in this
section shall have the following meanings unless the context clearly indicates
otherwise:
"DMERC" means the Durable Medical Equipment Regional
Carrier rate as published by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services at http://www.cms.gov/Medicare/Medicare-Fee-for-Service-Payment/DMEPOSFeeSched/DMEPOS-Fee-Schedule.html.
"HCPCS" means the Healthcare Common Procedure Coding
System, Medicare's National Level II Codes, HCPCS 2006 (Eighteenth edition), as
published by Ingenix, as may be periodically updated.
a. Obtaining prior authorization shall not guarantee Medicaid
reimbursement for DME.
b. The following shall be the reimbursement method used for
DME services:
(1) If the DME item has a DMERC rate, the reimbursement rate
shall be the DMERC rate minus 10%. For dates of service on or after July 1,
2014, DME items subject to the Medicare competitive bidding program shall be
reimbursed the lower of:
(a) The current DMERC rate minus 10%; or
(b) The average of the Medicare competitive bid rates in
Virginia markets.
(2) For DME items with no DMERC rate, the agency shall use the
agency fee schedule amount. The reimbursement rates for DME and supplies shall
be listed in the DMAS Medicaid Durable Medical Equipment (DME) and Supplies
Listing and updated periodically. The agency fee schedule shall be available on
the agency website at http://lis.virginia.gov/000/noc
/www.dmas.virginia.gov.
(3) If a DME item has no DMERC rate or agency fee schedule
rate, the reimbursement rate shall be the manufacturer's net charge to the
provider, less shipping and handling, plus 30%. The manufacturer's net charge
to the provider shall be the cost to the provider minus all available discounts
to the provider. Additional information specific to how DME providers,
including manufacturers who are enrolled as providers, establish and document
their cost or costs for DME codes that do not have established rates can be
found in the relevant agency guidance document.
c. DMAS shall have the authority to amend the agency fee
schedule as it deems appropriate and with notice to providers. DMAS shall have
the authority to determine alternate pricing, based on agency research, for any
code that does not have a rate.
d. The reimbursement for incontinence supplies shall be by
selective contract. Pursuant to § 1915(a)(1)(B) of the Social Security Act
and 42 CFR 431.54(d), the Commonwealth assures that adequate services or
devices shall be available under such arrangements.
e. Certain durable medical equipment used for intravenous
therapy and oxygen therapy shall be bundled under specified procedure codes and
reimbursed as determined by the agency. Certain services or durable medical
equipment such as service maintenance agreements shall be bundled under
specified procedure codes and reimbursed as determined by the agency.
(1) Intravenous therapies. The DME for a single therapy,
administered in one day, shall be reimbursed at the established service day
rate for the bundled durable medical equipment and the standard pharmacy
payment, consistent with the ingredient cost as described in 12VAC30-80-40,
plus the pharmacy service day and dispensing fee. Multiple applications of the
same therapy shall be included in one service day rate of reimbursement.
Multiple applications of different therapies administered in one day shall be
reimbursed for the bundled durable medical equipment service day rate as
follows: the most expensive therapy shall be reimbursed at 100% of cost; the
second and all subsequent most expensive therapies shall be reimbursed at 50%
of cost. Multiple therapies administered in one day shall be reimbursed at the
pharmacy service day rate plus 100% of every active therapeutic ingredient in
the compound (at the lowest ingredient cost methodology) plus the appropriate
pharmacy dispensing fee.
(2) Respiratory therapies. The DME for oxygen therapy shall
have supplies or components bundled under a service day rate based on oxygen
liter flow rate or blood gas levels. Equipment associated with respiratory
therapy may have ancillary components bundled with the main component for reimbursement.
The reimbursement shall be a service day per diem rate for rental of equipment
or a total amount of purchase for the purchase of equipment. Such respiratory
equipment shall include oxygen tanks and tubing, ventilators, noncontinuous
ventilators, and suction machines. Ventilators, noncontinuous ventilators, and
suction machines may be purchased based on the individual patient's medical
necessity and length of need.
(3) Service maintenance agreements. Provision shall be made
for a combination of services, routine maintenance, and supplies, to be known
as agreements, under a single reimbursement code only for equipment that is
recipient owned. Such bundled agreements shall be reimbursed either monthly or
in units per year based on the individual agreement between the DME provider
and DMAS. Such bundled agreements may apply to, but not necessarily be limited
to, either respiratory equipment or apnea monitors.
7. Local health services.
8. Laboratory services (other than inpatient hospital). The
agency's rates for clinical laboratory services were set as of July 1, 2014,
and are effective for services on or after that date.
9. Payments to physicians who handle laboratory specimens, but
do not perform laboratory analysis (limited to payment for handling).
10. X-ray services.
11. Optometry services.
12. Reserved.
13. Home health services. Effective June 30, 1991, cost
reimbursement for home health services is eliminated. A rate per visit by
discipline shall be established as set forth by 12VAC30-80-180.
14. Physical therapy; occupational therapy; and speech,
hearing, language disorders services when rendered to noninstitutionalized
recipients.
15. Clinic services, as defined under 42 CFR 440.90, except
for services in ambulatory surgery clinics reimbursed under 12VAC30-80-35.
16. Supplemental payments for services provided by Type I
physicians.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS provides supplemental payments to Type I
physicians for furnished services provided on or after July 2, 2002. A Type I
physician is a member of a practice group, organized by or under the
control of a state academic health system or an academic health system that
operates under a state authority and includes a hospital, who has entered into
contractual agreements for the assignment of payments in accordance with
42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective July 2, 2002, the supplemental payment amount
for Type I physician services shall be the difference between the Medicaid
payments otherwise made for Type I physician services and Medicare rates.
Effective August 13, 2002, the supplemental payment amount for Type I physician
services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made
for physician services and 143% of Medicare rates. Effective January 3, 2012,
the supplemental payment amount for Type I physician services shall be the
difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for physician services
and 181% of Medicare rates. Effective January 1, 2013, the supplemental payment
amount for Type I physician services shall be the difference between the
Medicaid payments otherwise made for physician services and 197% of Medicare
rates. Effective April 8, 2014, the supplemental payment amount for Type I
physician services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments
otherwise made for physician services and 201% of Medicare rates.
c. b. The methodology for determining the
Medicare equivalent of the average commercial rate is described in
12VAC30-80-300.
d. c. Supplemental payments shall be made
quarterly no later than 90 days after the end of the quarter.
e. Payment will not be made to the extent that the payment
would duplicate payments based on physician costs covered by the supplemental
payments. d. Effective April 1, 2017, the supplemental payment amount
for Type I physician services shall be the difference between the Medicaid
payments otherwise made for physician services and 256% of Medicare rates.
Effective May 1, 2017, the supplemental payment amount for Type I physician
services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made
for physician services and 258% of Medicare rates.
17. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
at Virginia freestanding children's hospitals.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS provides supplemental payments to Virginia
freestanding children's hospital physicians providing services at freestanding
children's hospitals with greater than 50% Medicaid inpatient utilization in
state fiscal year 2009 for furnished services provided on or after July 1,
2011. A freestanding children's hospital physician is a member of a practice
group (i) organized by or under control of a qualifying Virginia freestanding
children's hospital, or (ii) who has entered into contractual agreements
for provision of physician services at the qualifying Virginia freestanding
children's hospital and that is designated in writing by the Virginia
freestanding children's hospital as a practice plan for the quarter for which
the supplemental payment is made subject to DMAS approval. The freestanding
children's hospital physicians also must have entered into contractual
agreements with the practice plan for the assignment of payments in accordance
with 42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective July 1, 2011, the supplemental payment amount for
freestanding children's hospital physician services shall be the difference
between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for freestanding children's
hospital physician services and 143% of Medicare rates as defined in the
supplemental payment calculation described in the Medicare equivalent of the
average commercial rate methodology (see 12VAC30-80-300), subject to the
following reduction. Final payments shall be reduced on a prorated basis so
that total payments for freestanding children's hospital physician services are
$400,000 less annually than would be calculated based on the formula in the
previous sentence. Effective July 1, 2015, the supplemental payment amount for
freestanding children's hospital physician services shall be the difference
between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for freestanding children's
hospital physician services and 178% of Medicare rates as defined in the supplemental
payment calculation for Type I physician services. Payments shall be made on
the same schedule as Type I physicians.
18. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
affiliated with Eastern Virginia Medical Center.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, the Department of Medical Assistance Services
provides supplemental payments to physicians affiliated with Eastern Virginia
Medical Center for furnished services provided on or after October 1, 2012. A
physician affiliated with Eastern Virginia Medical Center is a physician who is
employed by a publicly funded medical school that is a political subdivision of
the Commonwealth of Virginia, who provides clinical services through the faculty
practice plan affiliated with the publicly funded medical school, and who has
entered into contractual arrangements for the assignment of payments in
accordance with 42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective October 1, 2015, the supplemental payment amount
shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for
physician services and 137% of Medicare rates. The methodology for determining
the Medicare equivalent of the average commercial rate is described in
12VAC30-80-300.
c. Supplemental payments shall be made quarterly, no later
than 90 days after the end of the quarter.
19. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
at freestanding children's hospitals serving children in Planning District 8.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS shall make supplemental payments for physicians
employed at a freestanding children's hospital serving children in Planning
District 8 with more than 50% Medicaid inpatient utilization in fiscal year 2014.
This applies to physician practices affiliated with Children's National Health
System.
b. The supplemental payment amount for qualifying physician
services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made
and 178% of Medicare rates but no more than $551,000 for all qualifying
physicians. The methodology for determining allowable percent of Medicare rates
is based on the Medicare equivalent of the average commercial rate described in
this chapter.
c. Supplemental payments shall be made quarterly no later than
90 days after the end of the quarter. Any quarterly payment that would have
been due prior to the approval date shall be made no later than 90 days after
the approval date.
20. Supplemental payments to nonstate government-owned or operated
clinics.
a. In addition to payments for clinic services specified
elsewhere in the regulations this chapter, DMAS provides
supplemental payments to qualifying nonstate government-owned or
government-operated clinics for outpatient services provided to Medicaid
patients on or after July 2, 2002. Clinic means a facility that is not part of
a hospital but is organized and operated to provide medical care to
outpatients. Outpatient services include those furnished by or under the
direction of a physician, dentist or other medical professional acting within
the scope of his license to an eligible individual. Effective July 1, 2005, a
qualifying clinic is a clinic operated by a community services board. The state
share for supplemental clinic payments will be funded by general fund
appropriations.
b. The amount of the supplemental payment made to each
qualifying nonstate government-owned or government-operated clinic is
determined by:
(1) Calculating for each clinic the annual difference between
the upper payment limit attributed to each clinic according to subdivision 20 d
of this subsection and the amount otherwise actually paid for the services by
the Medicaid program;
(2) Dividing the difference determined in subdivision 20 b (1)
of this subsection for each qualifying clinic by the aggregate difference for
all such qualifying clinics; and
(3) Multiplying the proportion determined in subdivision 20 b
(2) of this subsection by the aggregate upper payment limit amount for all such
clinics as determined in accordance with 42 CFR 447.321 less all payments made
to such clinics other than under this section.
c. Payments for furnished services made under this section
will be made annually in a lump sum during the last quarter of the fiscal year.
d. To determine the aggregate upper payment limit referred to
in subdivision 20 b (3) of this subsection, Medicaid payments to nonstate
government-owned or government-operated clinics will be divided by the
"additional factor" whose calculation is described in 12VAC30-80-190
B 2 in regard to the state agency fee schedule for Resource Based Relative
Value Scale. Medicaid payments will be estimated using payments for dates of
service from the prior fiscal year adjusted for expected claim payments.
Additional adjustments will be made for any program changes in Medicare or
Medicaid payments.
21. Personal assistance services (PAS) for individuals
enrolled in the Medicaid Buy-In program described in 12VAC30-60-200. These
services are reimbursed in accordance with the state agency fee schedule
described in 12VAC30-80-190. The state agency fee schedule is published on the
DMAS website at http://www.dmas.virginia.gov/.
B. Hospice services payments must be no lower than the
amounts using the same methodology used under Part A of Title XVIII, and take
into account the room and board furnished by the facility, equal to at least
95% of the rate that would have been paid by the state under the plan for
facility services in that facility for that individual. Hospice services shall
be paid according to the location of the service delivery and not the location
of the agency's home office.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5218; Filed August 9, 2018, 10:13 a.m.
TITLE 12. HEALTH
DEPARTMENT OF MEDICAL ASSISTANCE SERVICES
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 12VAC30-80. Methods and
Standards for Establishing Payment Rates; Other Types of Care (amending 12VAC30-80-30).
Statutory Authority: § 32.1-325 of the Code of
Virginia; 42 USC § 1396 et seq.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: Emily McClellan, Regulatory Supervisor,
Policy Division, Department of Medical Assistance Services, 600 East Broad
Street, Suite 1300, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 371-4300, FAX (804)
786-1680, or email emily.mcclellan@dmas.virginia.gov.
Basis: Section 32.1-325 of the Code of Virginia grants
to the Board of Medical Assistance Services the authority to administer and
amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance. Section 32.1-324 of the Code of
Virginia authorizes the Director of the Department of Medical Assistance
Services (DMAS) to administer and amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance
according to the board's requirements. The Medicaid authority as established by
§ 1902(a) of the Social Security Act (42 USC § 1396) provides governing
authority for payments for services.
Amended regulations (12VAC30-80-30 A 21) were required by Item
301 DDD 4 of Chapter 665 of the 2015 Acts of Assembly, Item 306 RRR 4 of
Chapter 780 of the 2016 Acts of Assembly, and Item 306 RRR 4 of Chapter 836 of
the 2017 Acts of Assembly, which state that DMAS shall have the authority to
"amend the State Plan for Medical Assistance Services to implement a
supplemental payment for clinic services furnished by the Virginia Department
of Health (VDH) effective July 1, 2015. The total supplemental Medicaid payment
shall be based on the Upper Payment Limit approved by the Centers for Medicare
and Medicaid Services and all other Medicaid payments. VDH is required to
transfer funds to the department funds already appropriated to VDH to cover the
non-federal share of the Medicaid payments."
Purpose: The purpose of this action is to implement the
provider reimbursement changes required by Item 301 of Chapter 665 of the 2015
Acts of Assembly, Item 306 of Chapter 780 of the 2016 Acts of Assembly, and
Item 306 of Chapter 836 of the 2017 Acts of Assembly.
This action also brings state regulations into line with
federal rules and current Virginia practice. The action is essential to protect
the health, safety, and welfare of citizens of the Commonwealth in that these
reimbursement rules help to ensure the continued financial viability of the
Virginia Medicaid Program.
All of the changes have been reviewed and approved by the
Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS).
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
regulatory action is being promulgated as a fast-track rulemaking action
because it is not expected to be controversial. The fiscal or budgetary impact
to DMAS is already provided in the agency's appropriations.
The reimbursement changes initially were implemented through
the Appropriations Act. Additionally, the changes are expected to improve
access to services, and members of the public are expected to support these
regulatory changes that may positively impact a disadvantaged population.
Substance: These changes affect supplemental payments
for qualifying state-owned or state-operated clinics. A clinic is a facility
that provides medical care to outpatients but is not part of a hospital.
Currently, a regulation does not exist for supplemental payments to state-owned
or state-operated clinics. This action will allow for supplemental payments for
clinic services provided by the Virginia Department of Health. The funds for
these changes were provided in the 2017 Acts of Assembly.
Issues: Implementing supplemental payments to qualifying
state-owned or state-operated clinics for outpatient services provided to
Medicaid patients is expected to be advantageous as it will improve access to
services.
These changes create no disadvantages to the public, the
agency, the Commonwealth, or the regulated community. The changes all implement
directives in the state budget or make changes required by CMS.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. Pursuant to
Chapter 665, Item 301.DDD.4, of the 2015 Acts of the Assembly; Chapter 780,
Item 306.RRR.4, of the 2016 Act of the Assembly; and Chapter 836, Item 306
RRR.4, of the 2017 Acts of the Assembly, the Director of the Department of
Medical Assistance Services (Director) proposes to amend the State Plan for
Medical Assistance (State Plan). Specifically, this amendment will set
parameters for supplemental Medicaid payments for outpatient clinical services
furnished by the Virginia Department of Health (VDH).
Result of Analysis. Benefits likely outweigh costs for these
proposed regulatory changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. In the last three appropriations
acts, the General Assembly (GA) has authorized supplemental Medicaid payments
for state-owned clinics operated under the auspices of VDH and directed the
Department of Medical Assistance Services (DMAS) to amend the State Plan to
implement those supplemental payments effective July 1, 2015. The GA further
directed that "(t)he total supplemental payment shall be based on the
Upper Payment Limit approved by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services
and all other Medicaid payments. VDH is required to transfer funds to the
department [DMAS] funds already appropriated to VDH to cover the non-federal
share of the Medicaid payments." The Director now proposes an action to
harmonize this regulation with the changes made to the State Plan and already
approved by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services.
This change will allow VDH to receive greater reimbursement for
clinic services they provide. DMAS staff reports that VDH received $394,723 in
supplemental Medicaid payments during the last year and further reports that
they expect annual payments going forward would be roughly similar. Half of
these supplemental payments are state funds from existing VDH allocations and
half are federal matching funds. This regulatory change will benefit any
interested party who chooses to read the regulations as it conforms the
regulation with federal rules and Virginia statute and, therefore, eliminates
the possibility that discrepancies may cause confusion.
Businesses and Entities Affected. This proposed regulatory
action will affect all state-owned and VDH-operated clinics in the Commonwealth.
DMAS staff reports that VDH currently operates 130 such clinics.
Localities Particularly Affected. No localities will be
particularly affected by this proposed change.
Projected Impact on Employment. Employment in the Commonwealth
is unlikely to be significantly affected by this proposed regulation.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. This proposed
regulatory change is unlikely to affect the use or value of private property in
the Commonwealth.
Real Estate Development Costs. These proposed regulatory
changes are unlikely to affect real estate development costs in the
Commonwealth.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. No small businesses are likely to be
affected by this regulatory action.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. No small
businesses are likely to be affected by this regulatory action.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. No businesses are likely to suffer adverse impacts
on account of this proposed regulatory action.
Localities. No locality is likely to suffer adverse impacts on
account of this proposed regulatory action.
Other Entities. No other entities are likely to suffer adverse
impacts on account of this proposed regulatory action.
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
agency has reviewed the economic impact analysis prepared by the Department of
Planning and Budget and raises no issues with this analysis.
Summary:
The amendments implement supplemental payments to
state-owned or state-operated clinics.
12VAC30-80-30. Fee-for-service providers.
A. Payment for the following services, except for physician
services, shall be the lower of the state agency fee schedule (12VAC30-80-190
has information about the state agency fee schedule) or actual charge (charge
to the general public). Except as otherwise noted in this section, state
developed fee schedule rates are the same for both governmental and private
individual practitioners. Fee schedules and any annual or periodic adjustments
to the fee schedules are published on the DMAS website at http://www.dmas.virginia.gov/.
1. Physicians' services. Payment for physician services shall
be the lower of the state agency fee schedule or actual charge (charge to the
general public).
2. Dentists' services.
3. Mental health services including: (i) community
mental health services, (ii) services of a licensed clinical psychologist,
(iii) mental health services provided by a physician, or (iv) peer support
services.
a. Services provided by licensed clinical psychologists shall
be reimbursed at 90% of the reimbursement rate for psychiatrists.
b. Services provided by independently enrolled licensed
clinical social workers, licensed professional counselors, or licensed
clinical nurse specialists-psychiatric shall be reimbursed at 75% of the
reimbursement rate for licensed clinical psychologists.
4. Podiatry.
5. Nurse-midwife services.
6. Durable medical equipment (DME) and supplies.
Definitions. The following words and terms when used in this section
shall have the following meanings unless the context clearly indicates
otherwise:
"DMERC" means the Durable Medical Equipment Regional
Carrier rate as published by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services at http://www.cms.gov/Medicare/Medicare-Fee-for-Service-Payment/DMEPOSFeeSched/DMEPOS-Fee-Schedule.html.
"HCPCS" means the Healthcare Common Procedure Coding
System, Medicare's National Level II Codes, HCPCS 2006 (Eighteenth edition), as
published by Ingenix, as may be periodically updated.
a. Obtaining prior authorization shall not guarantee Medicaid
reimbursement for DME.
b. The following shall be the reimbursement method used for
DME services:
(1) If the DME item has a DMERC rate, the reimbursement rate
shall be the DMERC rate minus 10%. For dates of service on or after July 1,
2014, DME items subject to the Medicare competitive bidding program shall be
reimbursed the lower of:
(a) The current DMERC rate minus 10%; or
(b) The average of the Medicare competitive bid rates in
Virginia markets.
(2) For DME items with no DMERC rate, the agency shall use the
agency fee schedule amount. The reimbursement rates for DME and supplies shall
be listed in the DMAS Medicaid Durable Medical Equipment (DME) and Supplies
Listing and updated periodically. The agency fee schedule shall be available on
the agency website at http://www.dmas.virginia.gov/.
(3) If a DME item has no DMERC rate or agency fee schedule
rate, the reimbursement rate shall be the manufacturer's net charge to the
provider, less shipping and handling, plus 30%. The manufacturer's net charge
to the provider shall be the cost to the provider minus all available discounts
to the provider. Additional information specific to how DME providers,
including manufacturers who are enrolled as providers, establish and document
their cost or costs for DME codes that do not have established rates can be
found in the relevant agency guidance document.
c. DMAS shall have the authority to amend the agency fee
schedule as it deems appropriate and with notice to providers. DMAS shall have
the authority to determine alternate pricing, based on agency research, for any
code that does not have a rate.
d. The reimbursement for incontinence supplies shall be by
selective contract. Pursuant to § 1915(a)(1)(B) of the Social Security Act
and 42 CFR 431.54(d), the Commonwealth assures that adequate services or
devices shall be available under such arrangements.
e. Certain durable medical equipment used for intravenous
therapy and oxygen therapy shall be bundled under specified procedure codes and
reimbursed as determined by the agency. Certain services or durable medical
equipment such as service maintenance agreements shall be bundled under
specified procedure codes and reimbursed as determined by the agency.
(1) Intravenous therapies. The DME for a single therapy, administered
in one day, shall be reimbursed at the established service day rate for the
bundled durable medical equipment and the standard pharmacy payment, consistent
with the ingredient cost as described in 12VAC30-80-40, plus the pharmacy
service day and dispensing fee. Multiple applications of the same therapy shall
be included in one service day rate of reimbursement. Multiple applications of
different therapies administered in one day shall be reimbursed for the bundled
durable medical equipment service day rate as follows: the most expensive
therapy shall be reimbursed at 100% of cost; the second and all subsequent most
expensive therapies shall be reimbursed at 50% of cost. Multiple therapies
administered in one day shall be reimbursed at the pharmacy service day rate
plus 100% of every active therapeutic ingredient in the compound (at the lowest
ingredient cost methodology) plus the appropriate pharmacy dispensing fee.
(2) Respiratory therapies. The DME for oxygen therapy shall
have supplies or components bundled under a service day rate based on oxygen
liter flow rate or blood gas levels. Equipment associated with respiratory
therapy may have ancillary components bundled with the main component for
reimbursement. The reimbursement shall be a service day per diem rate for
rental of equipment or a total amount of purchase for the purchase of
equipment. Such respiratory equipment shall include oxygen tanks and tubing,
ventilators, noncontinuous ventilators, and suction machines. Ventilators,
noncontinuous ventilators, and suction machines may be purchased based on the
individual patient's medical necessity and length of need.
(3) Service maintenance agreements. Provision shall be made
for a combination of services, routine maintenance, and supplies, to be known
as agreements, under a single reimbursement code only for equipment that is
recipient owned. Such bundled agreements shall be reimbursed either monthly or
in units per year based on the individual agreement between the DME provider
and DMAS. Such bundled agreements may apply to, but not necessarily be limited
to, either respiratory equipment or apnea monitors.
7. Local health services.
8. Laboratory services (other than inpatient hospital). The
agency's rates for clinical laboratory services were set as of July 1, 2014,
and are effective for services on or after that date.
9. Payments to physicians who handle laboratory specimens, but
do not perform laboratory analysis (limited to payment for handling).
10. X-ray services.
11. Optometry services.
12. Reserved.
13. Home health services. Effective June 30, 1991, cost
reimbursement for home health services is eliminated. A rate per visit by
discipline shall be established as set forth by 12VAC30-80-180.
14. Physical therapy; occupational therapy; and speech,
hearing, language disorders services when rendered to noninstitutionalized
recipients.
15. Clinic services, as defined under 42 CFR 440.90, except
for services in ambulatory surgery clinics reimbursed under 12VAC30-80-35.
16. Supplemental payments for services provided by Type I
physicians.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS provides supplemental payments to Type I
physicians for furnished services provided on or after July 2, 2002. A Type I
physician is a member of a practice group, organized by or under the
control of a state academic health system or an academic health system that
operates under a state authority and includes a hospital, who has entered into
contractual agreements for the assignment of payments in accordance with
42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective July 2, 2002, the supplemental payment amount for
Type I physician services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments
otherwise made for Type I physician services and Medicare rates. Effective
August 13, 2002, the supplemental payment amount for Type I physician services
shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for
physician services and 143% of Medicare rates. Effective January 3, 2012, the
supplemental payment amount for Type I physician services shall be the
difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for physician services
and 181% of Medicare rates. Effective January 1, 2013, the supplemental payment
amount for Type I physician services shall be the difference between the
Medicaid payments otherwise made for physician services and 197% of Medicare
rates. Effective April 8, 2014, the supplemental payment amount for Type I
physician services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments
otherwise made for physician services and 201% of Medicare rates.
c. The methodology for determining the Medicare equivalent of
the average commercial rate is described in 12VAC30-80-300.
d. Supplemental payments shall be made quarterly no later than
90 days after the end of the quarter.
e. Payment will not be made to the extent that the payment
would duplicate payments based on physician costs covered by the supplemental
payments.
17. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
at Virginia freestanding children's hospitals.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS provides supplemental payments to Virginia
freestanding children's hospital physicians providing services at freestanding
children's hospitals with greater than 50% Medicaid inpatient utilization in
state fiscal year 2009 for furnished services provided on or after July 1,
2011. A freestanding children's hospital physician is a member of a practice
group (i) organized by or under control of a qualifying Virginia freestanding
children's hospital, or (ii) who has entered into contractual agreements
for provision of physician services at the qualifying Virginia freestanding
children's hospital and that is designated in writing by the Virginia
freestanding children's hospital as a practice plan for the quarter for which
the supplemental payment is made subject to DMAS approval. The freestanding
children's hospital physicians also must have entered into contractual
agreements with the practice plan for the assignment of payments in accordance
with 42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective July 1, 2011, the supplemental payment amount for
freestanding children's hospital physician services shall be the difference
between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for freestanding children's
hospital physician services and 143% of Medicare rates as defined in the
supplemental payment calculation described in the Medicare equivalent of the
average commercial rate methodology (see 12VAC30-80-300), subject to the following
reduction. Final payments shall be reduced on a prorated basis so that total
payments for freestanding children's hospital physician services are $400,000
less annually than would be calculated based on the formula in the previous
sentence. Effective July 1, 2015, the supplemental payment amount for
freestanding children's hospital physician services shall be the difference
between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for freestanding children's
hospital physician services and 178% of Medicare rates as defined in the
supplemental payment calculation for Type I physician services. Payments shall
be made on the same schedule as Type I physicians.
18. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
affiliated with Eastern Virginia Medical Center.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, the Department of Medical Assistance Services
provides supplemental payments to physicians affiliated with Eastern Virginia
Medical Center for furnished services provided on or after October 1, 2012. A
physician affiliated with Eastern Virginia Medical Center is a physician who is
employed by a publicly funded medical school that is a political subdivision of
the Commonwealth of Virginia, who provides clinical services through the
faculty practice plan affiliated with the publicly funded medical school, and
who has entered into contractual arrangements for the assignment of payments in
accordance with 42 CFR 447.10.
b. Effective October 1, 2015, the supplemental payment amount
shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made for
physician services and 137% of Medicare rates. The methodology for determining
the Medicare equivalent of the average commercial rate is described in
12VAC30-80-300.
c. Supplemental payments shall be made quarterly, no later
than 90 days after the end of the quarter.
19. Supplemental payments for services provided by physicians
at freestanding children's hospitals serving children in Planning District 8.
a. In addition to payments for physician services specified
elsewhere in this chapter, DMAS shall make supplemental payments for physicians
employed at a freestanding children's hospital serving children in Planning
District 8 with more than 50% Medicaid inpatient utilization in fiscal year
2014. This applies to physician practices affiliated with Children's National
Health System.
b. The supplemental payment amount for qualifying physician
services shall be the difference between the Medicaid payments otherwise made
and 178% of Medicare rates but no more than $551,000 for all qualifying
physicians. The methodology for determining allowable percent of Medicare rates
is based on the Medicare equivalent of the average commercial rate described in
this chapter.
c. Supplemental payments shall be made quarterly no later than
90 days after the end of the quarter. Any quarterly payment that would have
been due prior to the approval date shall be made no later than 90 days after
the approval date.
20. Supplemental payments to nonstate government-owned or
operated clinics.
a. In addition to payments for clinic services specified
elsewhere in the regulations this chapter, DMAS provides
supplemental payments to qualifying nonstate government-owned or
government-operated clinics for outpatient services provided to Medicaid
patients on or after July 2, 2002. Clinic means a facility that is not part of
a hospital but is organized and operated to provide medical care to
outpatients. Outpatient services include those furnished by or under the
direction of a physician, dentist or other medical professional acting within
the scope of his license to an eligible individual. Effective July 1, 2005, a
qualifying clinic is a clinic operated by a community services board. The state
share for supplemental clinic payments will be funded by general fund
appropriations.
b. The amount of the supplemental payment made to each
qualifying nonstate government-owned or government-operated clinic is
determined by:
(1) Calculating for each clinic the annual difference between
the upper payment limit attributed to each clinic according to subdivision 20 d
of this subsection and the amount otherwise actually paid for the services by
the Medicaid program;
(2) Dividing the difference determined in subdivision 20 b (1)
of this subsection for each qualifying clinic by the aggregate difference for
all such qualifying clinics; and
(3) Multiplying the proportion determined in subdivision 20 b
(2) of this subsection by the aggregate upper payment limit amount for all such
clinics as determined in accordance with 42 CFR 447.321 less all payments made
to such clinics other than under this section.
c. Payments for furnished services made under this section
will be made annually in a lump sum during the last quarter of the fiscal year.
d. To determine the aggregate upper payment limit referred to
in subdivision 20 b (3) of this subsection, Medicaid payments to nonstate
government-owned or government-operated clinics will be divided by the
"additional factor" whose calculation is described in 12VAC30-80-190
B 2 in regard to the state agency fee schedule for Resource Based Relative
Value Scale. Medicaid payments will be estimated using payments for dates of
service from the prior fiscal year adjusted for expected claim payments.
Additional adjustments will be made for any program changes in Medicare or
Medicaid payments.
21. Personal assistance services (PAS) for individuals
enrolled in the Medicaid Buy-In program described in 12VAC30-60-200. These
services are reimbursed in accordance with the state agency fee schedule
described in 12VAC30-80-190. The state agency fee schedule is published on the
DMAS website at http://www.dmas.virginia.gov/.
22. Supplemental payments to state-owned or state-operated
clinics.
a. Effective for dates of service on or after July 1, 2015,
DMAS shall make supplemental payments to qualifying state-owned or
state-operated clinics for outpatient services provided to Medicaid patients on
or after July 1, 2015. Clinic means a facility that is not part of a hospital
but is organized and operated to provide medical care to outpatients.
Outpatient services include those furnished by or under the direction of a
physician, dentist, or other medical professional acting within the scope of
his license to an eligible individual.
b. The amount of the supplemental payment made to each
qualifying state-owned or state-operated clinic is determined by calculating
for each clinic the annual difference between the upper payment limit
attributed to each clinic according to subdivision 19 b of this subsection and
the amount otherwise actually paid for the services by the Medicaid program.
c. Payments for furnished services made under this section
shall be made annually in lump sum payments to each clinic.
d. To determine the upper payment limit for each clinic
referred to in subdivision 19 b of this subsection, the state payment rate
schedule shall be compared to the Medicare resource-based relative value scale
nonfacility fee schedule per Current Procedural Terminology code for a base
period of claims. The base period claims shall be extracted from the Medical
Management Information System and exclude crossover claims.
B. Hospice services payments must be no lower than the amounts
using the same methodology used under Part A of Title XVIII, and take into
account the room and board furnished by the facility, equal to at least 95% of
the rate that would have been paid by the state under the plan for facility
services in that facility for that individual. Hospice services shall be paid
according to the location of the service delivery and not the location of the
agency's home office.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5282; Filed August 9, 2018, 10:19 a.m.
TITLE 13. HOUSING
VIRGINIA MANUFACTURED HOUSING BOARD
Proposed Regulation
Title of Regulation: 13VAC6-20. Manufactured Housing Licensing and Transaction Recovery Fund Regulations (amending 13VAC6-20-10, 13VAC6-20-30, 13VAC6-20-50, 13VAC6-20-60, 13VAC6-20-80, 13VAC6-20-90, 13VAC6-20-100, 13VAC6-20-170, 13VAC6-20-320).
Statutory Authority: § 36-85.18 of the Code of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information:
October 1, 2018 - 10 a.m. - Virginia Housing Center, 4224 Cox Road, Glen Allen, VA 23060
Public Comment Deadline: November 2, 2018.
Agency Contact: Kyle T. Flanders, Senior Policy Analyst, Policy Office, Virginia Department of Housing and Community Development, 600 East Main Street, Suite 300, Richmond, VA 23219, telephone (804) 786-6761, FAX (804) 371-3090, or email kyle.flanders@dhcd.virginia.gov.
Basis: The legal authority for amendments to the regulation is found in § 36-85.18 of the Code of Virginia. Section 36-85.18 directs the board to promulgate regulations for the licensing of manufactured home manufacturers, dealers, brokers, and salespersons; the establishment and administration of a recovery fund; the resolution of complaints; making case decisions in accordance with the Administrative Process Act; and the levying and collection of fees sufficient to cover the expenses for the administration of the program.
Purpose: Administration and enforcement of the regulations by the Virginia Manufactured Housing Board and department has resulted in the identification of sections that need to be clarified, are out of date, or contain unnecessary restrictions. The board proposes to review issues related to licensing requirements for the manufactured housing industry members that will provide better protection to consumers without imposing unnecessary regulatory burdens on the licensees. The amended regulations will better define the parameters for warranties on homes and when and what disclosures must be given to buyers.
Substance: This regulatory action will (i) add "date of delivery" as a defined term to clarify the warranty period for a manufactured home and for easy reference; (ii) eliminate unnecessary biographical information of individuals applying for dealer, sales person, and broker licenses, such as weight, height, eye color, and sex; (iii) replace "Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles" with "Virginia Motor Vehicle Dealer Board"; (iv) replace the nondefined term "noncompliance" with the defined term "defect"; and (v) eliminate the requirement for a dealer to inspect "furniture" supplied with a home.
The action will also amend the list of prohibited conduct by regulants; identify specific items to be included on a sales contract, including the total cost of the contract, if the home is new or used, and the nominal house size; and require manufacturers to advise consumers that the dealer may retain damages and to notify consumers of the dispute resolution program.
Issues: The proposed revisions provide enhanced consumer protection by adding three additional items to the list of prohibited conduct by regulants. The revisions add specific items to be included on a sales contract, which lack clarity in the current regulations. These items include the total cost of the contract, specify if the home is new or used, and specify the nominal house size. The revisions assist in protecting consumers by requiring manufacturers to provide statements to the consumer indicating that the dealer may retain damages and notifying them of the dispute resolution program.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The Manufactured Housing Board (Board) proposes to amend its regulation to: 1) add a clarifying definition, 2) update obsolete references in regulatory text, 3) eliminate unnecessary requirements that manufactured housing salesmen provide biographical information, and 4) add failure to perform a written contract1 as grounds for disciplinary action.
Result of Analysis. Benefits likely outweigh costs for all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. The Board last updated this regulation in an action that was initiated in 2008. The Board now proposes a clarifying amendment to add a definition for "date of delivery," proposes to remove requirements that biographical information such as weight, height and eye color be provided on applications for licensure and also proposes to replace obsolete references to the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles with references to the Virginia Motor Vehicle Dealer Board.2 Changes such as these do not add any new regulatory requirements and, so, no regulated entity is likely to incur additional costs. Removing obsolete and now incorrect information from this regulation will benefit readers as this will eliminate any possible confusion about who registers manufactured housing dealers and brokers.
The Board also proposes to add failure to perform a written contract containing enumerated minimum requirements to the list of grounds for disciplining regulated entities. This change will likely benefit manufactured housing buyers as it will allow the Board to take action, up to and including license revocation, if a licensee defrauds a customer by failing to deliver on a contract.
Businesses and Entities Affected. This regulatory action will affect all Board licensees as well as their customers. Board staff reports that the Board currently licenses 27 manufacturers, 15 brokers, 178 dealers and 317 salespeople
Localities Particularly Affected. No locality is likely to be particularly affected by these proposed regulatory changes.
Projected Impact on Employment. These proposed regulatory changes are unlikely to affect employment in the Commonwealth.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. These proposed regulatory changes are unlikely to affect the use or value of private property in the Commonwealth.
Real Estate Development Costs. These proposed regulatory changes are unlikely to affect real estate development costs in the Commonwealth.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia, small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates, that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500 full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. No small businesses are likely to incur any additional costs on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. No small businesses are likely to incur any additional costs on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. No businesses are likely to incur any additional costs on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Localities. Localities in the Commonwealth are unlikely to see any adverse impacts on account of these proposed regulatory changes.
Other Entities. No other entities are likely to be adversely affected by these proposed changes.
___________________________
1Such contracts must contain specified minimum requirements to include: 1) a statement of the total cost of the contract, 2) a listing of specified materials and work to be performed as well as specification as to who will supply materials and who will perform the work, 3) the name, address and phone number of the Board licensee performing the contract, 4) the make and model of the home to be delivered, 5) a statement indicating whether the home is new or used, 6) a listing of the length and width of the home to be delivered under the contract, 7) the date of manufacture and the serial number of the home except when that information is not known because the home has not been built yet, 8) a statement notifying consumers of the limitations on liability for damages to the home and 9) a statement notifying consumers of the available dispute resolution program.
2The Virginia Motor Vehicle Dealer Board now registers manufactured housing dealers and brokers.
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The agency concurs with the economic impact analysis.
Summary:
The proposed amendments include (i) clarifying the parameters for warranties on manufactured homes, (ii) eliminating unnecessary individual biographical information of license applicants, (iii) expanding the list of specific items that must be included on a sales contract, and (iv) providing when and what disclosures must be given to buyers.
Part I
General
13VAC6-20-10. Definitions.
The following words and terms when used in this chapter shall have the following meanings unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.
"Board" means the Virginia Manufactured Housing Board.
"Buyer" means the person who purchases at retail from a dealer or manufacturer a manufactured home for personal use as a residence or other related use.
"Claimant" means any person who has filed a verified claim under Chapter 4.2 (§ 36-85.16 et seq.) of Title 36 of the Code of Virginia.
"Code" means the appropriate standards of the Virginia Uniform Statewide Building Code (13VAC5-63) and the Manufactured Home Safety Regulations (13VAC5-95) adopted by the Board of Housing and Community Development and administered by the Department of Housing and Community Development pursuant to the National Manufactured Housing Construction and Safety Standards Act of 1974 (42 USC § 5401 et seq.) for manufactured homes.
"Controlling financial interest" means the direct or indirect ownership or control of a firm.
"Date of delivery" means the date on which all terms or conditions of the sales contract agreed to or required of the regulant have been completed.
"Dealer/manufacturer sales agreement" means a written contract or agreement between a manufactured housing manufacturer and a manufactured housing dealer whereby the dealer is granted the right to engage in the business of offering, selling, and servicing new manufactured homes of a particular line or make of the stated manufacturer of such line or make. The term shall include any severable part or parts of such sales agreement which separately provides for selling or servicing different lines or makes of the manufacturer.
"Defect" means any deficiency in or damage to materials or workmanship occurring in a manufactured home which has been reasonably maintained and cared for in normal use. The term also means any failure of any structural element, utility system or the inclusion of a component part of the manufactured home which fails to comply with the Code.
"Department" means the Department of Housing and Community Development.
"Director" means the Director of the Department of Housing and Community Development, or his the director's designee.
"Fund" or "recovery fund" means the Virginia Manufactured Housing Transaction Recovery Fund.
"HUD" means the United States U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development.
"Imminent safety hazard" means a hazard that presents an imminent and unreasonable risk of death or severe personal injury that may or may not be related to failure to comply with an applicable federal manufactured home construction or safety standard.
"Licensed" means the regulant has met all applicable requirements of this chapter, paid all required fees, and been authorized by the board to manufacture or offer for sale or sell manufactured homes in accordance with this chapter.
"Manufactured home" means a structure constructed to federal standards, transportable in one or more sections, which, in the traveling mode is eight feet or more in width and is 40 feet or more in length, or when erected on site, is 320 or more square feet, and which is built on a permanent chassis and designed to be used as a dwelling with or without a permanent foundation when connected to the required utilities, and includes the plumbing, heating, air conditioning, and electrical systems contained therein.
"Manufactured home broker" or "broker" means any person, partnership, association or corporation, resident or nonresident, who, for compensation or valuable consideration, sells or offers for sale, buys or offers to buy, negotiates the purchase or sale or exchange, or leases or offers to lease used manufactured homes that are owned by a party other than the broker.
"Manufactured home dealer" or "dealer" means any person engaged in the business of buying, selling, or dealing in manufactured homes or offering or displaying manufactured homes for sale in Virginia. Any person who buys, sells, or deals in three or more manufactured homes in any 12-month period shall be presumed to be a manufactured home dealer. The terms "selling" and "sale" include lease-purchase transactions. The term "manufactured home dealer" does not include banks and finance companies that acquire manufactured homes as an incident to their regular business.
"Manufactured home manufacturer" or "manufacturer" means any persons, resident or nonresident, who manufacture or assemble manufactured homes for sale in Virginia.
"Manufactured home salesperson" or "salesperson" means any person who for compensation or valuable consideration is employed either directly or indirectly by, or affiliated as an independent contractor with, a manufactured home dealer to sell or offer to sell; or to buy or offer to buy; or to negotiate the purchase, sale or exchange; or to lease or offer to lease new or used manufactured homes.
"New manufactured home" means any manufactured home that (i) has not been previously sold except in good faith for the purpose of resale, (ii) has not been previously occupied as a place of habitation, (iii) has not been previously used for commercial purposes such as offices or storage, and (iv) has not been titled by the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles and is still in the possession of the original dealer. If the home is later sold to another dealer and then sold to a consumer within two years of the date of manufacture, the home is still considered new and must continue to meet all state warranty requirements. However, if a home is sold from the original dealer to another dealer and it is more than two years after the date of manufacture, and it is then sold to a consumer, the home must be sold as "used" for warranty purposes. Notice of the "used" status of the manufactured home and how this status affects state warranty requirements must be provided, in writing, to the consumer prior to the closing of the sale.
"Person" means any individual, natural person, firm, partnership, association, corporation, legal representative, or other recognized legal entity.
"Regulant" means any person, firm, corporation, association, partnership, joint venture, or any other legal entity required by Chapter 4.2 (§ 36-85.16 et seq.) of Title 36 of the Code of Virginia to be licensed by the board.
"Regulations" or "these regulations" means this chapter, the Virginia Manufactured Housing Licensing and Transaction Recovery Fund Regulations.
"Reinstatement" means having a license restored to effectiveness after the expiration date has passed or license has been revoked or not renewed by the board.
"Relevant market area" means the geographical area established in the dealer/manufacturer sales agreement and agreed to by both the dealer and the manufacturer in the agreement.
"Renewal" means continuing the effectiveness of a license for another period of time.
"Responsible management" means the following individuals:
1. The sole proprietor of a sole proprietorship;
2. The partners of a general partnership;
3. The managing partners of a limited partnership;
4. The officers of a corporation;
5. The managers of a limited liability company;
6. The officers or directors of an association or both; and
7. Individuals in other business entities recognized under the laws of the Commonwealth as having a fiduciary responsibility to the firm.
"Responsible party" means a manufacturer, dealer, or supplier of manufactured homes.
"Set-up" means the operations performed at the occupancy site which render a manufactured home fit for habitation. Such operations include, but are not limited to, transportation, positioning, blocking, leveling, supporting, anchoring, connecting utility systems, making minor adjustments, or assembling multiple or expandable units. Such operations do not include lawful transportation services performed by public utilities operating under certificates or permits issued by the State Corporation Commission.
"Standards" means the Federal Manufactured Home Construction and Safety Standards adopted by the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development.
"Statement of Compliance" means the statement found on the initial license application and on the renewal application, that the regulant licensed by the board will comply with the Manufactured Housing Licensing and Transaction Recovery Fund Law, this chapter, and the orders of the board.
"Substantial identity of interest" means (i) a controlling financial interest by the individual or corporate principals of the manufactured home broker, dealer, or manufacturer whose license has been revoked or not renewed for cause by the board or (ii) substantially identical principals or officers as the manufactured home broker, dealer, or manufacturer whose license has been revoked or not renewed for cause by the board.
"Supplier" means the original producers of completed components, including refrigerators, stoves, water heaters, dishwashers, cabinets, air conditioners, heating units, and similar components, and materials such as floor coverings, paneling, siding, trusses, and similar materials, which are furnished to a manufacturer or a dealer for installation in the manufactured home prior to sale to a buyer.
"Used manufactured home" means any manufactured home other than a new home as defined in this section.
"Warranty" means any written assurance of the manufacturer, dealer, or supplier or any promise made by a regulant in connection with the sale of a manufactured home that becomes part of the basis of the sale. The term "warranty" pertains to the obligations of the regulant in relation to materials, workmanship, and fitness of a manufactured home for ordinary and reasonable use of the home for the term of the promise or assurance.
13VAC6-20-30. Application for licensing; renewal.
A. Application for license or renewal shall be on forms supplied by the department and may be submitted as designated in hard copy or by electronic means. All information required on the form shall be furnished by the applicant for the board's review.
B. Each application for original licensure shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Deposit in the Transaction Recovery Fund required by 13VAC6-20-420 A 1.
2. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 1.
3. Copy of the manufacturer's homeowner and installation manual or manuals.
4. Statement of Compliance compliance.
5. List of salespeople licensed in Virginia with the following biographical information for each:.
Date of birth
Sex
Weight
Height
Eye/hair color
C. The Department of Housing and Community Development will mail a notice of renewal to the licensee at the last known address of record. Licensees may submit renewals by mail or electronically. Failure to receive this notice shall not relieve the licensee of the obligation to renew. If the licensee does not receive the notice of renewal, a copy of the license may be substituted with the required fee. Each application for renewal shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 2.
2. If revised, a copy of the revised homeowner and installation manual or manuals.
3. Statement of Compliance compliance.
4. Updated list of salespeople employed.
Article 2
Dealers
13VAC6-20-50. License required; annual renewal.
A. Any person located in or outside of the Commonwealth buying or selling or offering or displaying manufactured homes for sale in Virginia and meeting the definition of a dealer in 13VAC6-20-10 shall apply to the board for a license. The license shall be displayed in a conspicuous place accessible to the public in the office of the business location. The license shall be issued for a term of one year from the date of issuance.
B. Each licensed dealer shall apply for license renewal annually, by application and accompanied by the required fee. Applicants for license renewal shall meet all the criteria for original licensing. Upon failure to renew, the license shall automatically expire.
C. Should the department fail to receive a licensed dealer's renewal form and appropriate fee within 30 days of the license expiration date, the dealer shall be required to reinstate the license according to the terms and conditions of Article 8 (13VAC6-20-201 et seq.) of this part.
D. For licensing purposes, a dealer operating more than one retail location shall have each location treated as a separate entity and shall adhere to all requirements for dealer licensing including posting a license at each location.
E. Each dealer licensed under this chapter shall also obtain a certificate of dealer registration from the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles Vehicle Dealer Board (MVDB). The certificate of registration shall be renewed annually and shall be maintained in effect with the Department of Motor Vehicles MVDB as long as the dealer is licensed under this chapter.
13VAC6-20-60. Application for licensing; renewal.
A. Application for license or renewal shall be on forms supplied by the department and may be submitted as designated in hard copy or by electronic means. All information required on the form shall be furnished by the applicant for the board's review.
B. Each application for original licensure shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Deposit in the Transaction Recovery Fund required by 13VAC6-20-420 A 2.
2. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 3.
3. Statement of Compliance compliance.
4. Verification of a business office with all utilities, including a business telephone, and where the required business records are maintained.
5. Verification of a permanent business sign, in view of public traffic, bearing the name of the firm.
6. List of salespeople employed with the following biographical information for each:.
Date of Birth
Sex
Weight
Height
Eye/hair color
7. Name of the owner, principal, manager, agent, or other person designated as the holder of the dealer's license for the specific location and the names of other partners or principals in the dealership.
Photographs of the front of the business office and required sign may be considered as verification required by this subsection.
C. The Department of Housing and Community Development will mail a notice of renewal to the licensee at the last known address of record. Licensees may submit renewals by mail or electronically. Failure to receive this notice shall not relieve the licensee of the obligation to renew. If the licensee does not receive the notice of renewal, a copy of the license may be substituted with the required fee. Each application for renewal shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 4.
2. Statement of Compliance compliance.
3. Notification of any significant changes to the office or the business sign.
4. Updated list of salespeople employed.
5. Any changes of officers or directors of the company or corporation.
6. A copy of the dealer's current certificate of registration from the Department of Motor Vehicles Virginia Motor Vehicle Dealer Board.
D. Any change in the form of ownership of the dealer or any changes (deletions or additions) in the partners or principals of the dealer shall be submitted to the board with an application and fee for a new license. If the new owner or owners assume the liabilities of the previous owner or owners, then a new recovery fund assessment is not required. New recovery fund assessments shall be required when the new owner or owners do does not assume the liabilities of the previous owner or owners. The board shall be notified immediately by the dealer of any change in the operating name of the dealer. The director shall endorse the change on the license without requiring an additional fee. The board shall be notified immediately by the dealer of any change in the location of the dealer. The dealer shall pay a fee of $50 for the change of location on the license, but shall not be required to pay an additional assessment to the recovery fund for the change of location only.
13VAC6-20-80. Dealer responsibility for inspections; other items.
A. The dealer shall inspect every new manufactured home unit upon delivery from a manufacturer. If a dealer becomes aware of a noncompliance or an imminent safety hazard in a manufactured home, the dealer shall contact the manufacturer, provide full information concerning the problem, and request appropriate action by the manufacturer. No dealer shall sell a new manufactured home if he becomes aware that it contains a noncompliance defect or an imminent safety hazard.
B. The dealer shall inspect every new manufactured home unit prior to selling to determine that all items of furniture, appliances, fixtures, and devices are not damaged and are in place and operable.
C. A dealer shall not alter or cause to be altered any manufactured home to which a HUD label has been affixed if such alteration or conversion causes the manufactured home to be in violation of the standards.
D. If the dealer provides for the installation of any manufactured home he the dealer sells, the dealer shall be responsible for making sure the installation of the home meets the manufacturer's installation requirements and the Code.
E. On each home sold by the dealer, the dealer shall collect the applicable title fees and title tax for the manufactured home, to include an additional $30 inspection/administrative fee, and forward such fees and taxes to the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles.
The above fees shall be submitted to the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles within 30 days from the completion date of the sale.
F. On each home sold by the dealer, the dealer shall provide the owner with information to file a claim supplied by the department.
Article 3
Brokers
13VAC6-20-90. License required; annual renewal.
A. Any person located in or outside of the Commonwealth (i) buying or selling, negotiating the purchase or sale or exchange of, or leasing used manufactured homes and (ii) meeting the definition of broker in 13VAC6-20-10 shall apply to the board for a license. The license shall be displayed in a conspicuous place accessible to the public in the office of the business location. The license shall be issued for a term of one year from the date of issuance.
B. Each licensed broker shall apply for license renewal annually, by application and accompanied by the required fee. Applicants for license renewal shall meet all the criteria for original licensing. Upon failure to renew, the license shall automatically expire.
C. Should the department fail to receive a licensed broker's renewal form and appropriate fee within 30 days of the license expiration date, the broker shall be required to reinstate the license according to the terms and conditions of Article 8 (13VAC6-20-201 et seq.) of this part.
D. For licensing purposes, a broker operating more than one business location shall have each location treated as a separate entity and shall adhere to all requirements for broker licensing, including posting a license, at each location.
E. Each broker licensed under this chapter shall also obtain a certificate of dealer registration from the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles Vehicle Dealer Board (MVDB). The certificate of registration shall be renewed annually and shall be maintained in effect with the Department of Motor Vehicles MVDB as long as the broker is licensed under this chapter.
13VAC6-20-100. Application for licensing; renewal.
A. Application for license or renewal shall be on forms supplied by the department and may be submitted as designated in hard copy or by electronic means. All information required on the form shall be furnished by the applicant for the board's review.
B. Each application for original licensure shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Deposit in the Transaction Recovery Fund required by 13VAC6-20-420 A 3.
2. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 5.
3. Statement of Compliance compliance.
4. Verification of a business office with all utilities, including a business telephone, and where the required business records are maintained.
5. Verification of a permanent business sign, in view of public traffic, bearing the name of the firm.
6. Name of the owner, principal, manager, agent or other person designated as the holder of the broker's license for the specific location and the names of the partners or principals in the broker's firm.
7. List of salespeople employed with the following biographical information for each:.
Date of birth
Sex
Weight
Height
Eye/hair color
Photographs of the front of the business office and required sign may be considered as verification required by this subsection.
C. The Department of Housing and Community Development will mail a notice of renewal to the licensee at the last known address of record. Licensees may submit renewals by mail or electronically. Failure to receive this notice shall not relieve the licensee of the obligation to renew. If the licensee does not receive the notice of renewal, a copy of the license may be substituted with the required fee. Each application for renewal shall be accompanied by the following:
1. Licensing fee required by 13VAC6-20-200 A 6.
2. Statement of Compliance compliance.
3. Notification of any significant changes to the office or the business sign.
4. Any changes of officers or directors of the company or corporation.
5. A copy of the broker's current certificate of registration from the Department of Motor Vehicles Virginia Motor Vehicle Dealer Board.
6. Updated list of salespeople employed.
D. Any change in the form of ownership of the broker or any changes (deletions or additions) in the partners or principals of the broker shall be submitted to the board with an application and fee for a new license. If the new owner(s) owner assume the liabilities of the previous owner(s) owner, then a new recovery fund assessment is not required. New recovery fund assessments shall be required when the new owner(s) do owner does not assume the liabilities of the previous owner(s) owner.
The board shall be notified immediately by the broker of any change in the operating name of the broker. The director shall endorse the change on the license without requiring an additional fee. The board shall be notified immediately by the broker of any change in location of the broker. The broker shall pay a fee of $50 for the change of location on the license, but shall not be required to pay an additional assessment to the recovery fund for the change of location only.
Article 6
Violations and Hearings
13VAC6-20-170. Prohibited conduct; grounds for denying, suspending or revoking license.
A. The following acts by regulants are prohibited and may be considered by the board as grounds for action against the regulant:
1. Engaging in business as a manufactured home manufacturer, dealer, or broker without first obtaining a license from the board.
2. Engaging in business as a manufactured home salesperson without first applying to the board for a license.
3. Making a material misstatement in an application for license.
4. Failing to pay a required assessment to the Transaction Recovery Fund.
5. Failing to comply with the warranty service obligations and claims procedures required by this chapter.
6. Failing to comply with the set-up and tie-down requirements of the Code.
7. Knowingly failing or refusing to account for or pay over money or other valuables belonging to others which have come into the regulant's possession due to the sale of a manufactured home.
8. Using unfair methods of competition or unfair or deceptive commercial acts or practices.
9. Failing to comply with the advertising provisions in Part IV of this chapter (13VAC6-20-270 et seq.) of this chapter.
10. Defrauding any buyer to the buyer's damage, and any other person in the conduct of the regulant's business.
11. Employing an unlicensed salesperson.
12. Knowingly offering for sale a manufactured home produced by a manufacturer which that is not licensed as a manufacturer under this chapter.
13. Knowingly selling a manufactured home to a dealer who is not licensed as a dealer under this chapter.
14. Failing to appear before the board upon due notice.
15. Failing to comply with orders issued by the board pursuant to this chapter.
16. Failing to renew a license and continuing to engage in business as a manufacturer, dealer, broker, or salesperson after the expiration of any license.
17. A salesperson selling, exchanging, or offering to sell or exchange a manufactured home for any dealer or broker other than the licensed dealer or broker employing the salesperson.
18. A salesperson offering, transferring, or assigning any negotiated sale or exchange of a manufactured home to another dealer, broker, manufacturer, or salesperson.
19. Failing to comply with the Statement statement of Compliance compliance.
20. Failing to notify the board of a change of location or address of the business office.
21. Failing to comply with any provisions of this chapter.
a. The board may revoke or deny renewal of an existing license or refuse to issue a license to any manufactured home broker, dealer, manufacturer, or salesperson who is shown to have a substantial identity of interest with a manufactured home broker, dealer, or manufacturer whose license has been revoked or not renewed by the board.
b. Any person whose license is revoked or not renewed for cause by the board shall not be eligible for a license under any circumstances or under any name, except as provided by regulations of the board pursuant to § 36-85.18 of the Code of Virginia.
22. Failing to comply with the regulations of state or federal agencies regarding the financing, titling, taxation, or transporting of manufactured homes.
23. Failing to perform a written contract between the regulant and seller or buyer that contains the following minimum requirements:
a. A statement of the total cost of the contract and the amounts, including specific statement on the cost of the home, any additional costs for work to be performed, and the amount of the down payment, taxes, and titling fees.
b. A listing of specified materials and work to be performed and who is to supply the materials and perform that work.
c. Contract to identify the business name as shown on the license issued per this chapter and to include the address and the phone number of the business.
d. Specify the make and model of the home.
e. Specify if the home is new or used.
f. Specify the length and width of the home as defined by the HUD Standards.
g. Specify the date of manufacture and the serial number, except when the home is specially ordered from the manufacturer for the buyer and this information is not known.
24. Failing to provide a statement notifying consumers of the limitations on damages retained by dealer disclosure to the buyer.
25. Failing to provide a statement notifying consumers of the dispute resolution program available to resolve disputes concerning defects in manufactured homes.
B. The board may deny, suspend, revoke, or refuse to renew or reinstate the license of a regulant because of, but not limited to, one or more of the following grounds:
1. Having had a license previously denied, revoked, or suspended under this chapter.
2. Having a license denied, suspended, or revoked by a similar licensing entity in another state.
3. Engaging in conduct in another state which that would have been a violation of this chapter if the actions were committed in Virginia.
4. Failing to obtain a required certification of registration from the Department of Motor Vehicles Vehicle Dealer Board (MVDB), failing to renew the annual certificate of registration from the MVDB, or having the certificate of registration suspended or revoked by the Department of Motor Vehicles MVDB.
5. Having been convicted or found guilty in any jurisdiction of a felony.
13VAC6-20-320. Duration of warranties.
All warranties provided by regulants as required by 13VAC6-20-310 shall be for a period of not less than 12 months, measured from the date of delivery of the home to the buyer. The date of delivery shall be the date on which all terms or conditions of the sales contract agreed to or required of the regulant have been completed.
NOTICE: The forms used in administering the regulation were filed by the agency. The forms are not being published; however, online users of this issue of the Virginia Register of Regulations may click on the accompanying web address to access the online forms. The forms are also available from the agency contact or may be viewed at the Office of the Registrar of Regulations, 900 East Main Street, 11th Floor, Richmond, Virginia 23219.
FORMS (13VAC6-20)
Complete license registration application forms for broker, dealer, manufacturer, salesperson, and special licensing online at https://dmz1.dhcd.virginia.gov/BFR/Main/LogOn.aspx.
VA.R. Doc. No. R17-5104; Filed August 14, 2018, 4:35 p.m.
TITLE 18. PROFESSIONAL AND OCCUPATIONAL LICENSING
BOARD OF ACCOUNTANCY
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 18VAC5-22. Board of Accountancy
Regulations (amending 18VAC5-22-40).
Statutory Authority: §§ 54.1-4402 and 54.1-4403 of the
Code of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: Rebekah E. Allen, Enforcement Director,
Board of Accountancy, 9960 Mayland Drive, Suite 402, Richmond, VA 23223,
telephone (804) 367-2006, FAX (804) 527-4207, or email
rebekah.allen@boa.virginia.gov.
Basis: Subdivision 3 of § 54.1-4403 of the Code of Virginia
grants authority to the board to promulgate regulations necessary to assure
continued competency, to prevent deceptive or misleading practices by
licensees, and to effectively administer the regulatory system.
Purpose: This amendment is intended to remove
duplicative definitional information because the information was added to § 54.1-4400
of the Code of Virginia by Chapter 403 of the 2017 Acts of Assembly. The
board's rationale is to ensure that its regulations are not duplicative of
information already found in statute and to reduce confusion about which
definition should be used.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
rulemaking is expected to be noncontroversial because the information being
removed now exists in statute. This change is also supported by the Virginia
Society of Certified Public Accountants.
Substance: The amendment removes the existing definition
and replaces it with a citation to the correct statute.
Issues: The primary advantages to the public and the
agency are reduced confusion by removing duplicative material from the
regulation that is also found in statute. There are no primary disadvantages to
the public, the board, or the Commonwealth.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. Definitions
in the regulation of "providing services to the public" and
"providing services to an employer" are repetitious of definitions
listed in Code of Virginia § 54.1-4400. The Board proposes to replace the
definitions with a citation to § 54.1-4400.
Result of Analysis. The proposed amendment will not have a
significant impact.
Estimated Economic Impact. The proposed amendment would not
affect requirements or interpretations. It may add a small amount of time for
readers of the regulation seeking to understand the law.
Businesses and Entities Affected. The proposed regulation
affects CPA firms and CPAs. As of September 30, 2017, there were 27,842 persons
who held Virginia CPAs licenses, and 1,179 entities or sole proprietors that
held Virginia CPA firm licenses.1 All or most CPA firms would
qualify as small businesses.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendment does
not disproportionately affect particular localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed amendment does not
affect employment.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The proposed
amendments does not affect the use and value of private property.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendment does not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendment does not
significantly affect costs for small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendment does not significantly adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendment does not significantly
adversely affect businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not significantly
adversely affect other entities.
________________________
1Data source: Board of Accountancy
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Virginia Board of Accountancy concurs with the economic impact analysis of the
Department of Planning and Budget.
Summary:
The amendments replace definitions with a citation to § 54.1-4400
of the Code of Virginia.
18VAC5-22-40. Determining whether a person who holds a Virginia
license is providing services to the public using the CPA title or to an
employer using the CPA title.
For the purpose of determining whether a person who holds a
Virginia license is providing services to the public using the CPA title
or to an employer using the CPA title, as those terms are to
be defined in accordance with § 54.1-4400 of the Code of Virginia,
because of the written information readily available to the public through the
board's Internet postings, holding a Virginia license constitutes using the CPA
title. Accordingly, a person who holds a Virginia license:
1. Is providing services to the public using the CPA title
if he provides services that are subject to the guidance of the
standard-setting authorities listed in the standards of conduct and practice in
subdivisions 5 and 6 of § 54.1-4413.3 of the Code of Virginia.
2. Is providing services to an employer using the CPA title
if he provides to an entity services that require the substantial use of
accounting, financial, tax, or other skills that are relevant, as determined by
the board.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5259; Filed August 15, 2018, 8:29 a.m.
TITLE 18. PROFESSIONAL AND OCCUPATIONAL LICENSING
BOARD OF ACCOUNTANCY
Fast-Track Regulation
Title of Regulation: 18VAC5-22. Board of Accountancy
Regulations (amending 18VAC5-22-170).
Statutory Authority: §§ 54.1-4402 and 54.1-4403 of the
Code of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: No public hearings are
scheduled.
Public Comment Deadline: October 3, 2018.
Effective Date: October 18, 2018.
Agency Contact: Rebekah E. Allen, Enforcement Director,
Board of Accountancy, 9960 Mayland Drive, Suite 402, Richmond, VA 23223,
telephone (804) 367-2006, FAX (804) 527-4207, or email
rebekah.allen@boa.virginia.gov.
Basis: Subdivision 3 of § 54.1-4403 of the Code of
Virginia grants authority to the board to promulgate regulations necessary to
assure continued competency, to prevent deceptive or misleading practices by
licensees, and to effectively administer the regulatory system.
Purpose: The action is intended to make the occasions in
which a licensee or applicant must respond to the board match the language of §
54.1-4425 of the Code of Virginia and to give the board discretion in
determining whether a delay or failure to respond is a violation. Currently,
there is no discretion for the board, and the intent is to give the board more
latitude in determining whether a delay or failure to respond is a willful
violation of the regulation. The board's rationale is to ensure that its
regulations match statutory language to reduce confusion about when a licensee
or applicant is to respond to the board. The action also allows the board to
waive purported violations of the regulation if warranted and removes a
citation to the Code of Virginia that is no longer accurate.
Rationale for Using Fast-Track Rulemaking Process: This
rulemaking is expected to be noncontroversial because its requirements are
identical to those currently placed on licensees and applicants when responding
to the board. The proposed amendments match the language of current provisions
in § 54.1-4425 and allow the board to waive violations of the requirement
to respond, if warranted. This action is supported by the Virginia Society of
Certified Public Accountants.
Substance: The amendments (i) remove the list of
occasions upon which a licensee or applicant has to respond to the board and
replaces it with a sentence that matches language found in § 54.1-4425, (ii)
give the board discretion in determining whether a delay or failure to respond
is a violation, and (iii) remove a citation to the Code of Virginia in the last
subsection that is no longer accurate.
Issues: The primary advantage to the public is reduced
confusion between the differing language of the regulation and the statute
regarding the occasions requiring a response by a licensee. There are no
primary disadvantages to the public. The primary advantages to the board and
the Commonwealth is the ability to waive purported failures to respond to the
board if warranted. There are no primary disadvantages to the board or the
Commonwealth.
Department of Planning and Budget's Economic Impact
Analysis:
Summary of the Proposed Amendments to Regulation. The Board of
Accountancy (Board) proposes to amend the regulation to: 1) allow itself
discretion in determining whether a delay or failure to respond is a violation,
2) match the text to that of the Code of Virginia (Code) concerning when a
licensee or applicant has to respond to the Board, and 3) remove an out-of-date
citation to the Code.
Result of Analysis. The benefits likely exceed the costs for
all proposed changes.
Estimated Economic Impact. Code of Virginia § 54.1-4413.4(B)(1)
states that the Board may impose penalties on persons using the CPA title in
Virginia or firms providing attest services, compilation services, or financial
statement preparation services to persons or entities located in Virginia for
"Violation of the provisions of this chapter or violation of any
regulation,1 subpoena, or order of the Board." The current
regulation allows 30 calendar days for licensees to respond to Board inquiries.
Under the current regulation, licensees who fail to respond within 30 days
receive a $100 monetary penalty.
According to Board staff, the Board is aware that there may be
extenuating facts and circumstances, such as illness, death in the family, or
deployment, which would warrant non-timely responses to not be deemed a
violation. Thus the Board proposes to add the following sentence to the
regulation: "When the requested response is not produced by the licensee
or applicant within 30 calendar days, this nonproduction shall be deemed a
violation of this rule, unless otherwise determined by the board."2
The proposed amendment is beneficial in that it allows the Board to waive the
late fee when there are reasonable extenuating circumstances.
Matching the regulatory text to that of the Code and removing
an out-of-date citation to the Code would also be beneficial in that it would
reduce the likelihood of confusion amongst readers.
Businesses and Entities Affected. The proposed regulation potentially
affects CPA firms and CPAs, and CPA licensure applicants. As of September 30,
2017, there were 27,842 persons who held Virginia CPAs licenses, and 1,179
entities or sole proprietors that held Virginia CPA firm licenses. Annually,
there are on average 1,360 total applicants for licensure.3 All or
most CPA firms would qualify as small businesses.
Localities Particularly Affected. The proposed amendments do
not disproportionately affect particular localities.
Projected Impact on Employment. The proposed amendments do not
affect employment.
Effects on the Use and Value of Private Property. The proposed
amendments do not affect the use and value of private property.
Real Estate Development Costs. The proposed amendments do not
affect real estate development costs.
Small Businesses:
Definition. Pursuant to § 2.2-4007.04 of the Code of Virginia,
small business is defined as "a business entity, including its affiliates,
that (i) is independently owned and operated and (ii) employs fewer than 500
full-time employees or has gross annual sales of less than $6 million."
Costs and Other Effects. The proposed amendments do not
significantly affect costs for small businesses.
Alternative Method that Minimizes Adverse Impact. The proposed
amendments do not adversely affect small businesses.
Adverse Impacts:
Businesses. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
businesses.
Localities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
localities.
Other Entities. The proposed amendments do not adversely affect
other entities.
_________________________
1Bold added.
2Ibid.
3Data source: Board of Accountancy
Agency's Response to Economic Impact Analysis: The
Virginia Board of Accountancy concurs with the economic impact analysis of the
Department of Planning and Budget.
Summary:
The amendments (i) modify the occasions in which a licensee
or applicant has to respond to the board to match the language found in §
54.1-4425 of the Code of Virginia, (ii) allow the board discretion in
determining whether a delay or failure to respond is a violation, and (iii)
remove an out-of-date citation to the Code of Virginia.
18VAC5-22-170. Communication between with the
board and licensees.
A. When requested by the board:
1. Persons or firms applying for the issuance, renewal, or
reinstatement of a Virginia license or for lifting the suspension of the
privilege of using the CPA title in Virginia or providing attest services or
compilation services for persons or entities located in Virginia shall provide
the board with support for their conclusion that they have complied with
applicable provisions of Chapter 44 (§ 54.1-4400 et seq.) of Title 54.1 of the
Code of Virginia and this chapter.
2. Firms shall provide the board with proof of enrollment
in a monitoring program and copies of reports and other documentation related
to acceptance of their peer reviews.
3. Persons or firms shall provide the board documents
related to the board's investigation of their possible violation of provisions
of Chapter 44 (§ 54.1-4400 et seq.) of Title 54.1 of the Code of Virginia or
this chapter.
Each person or firm Pursuant to § 54.1-4425 of the
Code of Virginia, each licensee or applicant shall respond within 30
calendar days to any board request for information by the board under
this subsection regarding compliance with any statutes or regulations
pertaining to the board or any of the programs that may be in another title of
the Code of Virginia for which the board has regulatory responsibility. When
the requested response is not produced by the licensee or applicant within 30
calendar days, this nonproduction shall be deemed a violation of this rule,
unless otherwise determined by the board.
B. Each holder of a Virginia license shall notify the board
in writing within 30 calendar days of any change in the holder's name or in the
postal and electronic addresses where the person or firm may be reached.
C. The board shall transmit license renewal notices
electronically unless a person or firm is unable to communicate electronically.
However, § 54.1-4413.2 of the Code of Virginia places the The
responsibility for renewing a Virginia license is on its holder, and
that responsibility is not affected by whether the holder receives a license
renewal notice.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5263; Filed August 15, 2018, 8:27 a.m.
TITLE 18. PROFESSIONAL AND OCCUPATIONAL LICENSING
DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH PROFESSIONS
Final Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
Department of Health Professions is claiming an exemption from Article 2 of the
Administrative Process Act in accordance with § 2.2-4006 A 4 a of the Code
of Virginia, which excludes regulations that are necessary to conform to
changes in Virginia statutory law where no agency discretion is involved. The
Department of Health Professions will receive, consider, and respond to
petitions by any interested person at any time with respect to reconsideration
or revision.
Title of Regulation: 18VAC76-20. Regulations
Governing the Prescription Monitoring Program (amending 18VAC76-20-10, 18VAC76-20-20,
18VAC76-20-70).
Statutory Authority: § 54.1-2519 of the Code of
Virginia.
Effective Date: October 3, 2018.
Agency Contact: Ralph Orr, Program Manager, Department
of Health Professions, 9960 Mayland Drive, Suite 300, Richmond, VA 23233-1463,
telephone (804) 367-4523, FAX (804) 527-4470, or email
ralph.orr@dhp.virginia.gov.
Summary:
The amendments add (i) Schedule V controlled substances for
which a prescription is required, (ii) naloxone, and (iii) cannabidiol oil or
THC-A oil dispensed by a pharmaceutical processor in Virginia as covered
substances that must be reported to the Prescription Monitoring Program.
18VAC76-20-10. Definitions.
The following words and terms when used in this chapter shall
have the meanings ascribed to them in § 54.1-2519 of the Code of Virginia
unless the context clearly indicates otherwise:
"Covered substance"
"Department"
"Director"
"Dispense"
"Dispenser"
"Prescriber"
"Recipient"
In addition, the following term when used in this chapter
shall have the following meaning unless the context clearly indicates
otherwise:
"Program" means the Prescription Monitoring Program.
18VAC76-20-20. General provisions.
In accordance with Chapter 25.2 (§ 54.1-2519 et seq.) of
Title 54.1 of the Code of Virginia and this chapter, the Director of the
Department of Health Professions shall establish and administer a program for
monitoring the dispensing of Schedules II, III, and IV controlled covered
substances, which means all controlled substances included in Schedules II,
III, and IV; controlled substances included in Schedule V for which a
prescription is required; naloxone; and any other drugs of concern
identified by the Board of Pharmacy pursuant to § 54.1-3456.1 of the Code of
Virginia. Covered substances also include cannabidiol oil or THC-A oil
dispensed by a pharmaceutical processor in Virginia.
18VAC76-20-70. Notice of requests for information.
A. Any dispenser who intends to request information from the
program for a recipient or prospective recipient of a Schedule II, III, or
IV controlled substance covered substance shall post a sign that can
be easily viewed by the public at the place where the prescription is accepted
for dispensing and that discloses to the public that the pharmacist may access
information contained in the program files on all Schedule II, III or IV
prescriptions covered substances dispensed to a patient. In lieu of
posting a sign, the dispenser may provide such notice in written material
provided to the recipient, or may obtain written consent from the recipient.
B. Any prescriber who intends to request information from the
program about a patient or prospective patient shall post a sign that can be
easily viewed by the public that discloses to the public that the prescriber
may access information contained in the program files on all Schedule II,
III or IV prescriptions covered substances dispensed to a patient.
In lieu of posting a sign, the prescriber may provide such notice in written
material provided to the patient, or may obtain written consent from the patient.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5571; Filed August 8, 2018, 9:29 a.m.
TITLE 18. PROFESSIONAL AND OCCUPATIONAL LICENSING
REAL ESTATE APPRAISER BOARD
Final Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
following regulatory action is exempt from Article 2 of the Administrative
Process Act in accordance with § 2.2-4006 A 4 c of the Code of Virginia,
which excludes regulations that are necessary to meet the requirements of
federal law or regulations, provided such regulations do not differ materially
from those required by federal law or regulation. The Real Estate Appraiser Board
will receive, consider, and respond to petitions by any interested person at
any time with respect to reconsideration or revision.
Title of Regulation: 18VAC130-20. Real Estate
Appraiser Board Rules and Regulations (amending 18VAC130-20-30).
Statutory Authority: § 54.1-2013 of the Code of
Virginia.
Effective Date: November 1, 2018.
Agency Contact: Christine Martine, Executive Director,
Real Estate Appraiser Board, 9960 Mayland Drive, Suite 400, Richmond, VA 23233,
telephone (804) 367-8552, FAX (804) 527-4298, or email
reappraisers@dpor.virginia.gov.
Summary:
The amendments (i) eliminate the requirement for a licensed
residential real estate appraiser license applicant to have an associate's
degree or complete 30 semester credit hours of accredited college-level
education; (ii) eliminate the requirement for a certified residential real
estate appraiser license applicant to have a bachelor's degree or higher; and
(iii) reduce the appraisal experience requirement for a licensed residential
real estate appraiser license applicant, a certified residential real estate
appraiser license applicant, and a certified general real estate appraiser
license applicant.
18VAC130-20-30. General qualifications for licensure.
Every applicant to the Real Estate Appraiser Board for a
certified general, certified residential, or licensed residential real estate
appraiser license shall meet the following qualifications:
1. The applicant shall be of good moral character, honest,
truthful, and competent to transact the business of a licensed real estate
appraiser in such a manner as to safeguard the interests of the public.
2. The applicant shall meet the current educational and
experience requirements and submit a license application to the Department of
Professional and Occupational Regulation or its agent prior to the time the
applicant is approved to take the licensing examination. Applications received
by the department or its agent must be complete within 12 months of the date of
the receipt of the license application and fee by the Department of
Professional and Occupational Regulation or its agent.
3. The applicant shall sign, as part of the application, a
statement verifying that the applicant has read and understands the Virginia
real estate appraiser license law and the regulations of the Real Estate
Appraiser Board.
4. The applicant shall be in good standing as a real estate
appraiser in every jurisdiction where licensed or certified; the applicant may
not have had a license or certification that was suspended, revoked or
surrendered in connection with a disciplinary action or that has been the
subject of discipline in any jurisdiction prior to applying for licensure in
Virginia.
5. The applicant shall possess a background that would not
call into question the public trust. Each applicant shall submit to
fingerprinting. A background investigation shall be conducted, which shall not
reveal that he has been convicted, found guilty, or pled guilty or nolo
contendere to a crime that would call into question his fitness or suitability
to engage in the profession. The applicant must disclose the following:
a. All felony convictions; and
b. All misdemeanor convictions in any jurisdiction that
occurred within five years of the date of application.
Any plea of nolo contendere or finding of guilt regardless of
adjudication or deferred adjudication shall be considered a conviction for
purposes of this subdivision.
6. The applicant shall be at least 18 years old.
7. The applicant shall have successfully completed the
following education:
a. Licensed residential classification - 150 hours for
the licensed residential classification, 200 hours for the certified
residential classification, and 300 hours for the certified general
classification of approved real estate appraisal courses, including the
15-Hour National Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice course,
from accredited colleges, universities, and junior and community
colleges; adult distributive or marketing education programs; local, state,
or federal government agencies, boards, or commissions; proprietary
schools; or real estate appraisal or real estate related organizations. The
required core curriculum for the certified general or certified residential
real estate appraiser is a bachelor's degree or higher from an accredited
college or university. The required core curriculum for the licensed
residential real estate appraiser is an associate's degree or higher from an
accredited college, junior college, community college, or university. In lieu
of the required degree, the licensed residential real estate appraiser
applicant must complete 30 semester hours of college-level education from an
accredited college, junior college, community college, or university. The
classroom hours required for the licensed residential real estate appraiser may
include the classroom hours required for the appraiser trainee. The classroom
hours required for the certified residential real estate appraiser may include
the classroom hours required for the appraiser trainee or the licensed real
estate appraiser. The classroom hours required for the certified general real
estate appraiser may include the classroom hours required for the appraiser
trainee, the licensed residential real estate appraiser, or the certified
residential real estate appraiser. All applicants for licensure as a certified
general real estate appraiser must complete an advanced level appraisal course
of at least 30 classroom hours in the appraisal of nonresidential properties.
The classroom hours required for the licensed residential classification may
include the classroom hours required for the appraiser trainee.
b. Certified residential classification - 200 hours of
approved real estate appraisal courses, including the 15-Hour National Uniform
Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice course, from accredited colleges,
universities, and junior and community colleges; adult distributive or
marketing education programs; local, state, or federal government agencies,
boards, or commissions; proprietary schools; or real estate appraisal or real
estate related organizations. The classroom hours required for the certified
residential classification may include the classroom hours required for the
appraiser trainee or the licensed residential classification. The
applicant shall also meet one of the following options for the required core
curriculum:
(1) A bachelor's degree in any field of study;
(2) An associate's degree in a field of study related to
business administration, accounting, finance, economics, or real estate;
(3) Successful completion of 30 semester hours of
college-level courses that cover each of the following specific topic areas and
hours: English composition (3 hours); microeconomics (3 hours); macroeconomics
(3 hours); finance (3 hours); algebra, geometry, or higher math (3 hours);
statistics (3 hours); computer science (3 hours); business law or real estate
law (3 hours); and two elective courses in any of the topics described in this
subdivision or in accounting, geography, agricultural economics, business
management, or real estate (3 hours each);
(4) Successful completion of at least 30 hours of College
Level Examination Program (CLEP) examinations that cover each of the specific
topic areas in subdivision 7 b (3) of this section. For purposes of this
option, the CLEP examination for college algebra (3 hours) may be applied to
the topic area of algebra, geometry, or higher math; the CLEP examination for college
composition (6 hours) may be applied to the topic area of English composition;
the CLEP examination for college composition modular (3 hours) may be applied
to the topic area of English composition; the CLEP examination for college
mathematics (6 hours) may be applied to the topic area of algebra, geometry, or
higher math or statistics; the CLEP examination for principles of macroeconomics
(3 hours) may be applied to the topic area of macroeconomics or finance; the
CLEP examination for principles of microeconomics (3 hours) may be applied to
the topic area of microeconomics or finance; the CLEP examination for introductory
business law (3 hours) may be applied to the topic area of business law or real
estate law; and the CLEP examination for information systems (3 hours) may be
applied to the topic area of computer science;
(5) Successful completion of at least 30 hours of any
combination of college-level courses and CLEP examinations that includes all of
the topics identified in subdivision 7 b (3); or
(6) No college-level education. This option applies only to
applicants who have held a licensed residential credential for a minimum of
five years and have no record of any adverse, final, and nonappealable
disciplinary action affecting the licensed residential appraiser's legal
eligibility to engage in appraisal practice within the five years immediately
preceding the date of application for a certified residential credential.
c. Certified general classification - 300 hours of approved
real estate appraisal courses, including the 15-Hour National Uniform Standards
of Professional Appraisal Practice course, from accredited colleges,
universities, and junior and community colleges; adult distributive or
marketing education programs; local, state, or federal government agencies,
boards, or commissions; proprietary schools; or real estate appraisal or real
estate related organizations. The applicant must complete an advanced level
appraisal course of at least 30 classroom hours in the appraisal of
nonresidential properties. The classroom hours required for the certified
general classification may include the classroom hours required for the
appraiser trainee, the licensed residential classification, or the certified
residential classification. The required core curriculum is a bachelor's degree
or higher from an accredited college or university.
8. The applicant shall, as part of the application for
licensure, verify his experience in the field of real estate appraisal. All
applicants must submit, upon application, sample appraisal reports as specified
by the board. In addition, all experience must be acquired within the five-year
period immediately preceding the date application is made and be supported by
adequate written reports or file memoranda, which shall be made available to
the board upon request.
a. Applicants The applicant for a licensed
residential real estate appraiser license shall have a minimum of 2,000 1,000
hours appraisal experience, in no fewer than 12 six months. Hours
may be treated as cumulative in order to achieve the necessary 2,000 1,000
hours of appraisal experience.
b. Applicants The applicant for a certified
residential real estate appraiser license shall have a minimum of 2,500 1,500
hours of appraisal experience obtained during no fewer than 24 12
months. Hours may be treated as cumulative in order to achieve the necessary 2,500
1,500 hours of appraisal experience.
c. Applicants The applicant for a certified
general real estate appraiser license shall have a minimum of 3,000 hours of
appraisal experience obtained during no fewer than 30 18 months.
Hours may be treated as cumulative in order to achieve the necessary 3,000
hours of appraisal experience. At least 50% of the appraisal experience
required (1,500 hours) must be in nonresidential appraisal assignments and
include assignments that demonstrate the use and understanding of the income
approach. An applicant whose nonresidential appraisal experience is
predominately in such properties that do not require the use of the income
approach may satisfy this requirement by performing two or more appraisals on
properties in association with a certified general appraiser that include the
use of the income approach. The applicant must have substantially contributed
to the development of the income approach in such reports and shall provide
evidence or verification of such contribution.
9. Within 12 months after being approved by the board to take
the examination, the applicant shall have registered for and passed a written
examination developed or endorsed by the Appraiser Qualifications Board and
provided by the board or by a testing service acting on behalf of the board.
Successful completion of the examination is valid for a period of 24 months.
10. Applicants for licensure who do not meet the requirements
set forth in subdivisions 4 and 5 of this section may be approved for licensure
following consideration of their application by the board.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5621; Filed August 9, 2018, 8:10 p.m.
TITLE 19. PUBLIC SAFETY
DEPARTMENT OF STATE POLICE
Final Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
Department of State Police is claiming an exemption from the Administrative
Process Act pursuant to § 2.2-4002 B 6 of the Code of Virginia, which
exempts agency action relating to customary military, naval, or police
functions.
Title of Regulation: 19VAC30-70. Motor Vehicle Safety
Inspection Regulations (amending 19VAC30-70-3, 19VAC30-70-4,
19VAC30-70-5, 19VAC30-70-6, 19VAC30-70-9.1, 19VAC30-70-10, 19VAC30-70-11,
19VAC30-70-30, 19VAC30-70-50, 19VAC30-70-60, 19VAC30-70-90, 19VAC30-70-120,
19VAC30-70-160, 19VAC30-70-210, 19VAC30-70-290, 19VAC30-70-350, 19VAC30-70-360,
19VAC30-70-580, 19VAC30-70-660).
Statutory Authority: § 46.2-1165 of the Code of
Virginia.
Effective Date: October 4, 2018.
Agency Contact: Kirk Marlowe, Agency Regulatory
Coordinator, Department of State Police, P.O. Box 27472, Richmond, VA
23261-7472, telephone (804) 674-4606, FAX (804) 674-2936, or email
kirk.marlowe@vsp.virginia.gov.
Summary:
The amendments update the Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection
Regulations by making technical corrections and other revisions to comply with
changes in Virginia law, including (i) adjusting discipline for offenses; (ii)
adding a financial stability requirement following change of ownership; (iii)
in compliance with Chapter 400 of the 2018 Acts of Assembly, removing the
requirement for first-come, first-served inspections; (iv) exempting
nonresident military dependents from the requirement to have a Virginia
driver's license for identification purposes during inspection; (v) requiring
inspection stations to retain rejection sticker receipts for six months; (vi)
in compliance with Chapter 72 of the 2018 Acts of Assembly, providing that
vehicles with certain lighting devices under certain circumstances may leave
those devices uncovered while operating the vehicle on the highway; (vii)
providing that airbags cannot be disabled in a vehicle equipped with them; and
(viii) in compliance with Chapter 763 of the 2018 Acts of Assembly, providing
requirements for certain auxiliary lights on motorcycles or autocycles.
19VAC30-70-3. Class I offenses.
Class I offenses are unacceptable work performances less
serious in nature, but which require correction in order to maintain an efficient
and effective Official Motor Vehicle Inspection Program. A violation of any
paragraph of the following sections of the Official Motor Vehicle Safety
Inspection Manual and rules and agreements not covered in the Official Motor
Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual or those disseminated by other means shall
constitute a Class I offense, unless designated otherwise:
19VAC30-70-10 A through D
19VAC30-70-10 F through I
19VAC30-70-10 K through O
19VAC30-70-10 U
19VAC30-70-20 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-30 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-40 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-50 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-60 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-70 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-80 B 3
19VAC30-70-160 in its entirety (except subdivisions I 10
and 11 g (2)) 12 and 13 f (2))
19VAC30-70-170 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-200 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-290 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-310 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-330 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-360 D 4 e and f
19VAC30-70-410 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-440 B
19VAC30-70-530 in its entirety (except subdivisions K 10 i and
K 11 g (2))
19VAC30-70-540 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-570 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-660 in its entirety
Disciplinary action for Class I offenses shall be:
1st offense - Verbal counseling - Recorded on Form SP-164.
2nd offense - Written reprimand from the safety officer or his
designee.
3rd offense - Suspension of not less than 15 or more than 30
days.
Offenses shall be cumulative in nature and shall remain
active for 24 months from date of offense. When Class II, III, or IV
offenses are active, discipline can be written reprimand or suspension of not
more than 60 days.
19VAC30-70-4. Class II offenses.
Class II offenses shall be violations of any section of the
Official Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual considered very serious,
but the consequence of such violation or omission is not likely to be an
imminent cause or contributing factor to a traffic crash or other vehicle
related injury. A violation of the following sections of the Official Motor
Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual shall constitute a Class II offense unless
designated otherwise:
19VAC30-70-150 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-180 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-210 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-230 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-240 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-250 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-260 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-270 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-280 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-300 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-320 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-360 A 7 and C
19VAC30-70-380 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-390 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-420 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-520 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-550 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-580 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-600 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-610 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-620 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-630 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-640 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-650 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-670 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-680 in its entirety
Disciplinary action for a Class II offense shall be:
1st Offense - Verbal counseling - Recorded on Form SP-164.
2nd Offense - Written reprimand from the safety officer or his
designee.
3rd Offense - Suspension of not less than 30 or more than 60
days.
Offenses are cumulative in nature and shall remain active for
a period of 24 months from date of offense.
A Class II offense in combination with three Class I
offenses shall be grounds for no less than a 30-day or more than a 60-day
suspension. When Class I, III, or IV offenses are active, discipline can
be written reprimand or suspension of not more than 90 days.
19VAC30-70-5. Class III offenses.
Class III offenses may be violations of those sections of the
Official Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual considered more severe in
nature, and usually considered most critical from a safety or administrative
viewpoint. They would include the omission of checking or improper approval of
an item so critical to the safe operation of a motor vehicle as to have the
potential of being the imminent cause or factor of a motor vehicle crash. A
violation of the following sections of the Official Motor Vehicle Safety
Inspection Manual shall constitute a Class III offense unless designated
otherwise:
19VAC30-70-10 J and P Q
19VAC30-70-11 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-80 in its entirety (except subdivision B 3)
19VAC30-70-90 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-100 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-110 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-120 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-130 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-140 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-160 I 10 h and 11 f 12 g and 13 e
19VAC30-70-160 I 10 g and 11 g (2) 12 f and 13 f (2)
19VAC30-70-190 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-220 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-340 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-350 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-360 A and B
19VAC30-70-370 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-400 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-440 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-450 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-460 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-470 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-480 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-490 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-500 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-510 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-530 K 10 i and K 11 g (2)
19VAC30-70-560 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-590 in its entirety
19VAC30-70-690 in its entirety
Disciplinary action for a Class III offense shall be:
1st offense - Written reprimand from the safety officer or his
designee.
2nd offense - Suspension for not less than 45 or more than 90
days.
3rd offense - Suspension for not less than 90 days or more
than six months.
Offenses are cumulative in nature and will remain active for
a period of 24 months from date of offense.
A Class III offense in combination with two Class II
offenses or three Class I offenses shall be grounds for no less than a 60-day
or more than a 90-day suspension. When a Class I, II, or IV offense is
active, discipline can be written reprimand or suspension of any duration less
than one year.
19VAC30-70-6. Class IV offenses.
A. Class IV offenses are those violations considered
so critically important to the integrity and credibility of the Official Annual
Motor Vehicle Inspection Program as to require immediate and severe
disciplinary action. Any Class IV offense is grounds for suspension or
revocation. The following violations and actions shall be considered a
Class IV offense:
1. Loss of driver's license, with the exception of an
administrative court-ordered suspension that does not exceed seven days.
2. Obvious usage of either alcohol or drugs by an employee
associated with the Annual Motor Vehicle Inspection Program.
3. Loss of inspection stickers through neglect or subsequent
violations of subsection K of 19VAC30-70-10.
4. Improper use of inspection supplies such as placement on a
vehicle that has not been inspected or failure to affix the inspection sticker
to the vehicle in its proper location, after inspection.
5. Falsifying inspection receipts or inspection records.
6. Giving false information during an inspection complaint
investigation.
7. Performing either an inspection or inspections at a station
without authority from the safety officer.
8. The arrest of any person associated with the inspection program
for a criminal offense or the institution of civil action of a nature that
would tend to immediately reflect upon the integrity and reputation of the
Department of State Police may be grounds for an immediate suspension until
final court disposition. The conviction of A finding other than
acquittal for any criminal offense or a civil judgment or bankruptcy may
result in a suspension or revocation of the inspector or station appointment,
or both.
9. The use of profanity or verbal abuse by station owners,
managers, or safety inspectors toward each other or directed at customers
presenting their vehicles for inspection by inspectors, managers or business
owners.
10. Illegal use of inspection supplies such as stealing,
selling, mailing or giving away, shall be grounds for revocation.
11. Nonpayment of inspection fees.
12. Conduct displayed by station owners, managers, or safety
inspectors that may be rude or discourteous, or the use of profanity or verbal
abuse directed at or towards toward Safety Division Personnel,
may be grounds for revocation.
13. Failure of any person connected with the inspection
program to notify their supervising trooper or Safety Division Area Office
within 72 hours of an arrest for a criminal offense or the institution of civil
action.
14. Any misuse or falsification of the automated Motor Vehicle
Inspection Program (MVIP) system through neglect or intentionally allowing an
assigned password or personal identification number (PIN) to be used by other
persons.
15. Willfully obtaining computer services without proper
authority from the safety officer.
16. Failure to adequately explain and differentiate, both
orally and in writing, to customers what repairs are necessary to pass the
safety inspection and those repairs that are only recommended. Each station
shall explicitly (not fine print) convey to each customer when his vehicle will
be examined beyond the parameters of the state inspection and empower the
customer with the ability to decline this service.
17. Allowing a suspended or revoked safety inspector to
perform predelivery inspections (PDIs) or have access to inspection supplies,
which may be grounds for suspension or revocation of the station appointment
and an additional suspension or revocation for the inspector.
B. Disciplinary action for a Class IV offense shall be
immediate suspension or revocation. A suspension shall not be less than 90
days or more than six months. A revocation shall not be less than one year or
more than three years. A revocation shall not be less than one year or
more than three years. A suspension shall constitute any period of time less
than a year and shall not be less than 90 days. Offenses are cumulative in
nature and will remain active for a period of 24 months from the date of the
offense. For a subsequent violation within 24 months, the suspension shall
not be less than six months or more than one year or revocation shall be
no less duration than the prior discipline received.
C. In the case of the loss of the driver's license,
the suspension shall remain in effect until the driver's license is reinstated
and consideration for reinstatement of inspection privileges will be made at
that time.
D. In cases concerning nonpayment of fees when the
inspection station has been given 15 days to reply to a final notice, the
suspension of the affected inspection station shall remain in effect until all
inspection fees are paid. Consideration for reinstatement of inspection
privileges will be made when all fees are paid. Furthermore, stations that have
not paid their processing fee after the 15-day period will not be issued any
additional inspection supplies. Supply orders may resume when the inspection
fee is paid and the station has been reinstated to an active status.
A Class IV offense in combination with three Class I
offenses, two Class II offenses, or one Class III offense shall be grounds for
no less than a 90-day or more than a six-month suspension.
19VAC30-70-9.1. Official inspection station appointment.
A. These procedures are applicable to the application process
for initial appointment, reclassification of appointment, change in ownership,
change in name, and reinstatement of the appointment for an official inspection
station following a period of suspension or revocation.
For investigations involving changes to the original report,
only those areas of inquiry which that have changed need to be
reported.
For changes in station name, location, and classification
only, a narrative report is not required. These requests may be reported on the
Form SP-164. This report should include information pertinent to the change. A
statement should be included to report verification of information contained in
the station's new application for appointment.
1. Any garage or other facility that routinely performs motor
vehicle, motorcycle, or trailer repairs may apply to the Department of State
Police in writing for appointment as an Official Safety Inspection Station.
a. The Department of State Police will forward an application
package to the applicant.
b. The application form or forms are to be completed
and returned to the supervising trooper processing the application within 45
days.
c. The application shall include the names, addresses, email
addresses, telephone numbers, dates of birth, and social security numbers for
the applicant and each person who will supervise or otherwise participate in
the program. Each person will also be required to execute an Authorization for
Release of Information Form and a Criminal History Record Request (Form
SP-167). When a corporation with other established inspection stations is
applying for an additional location, it shall not be necessary for the
corporate officers to complete the Form SP-167 or undergo the usual background
investigation. In these situations, the Department of State Police is only
concerned with the personnel who will be responsible for handling and securing
the safety inspection supplies.
2. Each inspection station application will be reviewed and
the applicant must meet the following criteria:
a. The facility must have been in business at its present
location for a minimum of six months.
(1) This requirement will not apply to a change in location
for a previously appointed station or a change in ownership which does not
affect the station's ability to perform safety inspections.
(2) This requirement will not apply to a repair garage that is
an established business and is expanding its mechanical convenience to the
general public by the addition of other repair locations.
(3) This requirement will not apply to a business license as a
franchised dealer of new vehicles.
b. The facility must perform motor vehicle, motorcycle, or
trailer repairs routinely.
c. The station must have on hand or be willing to purchase the
necessary equipment as identified by the Department of State Police for
performing safety inspections.
d. The station must employ or be willing to employ at least
one full time full-time safety inspector with the appropriate
license for the desired station's classification.
e. The facility's physical plant must meet the specific
standards for the station classification for which the appointment is required.
3. Each applicant station must undergo a background
investigation to determine if the business and associated personnel meet the
following minimum criteria:
a. A review of the history of management and all persons
employed who will participate in the inspection program must reflect general
compliance with all federal, state, and local laws.
b. The character, attitude, knowledge of safety inspection
requirements, mechanical ability, and experience of each individual who will
perform or supervise safety inspections must be satisfactory.
c. The applicant and all participants must be familiar with
and agree to comply with the Official Motor Vehicle Inspection Manual. Each
vehicle presented for safety inspection must be inspected in strict compliance
with the Code of Virginia and the Official Motor Vehicle Inspection Manual.
d. The business establishment must be financially stable. Its
future existence should not be dependent upon appointment as an inspection
station. The applicant and all persons to be associated with the inspection
program must be in compliance with any judgment order or meeting all financial
obligations, or both. The applicant and all persons to be associated with the
inspection program must be in good financial standing for a period of at least
one year.
Following any change in ownership, new ownership must show
financial stability for a minimum of six months prior to their official inspection
station appointment.
4. Each business must agree to provide the necessary space,
equipment, and personnel to conduct inspections as required by the Department
of State Police. Facilities and equipment will be maintained in a manner
satisfactory to the superintendent. All safety inspectors will read and be
thoroughly familiar with the instructions furnished for Official Inspection
Stations and agree to abide by these instructions and to carefully inspect
every motor vehicle, trailer, and semi-trailer presented for inspection as
required by the Official Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual. Businesses
must operate inspection stations in strict accordance with the Code of Virginia
and the Official Motor Vehicle Inspection Manual. The appointment of an
inspection station may be canceled at any time by the superintendent and will
be automatically canceled if any change in address, name, or ownership is made
without proper notification.
5. Any applicant whose application is rejected or withdrawn
may not reapply sooner than six months from the date he is notified of the
rejection of his application or from the date the application is withdrawn.
6. Each business to be
appointed will be assigned one of 11 classifications based upon the physical
plant specifications or other criteria as follows:
a. Unlimited: The inspection lane shall be level or on the
same plane and in good condition for 60 feet. The front portion of the lane
shall be level or on the same plane for a minimum of 40 feet. The entrance
shall be at least 13-1/2 feet in height and no less than nine feet in width.
(Space should be adequate to allow a tractor truck towing a 53-foot trailer
access to the inspection lane.)
b. Small exemption: The inspection lane shall be level or on
the same plane for 40 feet. The entrance opening shall be at least 10 feet in
height, eight feet in width, and adequate to accommodate vehicles 40 feet in
length. Any vehicle exceeding 10 feet in height may be inspected if the
building entrance will allow such vehicle to completely enter the designated
inspection lane.
c. Large exemption: The inspection lane shall be level or on
the same plane and in good condition for 60 feet. The front portion of the lane
shall be level or on the same plane for a minimum of 40 feet. The entrance
shall be at least 13-1/2 feet in height and no less than nine feet in width.
(Space should be adequate to allow a tractor truck towing a 53-foot trailer
access to the inspection lane.) This classification is required to inspect only
vehicles with a GVWR exceeding 10,000 pounds.
d. Motorcycle: The inspection lane shall be level or on the
same plane. The entrance shall be adequate to accommodate the motorcycle and
the operator.
e. Unlimited trailer: The inspection lane shall be reasonably
level and in good condition for 60 feet. The entrance shall be at least 13-1/2
feet in height and no less than nine feet in width. This classification is
required to inspect all trailers.
f. Small trailer exemption: The inspection lane shall be
reasonably level and in good condition for 40 feet. The entrance shall be at
least 10 feet in height and adequate to accommodate trailers 40 feet in length.
This classification is required to inspect only those trailers not exceeding 40
feet in length or 10 feet in height measured to the highest part of the trailer
but not including racks, air conditioners, antennas, etc.
g. Large trailer exemption: The inspection lane shall be
reasonably level and in good condition for 60 feet. The entrance shall be at
least 13-1/2 feet in height and adequate to accommodate all legal size
trailers. This classification is required to inspect only property-carrying
trailers exceeding 10 feet in height or 40 feet in length.
h. Safety and emissions: The inspection lane shall be level or
on the same plane. The lane must accommodate most passenger cars and light
trucks. The emissions equipment must be placed in the lane at a location to
allow the inspected vehicle to be positioned with all four wheels on the floor
or on an above-ground ramp on a plane to the floor to accommodate headlight
aiming and other required inspection procedures. Any above-ground structure
must be constructed so as to permit proper steering, suspension, brake, and
undercarriage inspection as outlined in the Official Motor Vehicle Safety
Inspection Manual. A list of local inspection stations that can accommodate
vehicles that cannot be safety inspected due to the pretenses of emissions
equipment must be maintained and available for customers. A "bottle"
jack or other appropriate lifting equipment may be used for safety inspection
on above-ground structures.
i. Private station: The inspection lane shall be level or on
the same plane. The entrance and size must be adequate to accommodate any
vehicle in the fleet. An applicant who owns and operates less than 20 vehicles
will not be considered.
j. Private station (fleet service contractor): The inspection
lane shall be level or on the same plane. The entrance and size must be
adequate to accommodate any vehicle in the fleet to be inspected. This
classification will permit the inspection of all vehicles that the applicant
has a written agreement to service and repair. An applicant who does not have
at least six written agreements to service private fleets with at least five
vehicles in each fleet or at least one written agreement to service a private
fleet with at least 30 vehicles in the fleet will not be considered for this
type of appointment. Vehicles not covered by a written agreement for service,
and repair, other than the vehicles owned by the applicant's company or
corporation, shall not be inspected by a garage having this type of
classification.
k. Private station (government): The inspection lane shall be
level or on the same plane. The entrance and size must be adequate to accommodate
any vehicle in the fleet to be inspected. This classification will permit the
inspection of all vehicles in the government entity's fleet, the fleet of any
volunteer or paid fire department, or any other unit or agency of the
government structure having a written agreement with such governmental entity
for repair, inspection service, or both. An applicant for this classification
must own or have a written agreement to inspect 30 or more vehicles. Vehicles
not owned by or covered by a written agreement shall not be inspected by a
garage having this type of classification.
7. Classifications listed in subdivisions 6 a through 6 h of
this subsection must be open to the public and have at least one safety
inspector available to perform inspections during normal business hours as set
forth in 19VAC30-70-10.
8. Private inspection station classifications may be assigned
to businesses or governmental entities with fixed garage or repair facilities
operating or contracting with vehicle fleets.
B. A representative of any official inspection station may
apply to the Department of State Police in writing to request a change of the
station's status.
1. An application form or forms will be forwarded to
the applicant.
2. The applicant will complete the application form or
forms and contact the Department of State Police in keeping with the
application instructions. Applications will include all data as set forth in
this section.
3. A Safety Division trooper will be assigned to complete the
appropriate investigation to affect the change. A change in status
investigation will include:
a. A review of the existing station file.
b. An update of the file to include personnel, facility, or
other significant changes. Criteria for appointment and background
investigation procedures for a change in status will be in keeping with this
section.
c. Official inspection stations will be permitted to continue
to perform safety inspections during a change of ownership investigation
provided at least one safety inspector is retained from the prior owner.
d. If disqualifying criteria is revealed, the station's
appointment shall be canceled until final disposition of the application is
made or until issues of disqualifying criteria are resolved.
C. Once an official inspection station has been suspended,
regardless of the cause for the suspension, management may request
reinstatement up to 60 days prior to the expiration of the suspension period.
Stations whose appointments are revoked may complete the application process as
set forth for original appointments after the expiration of the period of
revocation.
1. The applicant station must submit a letter to Safety
Division Headquarters (Attention: Station Files) requesting reinstatement.
2. An application package will be forwarded to the applicant.
3. The completed application forms are to be returned to
Safety Division Headquarters (Attention: Station Files).
4. After review, the application package is forwarded to the
appropriate Safety Division Area Office for investigation.
a. The trooper assigned to the investigation will compare the
information in the new application package to the information in the existing
files.
b. The investigation will focus on any changes or
inconsistencies.
c. The applicant station must meet all criteria for appointment
as set forth in this section.
d. Any applicant whose application for reinstatement is
rejected or withdrawn may not reapply sooner than six months from the date he
is notified of the rejection or withdrawal of the application.
D. Failure to comply with the provisions of this section
shall be grounds for termination of the application process or cancellation of
the official inspection station's appointment. An applicant having an
application terminated or an official inspection station having an appointment
canceled for noncompliance may not reapply for a period of one year.
Part II
Inspection Requirements
19VAC30-70-10. Official inspection station requirements.
A. Official inspection stations, except private appointments,
shall be open at least eight hours of each normal business day and shall be
able to perform inspections 12 months throughout the year, except during
illness of limited duration or normal vacation.
1. Normal business hours, Monday through Friday, are defined
as an eight-hour period of time between 8 a.m. and 6 p.m.
2. Stations are not prohibited from performing inspections at
times other than during normal business hours.
3. A station that advertises inspections beyond normal
business hours shall be able to perform such inspections.
4. If a station desires to maintain business hours that are
different from those defined in this section, written permission must be
obtained from the safety officer and a sign setting forth the inspection hours
must be posted conspicuously at the station where it can be observed by a
person desiring to have a vehicle inspected.
B. At least one full-time safety inspector to perform
inspections and one inspection lane meeting the minimum requirements shall be
available for inspection at all times during the normal business day. All
inspections must be made only at the locations and in the inspection lane
approved by the Department of State Police. All stations shall have other
lanes, bays, or areas in which repairs can be made so the inspection lane can
remain available.
The designated inspection areas, including any location where
customers are permitted to enter when submitting vehicles for inspection, must
be kept clean and free from excessive dirt, grease, and loose materials. If
requested, customers presenting vehicles for inspection shall be allowed to
observe the inspection process from a safe location designated by the station.
C. Inspection station facilities must be properly maintained
and must present a businesslike appearance to the general public. Property
adjacent to the inspection station that is owned or controlled by the station
must be free of debris, litter, used parts and junk vehicles. Vehicles properly
contained within fenced storage areas shall be deemed to comply with this
requirement.
D. Inspections shall be performed on a first-come,
first-served basis. "First-come, first-served" means a procedure
whereby customers seeking an inspection shall be attended to in the order that
they arrive to the station. Motorists shall not be required to make an
appointment to obtain an inspection, except those appointments Official
inspection stations may, at their discretion, accept vehicles on a first-come,
first served basis or by prescheduled appointments for the safety inspection of
a motor vehicle pursuant to § 46.2-1157 of the Code of Virginia.
Appointments shall be made for those motorists that are required by
subdivision A 12 of § 46.2-1158.01 of the Code of Virginia. Stations that
take in vehicles for inspection at the beginning of the work day shall not be
required to stop inspecting those vehicles to provide an inspection for a
drive-in request, provided inspections are currently being performed at the
time and will continue throughout the day. Stations must maintain a procedure
to validate when vehicles were brought to the station for inspection.
Inspections shall begin concurrently with repair lanes during the station's
normal business hours, without delay. Stations may suggest to motorists a
timeframe of no greater than three hours during which it may be anticipated
that an inspection may be provided. Stations shall cooperate fully with
Department of State Police personnel regarding any issues detailed in this
section, as with all other investigations.
In addition to accepting vehicles on a first-come,
first-served basis, any official inspection station consisting of two or more
inspection lanes may accept prescheduled appointments for the safety inspection
of a motor vehicle pursuant to § 46.2-1157 of the Code of Virginia, so
long as at least one lane is reserved for the sole purpose of first-come,
first-served safety inspections. An additional certified safety inspector shall
be available to perform those inspections that are made by an appointment.
Stations shall make every effort to keep the designated
inspection lanes available. Stations with more than one repair bay shall not
perform work in the designated inspection lanes when customers are waiting for
an inspection. This will not apply to minor adjustments that require minimal
time to perform. Stations shall not let vehicles occupy the designated
inspection lanes while awaiting parts or customer authorization to complete the
inspection pursuant to 19VAC30-70-60.
E. Safety inspectors, managers who supervise inspection activities,
and business owners, through participation in the Official Motor Vehicle
Inspection Program, are representatives of the Department of State Police and
should conduct themselves in a manner to avoid controversy in dealing with
customers presenting vehicles for inspection. The use of profanity or verbal
abuse directed at customers presenting their vehicles for inspection will be
grounds for suspension from participation in the inspection program and will be
considered a Class IV offense as set forth in 19VAC30-70-6.
Controversy that cannot be calmly resolved by the safety
inspector, managers, and owners should be referred to the supervising trooper
for handling.
F. The "Certificate of Appointment" must be framed
under glass or clear plastic and posted in the customer waiting area where it
can be observed and read by a person submitting a vehicle for inspection.
Inspection stations must have garage liability insurance in
the amount of at least $500,000 with an approved surplus lines carrier or
insurance company licensed to write such insurance in this Commonwealth. This
requirement shall not apply to inspection stations that only inspect their
company-owned, government-owned, or leased vehicles.
G. The required "Official Inspection Procedure"
sheet and the "Direct Inquiries" sheet furnished to each station must
both be framed under glass or clear plastic and posted conspicuously in the
customer waiting area where they can be observed and read by a person
submitting a vehicle for inspection.
H. The poster designating the station as an official
inspection station shall be posted in a prominent location, outside or visible
outside the station, to alert passersby that inspection services are available.
Private inspection stations shall not display an outside poster.
I. Each official inspection station shall display a list with
the names and license expiration dates of all employees licensed to inspect
at that station each active inspector associated to the station within
the MVIP system, adjacent to the certificate of appointment. All
inspectors listed must be actively employed by the station. The Official
Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual will be kept at or near the point of
inspection for ready reference. The manual may be kept in written or electronic
form.
J. Important -- Any change in name, ownership or location of
any official inspection station cancels the appointment of that station, and
the Department of State Police must be notified immediately. The department
shall be notified when an official inspection station discontinues operation.
K. All inspection supplies, inspection binders and manual,
unused stickers, duplicates of certificates issued, bulletins and other forms
are the property of the Department of State Police and must be safeguarded
against loss.
L. Inspection supplies issued to an inspection station can be
used only by that station and are not to be loaned or reissued to any other
station.
1. Stations must maintain a sufficient supply of approval
stickers, trailer and motorcycle approval stickers, rejection stickers and
inserts. When reordering supplies, station owners or managers shall request
sufficient supplies to sustain their business for at least six months. However,
it is realized that a few stations will not be able to comply with the
six-month requirement since there is a maximum of 100 books per order limit. Also,
when ordering supplies, the following information should be considered so that
the station does not order an excessive amount of supplies: each book of
approval stickers contains 25 stickers, the rejection book contains 50
stickers, the month inserts are packaged in strips of 50 each, and trailer and
motorcycle decals are five per strip. In December of each year, a supply of
year inserts will be shipped to each station based on the station's previous
year's usage. In November, each station shall check its stock of month inserts
and order what is needed for the months of January through June. In May, the
same should be done for the months of July through December.
2. Inspection stations that exhaust any type of their supply
of supplies, such as approval stickers, trailer and motorcycle
approval stickers, rejection stickers, and or inserts shall
immediately stop performing new inspections all inspection operations
and contact their supervising trooper or the nearest Safety Division Area
Office.
M. All losses of stickers must be reported immediately to the
supervising inspection trooper or the nearest Safety Division Area Office.
N. Every precaution against the loss of stickers must be
taken. If the loss occurs through carelessness or neglect, a suspension of the
station may result.
O. Manuals, bulletins, other regulations and lists of
approved equipment must be available at all times for reference and may be kept
in written or electronic form. Revisions to the Motor Vehicle Safety Inspection
Manual will be sent to each station electronically through the MVIP system.
Station management shall be responsible to see that each safety inspector is
familiar with all bulletins and manual revisions and shall be required to
furnish evidence to the department that all bulletins and manual revisions have
been reviewed by each licensed inspector.
A copy of the diagram drawn by the investigating trooper,
showing the approved inspection lane or lanes, will be maintained for review
and kept available with the station's inspection supplies.
P. Private appointment may be made of company stations or
government stations that own and operate a minimum of 20 vehicles and they may
inspect only company-owned or government-owned vehicles respectively. When
authorized by the department, they may inspect vehicles of a wholly-owned
subsidiary or leased vehicles.
1. A private station may perform inspections during each month
of the year or may elect to inspect only during certain designated months.
2. A private station not electing to inspect vehicles every
month of the year that finds it necessary to inspect a vehicle during a month
other than those selected for inspection may issue a sticker to the vehicle
from the nearest past inspection month.
Q. All official inspection station owners, managers, and
certified safety inspectors shall comply with the Virginia inspection laws and
the inspection rules and regulations and will adhere to all instructions given
by the supervising trooper or the Safety Division. Reports of violations will
be investigated and, if found to be valid, may result in the suspension of the
station, suspension of the inspector, possible court action, or other
appropriate action, or any combination of these actions. Repeated violations or
serious violations may result in a revocation of the inspector or
station appointment, or both, by the superintendent.
R. The arrest of any person associated with the inspection
program for a criminal offense of a nature that would tend to immediately
reflect upon the integrity and reputation of the Department of State Police may
be grounds for an immediate suspension and the conviction for such an offense
may result in a revocation of the station's appointment.
S. When a station has been suspended or revoked, it must
release to an employee of the Department of State Police all inspection
supplies, posters, and papers including the certificate of appointment. Failure
to do so is a violation of § 46.2-1172 of the Code of Virginia.
T. The authority of the superintendent to suspend the
designation or appointment of an official inspection station as provided in §
46.2-1163 of the Code of Virginia, or to suspend the certification of an
inspector designated to perform inspections at an official inspection station,
and, in keeping with the provisions of § 46.2-1166 of the Code of Virginia, is
hereby delegated to any of the following supervisory ranks of the Department of
State Police: Lieutenant Colonel, Major, Captain, Lieutenant, First Sergeant
and Sergeant.
U. Each station must purchase and keep in proper operating
condition the following equipment: computer, printer, internet connection,
paper hole punch, black ball point pen or pens or black marker or markers,
sticker scraper with replacement razor blades, tire tread depth gauge, amp
meter, headlight and auxiliary lamp adjustment tools, 12-inch ruler, 25-foot
measuring tape, torque wrench or torque sticks, brake pads/shoes/disc/drum
measuring device, dial indicator, micrometer, pry bars, roller jack (at least
4-ton), and an approved type optical headlight aiming device. Each station that
requests an additional inspection lane that is not in close proximity to the
originally approved inspection lane must purchase an additional approved
headlight machine for each lane that meets the minimum requirements. Stations
are required to have one of the following headlight aiming devices effective
January 1, 2013: the: Hopkins Vision1, Hopkins Vision 100, American
Aimers Vision 100, American Aimers Vision 2 Pro, or the Symtech (former L.E.T.),
DVA-6, HBA-5, PLA-11, and PLA-12. This shall not apply to
"trailer-only" inspection stations.
19VAC30-70-11. Automated Motor Vehicle Inspection Program
(MVIP).
A. Effective March 1, 2011, the automated Motor Vehicle
Inspection Program (MVIP) was implemented. The MVIP system will enable the
Safety Division and inspection stations to more efficiently record and retain
data, thereby enhancing the overall operation of the program.
B. Passwords or personal identification numbers (PINs) shall
only be used by the person to whom they were assigned.
C. Automated stations shall order all supplies via the MVIP
system. Stations will ensure supplies are ordered no more than once per month.
D. Once a certified safety inspector completes an inspection,
he will be required to immediately enter the inspection information via the
MVIP system. In the event there is an MVIP or internet connection
failure, inspectors will complete the corresponding receipt provided in the
approval or rejection sticker book. A manual copy will be given to the customer
or placed in the vehicle, while the original will remain in the book.
Inspections performed during such outages shall be entered into MVIP by the
inspector performing the inspections and done so by the close of business of
the day MVIP connectivity is restored.
E. All stations and inspectors are required to verify the
accuracy of the information entered through the MVIP system to include:
1. One copy of the official safety inspection approval/rejection
approval or rejection receipt shall be printed on 8-1/2 by 11 inch white
paper and given to the customer or placed in the vehicle. The size of the print
on the receipt shall not be reduced. In the event of MVIP or internet
connection failure, the corresponding manual receipt from the book shall take
the place of the MVIP generated receipt.
2. The printed official inspection receipt number shall
correspond with the issued decal.
3. The complete vehicle identification number (VIN) shall be
verified before submitting the inspection through the MVIP system and printing
the official inspection receipt.
F. When a station has a voided decal, it must be entered into
MVIP by the inspector. Once entered, the receipt shall be printed, attached to
the decal, and retained until the supervising trooper's next visit. The
supervising trooper will be responsible for destroying the voided sticker and a
Form SP-164 will not be required.
G. Once a book of stickers is completed, station Station
management shall ensure that all decals stickers are accounted
for and all information has been entered correctly into the MVIP system.
Completed books approval or rejection receipts shall be retained
by the station for a period of six months. At the end of the six-month period,
used receipts shall be destroyed by burning or shredding.
19VAC30-70-30. Inspector requirements.
A. The inspection of motor vehicles required by these rules
and regulations shall be made only by those individuals who are certified and
licensed as safety inspectors by the Department of State Police. The procedures
outlined in this section are applicable to the processing of applications for
initial certification, reclassification of safety inspector's licenses, and
reinstatement of suspended or revoked safety inspector's licenses.
B. All certified inspectors shall be at least 18 years of
age. In addition, all certified inspectors shall have:
1. A minimum of one year of practical experience as an
automotive mechanic or six months of practical experience as an automotive
mechanic combined with an additional and separate six months of mirroring a
certified state inspector, or
2. Satisfactorily completed a training program in the field of
automotive mechanics approved by the Superintendent of State Police.
A person who has met either of the practical experience requirements
in repairing motorcycles may be certified to inspect motorcycles only and a
person who meets them in repairing trailers may be certified to inspect
trailers only.
C. Each mechanic entering the inspection program will be
required to satisfactorily pass a written and practical examination exhibiting
his knowledge of the inspection procedures.
D. Each certified inspector shall possess a valid Virginia
driver's license with the following exceptions:
1. An inspector who is a resident of an adjoining state
holding a valid driver's license in that state and who commutes regularly to
work in Virginia; or
2. A member of the armed forces of the United States on active
duty, or a dependent thereof, who holds a driver's license from his home
state.
E. An inspector whose driver's license is suspended or
revoked, including the seven-day administrative suspension for a DUI arrest,
must immediately notify the station's supervising trooper or the local Safety
Division Area Office of the suspension or revocation. The suspension or
revocation of an inspector's driver's license shall automatically act as a
suspension of his privilege to inspect motor vehicles until such suspension or revocation
is terminated and the reinstatement has been made by the Superintendent of
State Police.
F. Each licensed safety inspector must have a valid safety
inspector's license in his possession at all times while conducting
inspections.
G. Each safety inspector with a valid safety inspector's
license need only present such valid license to his new employer to commence
participation in the program at his new place of employment. Management of the
inspection station is required to notify the Safety Division when a safety
inspector begins or ends employment. This may be handled by contacting the
Safety Division Headquarters in Richmond by telephone.
H. An inspector must promptly notify the Safety Division in
writing of any change in his home address as shown on the safety inspector's
license. In the event the license becomes mutilated, lost or stolen, the
inspector must notify the Department of State Police immediately in writing,
requesting a duplicate. The Safety Inspector Notification Form shall be used
and all requested information should be printed plainly and completely. For
those inspectors who are not employed, write "Inactive" in the
station name block. In those cases where notification is being made due to an
address change, it will be necessary to: (i) fill out the form completely and
(ii) retain a copy of the form and license until a permanent (new) license is
received. In those cases where the license has been lost, stolen or mutilated,
complete steps in clauses (i) and (ii) as set forth in this subsection. The
notification form may be duplicated as necessary.
I. An inspector must immediately notify the station's
supervising trooper or local Safety Division Area Office of an arrest for a
criminal offense or the institution of a civil action.
J. Requirements for safety inspector applicants with a
specific learning disability:
1. Applicants will be required to furnish documentation from
the particular school division where the applicant was classified as having a
learning disability. The specific learning disability will be clearly
identified.
2. Once the learning disability has been documented, and if
applicable, the applicant will be allowed to test with the written exam being
orally presented.
3. The station management where the applicant is employed or
to be employed must agree to have someone present during the hours the employee
is conducting inspections to assist with the reading of the Official Motor
Vehicle Safety Inspection Manual when necessary during the initial three-year
certification period. If the inspector changes stations within the first
three-year period, it is the inspector's responsibility to notify station
management of his disability and this requirement.
19VAC30-70-50. Approval stickers and decals.
A. If the vehicle meets all inspection requirements, the
certified safety inspector performing the inspection shall immediately enter
the receipt information via the MVIP system.
The inspection sticker is not valid unless the rear portion
is completed with the vehicle make, year built, license plate number (dealer
name if a dealer tag is displayed), body type, and the complete vehicle
identification number (VIN). The inspection sticker shall be completed using
black indelible ink.
B. Approval stickers and decals shall be issued according to
the following schedule:
ANNUAL PROGRAM
|
Vehicles inspected in January are issued stickers bearing
the Number "1"
Vehicles inspected in February are issued stickers bearing the Number
"2"
Vehicles inspected in March are issued stickers bearing the Number
"3"
Vehicles inspected in April are issued stickers bearing the Number
"4"
Vehicles inspected in May are issued stickers bearing the Number
"5"
Vehicles inspected in June are issued stickers bearing the Number
"6"
Vehicles inspected in July are issued stickers bearing the Number
"7"
Vehicles inspected in August are issued stickers bearing the Number
"8"
Vehicles inspected in September are issued stickers bearing the Number
"9"
Vehicles inspected in October are issued stickers bearing the Number "10"
Vehicles inspected in November are issued stickers bearing the Number
"11"
Vehicles inspected in December are issued stickers bearing the Number
"12"
|
All February annual inspection stickers for trailer and
motorcycle decals (#2) due to expire at midnight, February 28 automatically
will be valid through midnight February 29 each leap year.
C. The numeral decal indicating the month of expiration shall
be inserted in the box identified as month and the numeral decal indicating the
year of expiration shall be inserted in the box identified as year of the
approval sticker and the trailer or motorcycle sticker. Extreme care should be
used by inspectors in applying these inserts. On all windshields, the sticker
is to be placed at the bottom left corner of the windshield when viewed
from the inside of the vehicle. The left edge of the sticker is to be placed as
close as practical, but no closer than one inch to the left edge of the
windshield when viewed from the inside of the vehicle. The top edge of the sticker
is to be approximately four inches from the bottom of the windshield when
viewed from the inside of the vehicle.
On passenger vehicles not equipped with a windshield, the
sticker shall be placed on or under the dash and protected in some manner from
the weather.
EXCEPTIONS: On vehicles equipped with heating and grid
elements on the inside of the windshield, the sticker shall be placed one inch
above the top of the grid element and the left edge of the sticker shall be
approximately one inch to the right of the left edge of the windshield when
viewed from the inside of the vehicle.
Any sticker or decal required by the laws of any other state
or the District of Columbia and displayed upon the windshield of a vehicle
submitted for inspection in the Commonwealth is permitted by the
superintendent, provided the vehicle is currently registered in that
jurisdiction, and the sticker is displayed in a manner designated by the
issuing authority and has not expired. In these cases, if the sticker or decal
is located where the inspection sticker is to be placed, it will not be removed
unless the owner or operator authorizes its removal. The inspection sticker
will be placed 1/4 inch to the right of the sticker or decal when viewed from
the inside of the vehicle without removing or overlapping the sticker or decal.
D. The Code of Virginia requires that the inspection sticker
be displayed on the windshield or at other designated places at all times. The
inspection sticker cannot be transferred from one vehicle to another.
EXCEPTION: If the windshield in a vehicle is replaced, a
valid sticker may be removed from the old windshield and placed on the new
windshield.
E. The sticker issued to a motorcycle shall be affixed to the
left side of the cycle where it will be most visible after mounting. The
sticker may be placed on a plate on the left side where it will be most visible
and securely fastened to the motorcycle for the purpose of displaying the
sticker. The sticker may be placed horizontally or vertically.
F. Trailer stickers will be issued to all trailers and
semitrailers required to be inspected. (No boat, utility, or travel trailer
that is not equipped with brakes shall be required to be inspected.)
G. All inspected trailers must display a trailer sticker on
that particular vehicle. These stickers are to be placed on the left side of
the trailer near the front corner. The sticker must be affixed to the trailer
body or frame. In those instances where a metal back container with a removable
transparent cover has been permanently affixed to the trailer body, the sticker
may be glued to it. The container must be permanently mounted in such a manner
that the sticker must be destroyed to remove it.
H. In all other cases involving unusually designed trailers
such as pole trailers, the safety inspector is to exercise his own good
judgment in placing the sticker at a point where it will be as prominent as
possible and visible for examination from the left side.
I. Motorcycles have a separate sticker that is orange and
issued with the prefix M. Trailers have a separate sticker that is blue and
issued with the prefix T. The trailer and motorcycle receipts are completed in
the same manner as other inspection receipts.
J. Appointed stations will keep sufficient inspection
supplies on hand to meet their needs. Requests for additional supplies shall be
ordered via the MVIP system. Requests for supplies that are to be picked up at
the Safety Division Headquarters must be made at least 24 hours prior to pick
up.
Packing slips mailed with inspection supplies will be kept on
file at the station for at least 24 months.
K. All unused center inserts used to indicate the month that
a sticker expires, in possession of the inspection station at the end of each
month, shall be retained by the inspection station, properly safeguarded, and
used in the inspection of vehicles for that particular month in the following
year or be disposed of as directed by the Department of State Police.
All inspection supplies that are voided, damaged, disfigured
or become unserviceable in any manner, will be returned to the Safety Division.
New replacement supplies will be issued to the station. Expired stickers will
be picked up by the station's supervising trooper.
L. All voided approval or rejection stickers will be picked
up by the station's supervising trooper.
M. The MVIP system approval or rejection printed receipt
shall be given to the owner or operator of the vehicle. In the event of an
MVIP or internet connection failure, manual receipts from the approval and rejection
books shall be utilized.
N. All yellow receipt copies of approval stickers and
decals will be retained in the books and shall be kept on file at the
station for at least six months. They may be inspected by any law-enforcement
officer during normal business hours.
O. Safety Division troopers may replace inspection stickers
that have separated from the windshield of motor vehicles and become lost or
damaged without conducting an inspection of the safety components of the
vehicle. Such replacement of inspection stickers shall be made only in
accordance with the following provisions:
1. A vehicle owner or operator complaining of the loss or
damage to the inspection sticker on the windshield of their vehicle due to
separation of the sticker from the windshield shall be directed to the nearest
Safety Division Area Office or Safety Division trooper.
2. Safety Division troopers, upon receipt of a complaint from
a vehicle owner or operator that their inspection sticker has been stolen, lost
or become damaged due to separation from the windshield, will make arrangements
to meet the person to effect the replacement of the sticker. A vehicle owner or
operator alleging theft of the inspection sticker will furnish proof to the
Safety Division trooper that such theft has been reported to the proper
law-enforcement authority.
3. The vehicle owner or operator must produce the original
safety inspection approval sticker receipt indicating a valid approval
inspection sticker was issued to the vehicle within the past 11 months. (The
vehicle must be reinspected if the expiration of the original inspection
sticker is in the month the request is being made.)
4. The Safety Division trooper will verify by the inspection
receipt that the vehicle was issued an approval inspection sticker within the
past 11 months and will then issue a replacement inspection sticker to the
vehicle. If any obvious equipment defects are detected during the replacement
process, the vehicle will not be issued a replacement approval sticker.
5. The Safety Division trooper will complete the inspection
sticker receipt for the approval sticker from information contained on the
original receipt. The date the replacement sticker is issued will be used in
the date space. In the space for Inspection Related Charges, the trooper will
insert the word "REPLACEMENT" and the sticker number from the
original inspection receipt.
6. The Safety Division trooper will sign the receipt
vertically in the O.K. column in the "Equipment Inspected" blocks.
These blocks will not otherwise be completed.
7. The Safety Division trooper shall place month and year
inserts on the inspection sticker to reflect the expiration as shown on the
original approval inspection sticker and place the inspection sticker on the
windshield in accordance with the requirements of subsection C of this section.
8. The Safety Division trooper will enter the replacement
information into the MVIP system.
P. New vehicle safety inspections.
1. Section 46.2-1158.01 of the Code of Virginia allows an
employee who customarily performs the inspection requirement of a manufacturer
or distributor of new motor vehicles to place an inspection sticker furnished
by the Department of State Police on the vehicle once it has met the
requirements of that manufacturer or distributor. This employee does not have
to be a certified safety inspector.
2. With the addition of other personnel using Department of
State Police inspection supplies, a system shall be developed at each
inspection station to afford accountability of all supplies. The system shall
include proper safeguards to prevent the loss of supplies through carelessness,
neglect, theft, or unauthorized use.
3. Inspection stations shall not mix annual state inspections
with predelivery inspections (PDI) in the same book of inspection stickers.
4. All employees shall be reminded that anyone who performs
inspections, whether it be for the annual inspection or the PDI inspection, is
subject to criminal prosecution if inspection supplies are used illegally or
used in some other unauthorized way.
5. Station management and licensed safety inspectors are
subject to administrative sanctions for any misuse of inspection supplies.
6. The inspection receipts shall be completed as usual with
the following exceptions: On the "inspector" line, the initials
"PDI" (for predelivery inspection) and the printed employee's name
performing the inspection shall be entered. On the "inspector's license
number" line, the letters "N/A" shall be entered. In the equipment
inspected section, the words "New Vehicle" shall be entered in the
"adjust" column. The PDI employee performing the inspection shall
sign his name in the "O.K." column.
19VAC30-70-60. Rejection stickers.
A. Only one rejection sticker shall be issued to any one
vehicle. A rejection sticker shall not be issued to any vehicle already bearing
such a sticker or to one which bears evidence of previously being issued a
rejection sticker. When a vehicle is bearing a valid or expired rejection
sticker, it is not to be removed unless the vehicle meets all of the inspection
requirements.
B. A vehicle rejected by one station may be reinspected by
another station if the owner desires to have this done; however, that station
shall perform a complete inspection of the vehicle.
C. Reinspection of a rejected vehicle by the same station
during the 15-day validity of the rejection sticker need include only a check
of the items previously found defective, unless there is an obvious equipment
defect that would warrant further rejection of the vehicle. Such reinspection
will not constitute a complete inspection and a $1.00 fee may be charged.
Furthermore, if a vehicle returns for reinspection within the 15-day period,
the rejecting station will reinspect the vehicle without delay or at the
reasonable conclusion of the current inspection being performed.
1. If additional defects are detected during reinspection of a
vehicle previously rejected, the vehicle will not be issued an approval
sticker.
2. No vehicle bearing a valid rejection sticker shall be
entitled to receive more than two reinspections by the rejecting station during
the validity period of the rejection sticker.
3. The validity period of the rejection sticker shall be 15
days in addition to the day of inspection.
4. Any vehicle that is presented for inspection at another
inspection station after the 15-day validity period, if the vehicle was
rejected for brakes, and the inspector cannot determine which wheels were
checked, then all four wheels will be removed to ensure that all repairs or
defects have been corrected.
D. If repairs are to be made to a rejected vehicle that would
necessitate removing the vehicle from the inspection lane, no rejection sticker
need be issued; however, the vehicle must be returned to an approved lane for a
recheck of the rejected items and the application of the approval sticker.
E. If the vehicle does not meet all the requirements and the
owner does not authorize immediate repairs, and if a rejection sticker has not
already been issued, a rejection sticker shall be legibly filled out in its
entirety with a black ball point pen. The certified safety inspector performing
the inspection shall immediately enter the receipt information via the MVIP
system. The complete vehicle identification number (VIN), tag number or car
dealer name if a dealer tag is attached, mileage, year, make, and model shall
be included. A circle to indicate which wheels were pulled to check the brakes
and an individual mark shall be placed in each equipment block of the rejection
sticker that was pertinent to the rejection. In addition, information may be
written on any blank area as to the exact nature of the rejection (i.e., front
brakes vs. rear brakes). The date of issue shall be punched, and the sticker
affixed to the same location as indicated in subsections C, E, and G of
19VAC30-70-50. (When affixed to a trailer or motorcycle, the face of the
rejection sticker shall be attached to the trailer or motorcycle in order to
allow the rejection data on the back side to be read.)
F. The operator of the rejected
vehicle shall be informed of the following:
1. The rejection sticker is valid for 15 days in addition to
the date of inspection.
2. The rejection sticker places no travel restriction on the
operation of the vehicle and is issued in lieu of an approval sticker.
3. The vehicle operator is legally responsible for any defect
if operated on the highway and may be subject to a traffic summons for any
existing equipment violation.
G. Duplicate copies (pink) of rejection stickers shall be
forwarded, in numerical order, to the Safety Division by the fifth of the month
following the month of inspection. The yellow copy shall be retained, in
numerical order, by the station for at least 24 months. All receipt
copies of rejection stickers will be retained in the books and shall be kept on
file at the station for at least six months. They may be inspected by any
law-enforcement officer during normal business hours.
19VAC30-70-90. Brakes: emergency, parking, or holding;
batteries.
A. Some vehicles are equipped with an actual emergency brake,
while others have only a parking or holding brake. Some types may be actuated
by a foot or hand lever, while others may incorporate a switch or valve to
actuate the brake. Air and vacuum brake systems may employ spring activating parking
brakes.
B. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Vehicle or combination of vehicles is not equipped with a
parking, holding, or emergency brake in good working order of the type
installed as original standard factory equipment for the vehicle on which it is
installed.
2. The parking brake actuating mechanism does not fully
release when the control is operated to the off position or if the parking
brake lamp light remains on.
NOTE: The light does not apply to vehicles that are not
equipped with a parking (emergency) brake indicator light.
3. Any mechanical parts are missing, broken, badly worn, or
are inoperative.
4. Cables are stretched, worn, or frayed or not operating
freely.
5. Grease or other similar-type
contamination is present on the linings, drums, or rotors.
6. Parking brake will not hold the vehicle stationary with the
engine running at slightly accelerated speed with shift lever in drive position
for automatic transmission or shift lever in low gear with clutch engaged for
standard shift transmission.
7. Holding brake will not disengage when engine is started and
vehicle is placed in drive. Holding brake will not hold vehicle stationary with
foot on holding brake and vehicle in drive.
8. On vehicles equipped with automatic transmissions, the
vehicle will start in any gear other than (P) park and (N) neutral. If the
gearshift indicator does not identify the park (P) and neutral (N) positions,
then the vehicle shall be rejected.
9. On vehicles equipped with manual transmissions, the vehicle
will start in any gear if the clutch is not depressed or disengaged.
NOTE: This will not apply to older model vehicles, which were
not originally equipped with a neutral-safety switch, clutch disengagement
system or clutch pedal position sensor by the manufacturer.
10. The accelerator does not disengage after being depressed,
allowing the engine to return to a normal idle speed.
C. Battery mounting and storage. Inspect for and reject if:
1. A battery is not securely attached to a fixed part of the
motor vehicle or trailer. A battery is not protected by a removable cover or
enclosure if the battery is installed in a location other than the engine
compartment.
2. All brackets, hardware, bolts, and bushings used for
securely mounting the battery to the vehicle are not present.
3. Removable covers or enclosures are not substantial and are
not securely latched or fastened.
4. The battery compartment does not have openings to provide
ample battery ventilation and drainage.
5. Whenever the cable to the starting motor passes through a
metal compartment, the cable shall be protected against grounding by an acid
and waterproof insulating bushing.
6. Whenever a battery and a fuel tank are both placed under
the driver's seat, (i) the battery and fuel tank are not partitioned from each
other or (ii) each compartment is not provided with an independent cover,
ventilation, and drainage.
19VAC30-70-120. Frame, engine mounts, coupling devices and
emergency chains.
Inspect for and reject if:
1. Frame or unitized body of any motor vehicle, trailer or
semitrailer is broken, cracked, bent or damaged at any location, including any
welded joint and/or or is rusted or corroded to the point the
frame is weakened as to reasonably constitute a hazard during the
operation of the vehicle.
2. Engine or transmission mounts and hardware is broken or
missing. This includes all hardware bolts and bushings used for mounting to the
vehicle's frame, engine, or transmission. Any engine or transmission mount
shall be rejected if they allow the power train to come in contact with the
firewall or other body parts. Cab Any body, truck bed, or bumper
mounts or mounting hardware shall be rejected if they do not properly
secure the body these components to the frame as originally
designed.
3. Trailer hitch or pintle hook is not securely attached.
Reject if the pintle eye or trailer drawbar has any cracks or if any welding
repairs have been made to the pintle eye.
4. Chains, cables, etc., used to attach a towed vehicle are not
securely attached or are broken, worn or abraded.
5. Fifth wheel does not lock in position or have a locking
mechanism in proper working order.
6. Fifth wheel assembly system has any leak of fluid or air.
7. Fifth wheel has any broken, missing, or damaged parts; or
is not securely attached to the frame.
8. Trailer king pin is not secure, or is broken or worn so as
to prevent secure fit in fifth wheel.
9. Any movement is detected at any location where any device
has been placed between the body and the chassis.
10. Trailer is not equipped with an emergency chain or steel
cable.
NOTE: Fifth wheel assembly system does not require an
emergency chain or cable. A fifth wheel is defined as a device which interfaces
with and couples to the upper coupler assembly of a semitrailer. The upper
coupler assembly is a structure consisting of an upper coupler plate, king pin
and supporting framework which interfaces with and couples to a fifth wheel.
Ball and socket connections also referred to as hitch and coupling connections
are not fifth wheel assemblies and do require an emergency chain or steel
cable.
19VAC30-70-160. Auxiliary lamps: backup; cornering; driving;
fog; spot and warning.
A. Auxiliary lamps on a vehicle consist of seven general
types: backup lamps (SAE-R), cornering lamps (SAE-K), driving lamps (SAE-Y),
front fog lamps with an amber or clear lens (SAE-F) and rear fog lamps with red
lens (SAE-F2), spot lamps (SAE-O), warning lamps (SAE-W, W2, W3), and daytime
running lamps (DRLs) (SAE-Y2).
B. School buses may be equipped with an eight-lamp warning
system of two red and two amber warning lamps of an approved type (SAE-W2) on
the front and rear of such vehicle.
1. School buses may also be equipped with roof-mounted
flashing white or amber warning lamps of an approved type (SAE-W2).
2. In addition to required warning lamps, school buses may be
equipped with a stop signal arm consisting of an octagonal sign which meets
FMVSS specifications (Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards, 49 CFR Part 571).
The stop signal arm shall be reflectorized or be equipped with two red warning
lamps of an approved type.
C. There is no limit on the number of backup lamps that a
vehicle may have so long as they are of an approved type (SAE-R).
D. No more than four lamps, including two headlamps, may be
lighted at any time to provide general illumination ahead of the vehicle.
E. Approved type (DOT or SAE-W) blue or blue and red lights
are permitted on Department of Corrections vehicles designated by the Director
of the Department of Corrections and any law-enforcement vehicle.
1. Approved type secondary warning lights installed only on
the four corners, on law-enforcement vehicles, Department of Corrections, fire
apparatus, government-owned vehicle operated on official business by a local
fire chief or other local fire official, rescue squad vehicle, ambulance, or
any other emergency medical vehicles. These lights shall also have primary
warning lights installed.
2. The hide-away or undercover strobe lights shall be
installed in the side marker lights, tail lights or parking lights. The strobe
itself must be clear and the lens color must continue to be the same type and
color as originally approved. It will not be permissible to install the
hide-away lights in the headlights.
3. Approved type (SAE-W) red warning lights or red and white
lights showing to the front are permitted on fire department vehicles,
including publicly-owned state forest warden vehicles, ambulances, any rescue
vehicle used for emergency calls, local department of emergency management,
animal warden vehicles, school buses and vehicles used by security personnel at
the Newport News Shipbuilding and Drydock Company, Bassett-Walker,
Incorporated, the Tultex Corporation, the Winchester Medical Center, or the
National Aeronautics and Space Administration's Wallops Flight Facility.
4. No more than two flashing or steady-burning red lights or
red and white combination lights of an approved type (SAE-W) may be installed
on one vehicle owned by any member of a fire department, volunteer fire company
or volunteer rescue squad, any ambulance driver employed by a privately-owned
ambulance service, and any police chaplain.
F. Vehicles mentioned in subsection E of this section
permitted to be equipped with flashing, blinking or alternating red, red and
white, blue, or blue and red emergency lights (except vehicles owned by any
member of a fire department, volunteer fire company, volunteer rescue squad or
any ambulance driver employed by a privately-owned ambulance service) may be
equipped with the means to flash their headlamps when their emergency warning
lamps are activated provided:
1. The headlamps are wired to allow either the upper beam or
lower beam to flash but not both.
2. The headlamp system includes a switch or device which prevents
flashing of headlamps when headlamps are required to be lighted pursuant to
current statute.
3. Emergency vehicles in Chesapeake, Poquoson, and York County
may be equipped with flashing headlights that will function whenever their
warning lights are activated.
G. Any firefighting vehicle, ambulance, rescue or life-saving
vehicle, Virginia Department of Transportation vehicle, or tow truck may be
equipped with clear auxiliary lamps which shall be used exclusively for
lighting emergency scenes. Such lamps shall be of a type permitted by the
superintendent. Any government-owned police vehicle may be equipped with clear
auxiliary lamps of a type approved by the superintendent.
H. Approved type (SAE-W) amber flashing, blinking or
alternating lights are permitted on vehicles used for the principal purpose of
towing or servicing disabled vehicles or in constructing, maintaining and
repairing highways or utilities on or along public highways and vehicles used
for the principal purpose of removing hazardous or polluting substances from
the state waters or drainage areas on or along public highways. Such lamps are
permitted on vehicles used for servicing automatic teller machines, refuse
collection vehicles, hi-rail vehicles and on vehicles used for towing or escorting
over-dimensional materials, equipment, boats, or manufactured housing units by
authority of highway hauling permit.
1. Approved type (SAE-W) amber flashing, blinking or
alternating lights are permitted on fire apparatus, government-owned vehicles
operated on official business by a local fire chief or other local fire
official, rescue squad vehicles, ambulances, and any other emergency medical
vehicles to be equipped with alternating blinking or flashing red, or red and
white secondary lights mounted inside the vehicle's tail lights or marker
lights.
2. Approved type (SAE-W) amber flashing, blinking or
alternating lights are permitted on vehicles owned and used by municipal safety
officers in the performance of their official duties, businesses providing
security services and vehicles used to collect and deliver the United States
mail, vehicles used by law-enforcement personnel in the enforcement of laws
governing motor vehicle parking, government-owned law-enforcement vehicles
provided the lights are used for giving directional warning, and
vehicles used to provide escort for funeral processions.
3. Approved type (SAE-W) amber flashing, blinking or
alternating lights are permitted on vehicles used as pace cars, security
vehicles, or firefighting vehicles by any speedway or motor vehicle race track.
4. An approved type (SAE-W) amber flashing, blinking or
alternating light may be mounted on the rear of any vehicle used to transport
petroleum products. The light must be wired through the reverse gear circuit
and activate in conjunction with the back-up lights and audible alarm.
5. An approved type (SAE-W) green warning light is permitted
on vehicles used by police, firefighting, or rescue personnel as command
centers at the scene of incidents. Such lights shall not be activated while the
vehicle is operating upon the highway.
6. Approved type (DOT or SAE-W) colored warning lights may
be used by dealers or businesses engaged in the sale of fire, emergency medical
services, or law-enforcement vehicles. They may, for demonstration purposes,
equip such vehicles with colored warning lights.
I. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Vehicle has an auxiliary Auxiliary lamp is
being used for a purpose other than for which it was is manufactured
or previously approved by the superintendent.
2. Auxiliary lamp does not have a clear lens.
3. Any reflector in such auxiliary lamp device is not
clear.
EXCEPTION: Any EXCEPTIONS: An auxiliary lighting
device that is both covered and not illuminated, other than lamps required,
unlit shall not be considered for inspection. An auxiliary lighting
device that has a clear lens, has clear reflectors, and is unlit shall not be
considered for inspection. Fog and driving lamps mounted below the level of
the regular headlamps must be checked for aim as outlined in subdivisions I 10
i and I 11 g 12 h and 13 f of this section if not covered.
NOTE: The covers shall be a type that would be installed as
original equipment and not tape, paper bags, aluminum foil or similar materials
per subdivision I 11 g (2) of this section.
2. 4. A vehicle has installed on it a warning
lamp (DOT or SAE-W) that is not of an approved type or has been altered.
Reject if the vehicle has wire, unapproved lens or plastic
covers, any other materials that are not original equipment or any colored
material placed on or in front of any auxiliary lamps: backup, cornering,
driving, fog, spot, or warning lamps.
3. 5. Motor vehicles may be equipped with more
than two fog or auxiliary lights; however, only two of these types of lights
can be illuminated at any time. Reject a vehicle equipped with a headlamp
mounted or used as an auxiliary lamp.
4. 6. Vehicle is equipped with an auxiliary lamp
that does not function properly. (If an auxiliary lamp has been modified by
removing the wiring, bulb and socket, the unit will be considered an ornament
and not a lamp and will not be considered in inspection.)
5. 7. Vehicle is equipped with a lighted
advertising sign, except commercial motor vehicles, buses operated as public
carriers, taxicabs, and privately-owned passenger cars used for home delivery
of commercially prepared food. Commercial motor vehicles, buses operated as
public carriers, and taxicabs may be equipped with vacant and destination signs
and one steady burning white light for the nighttime illumination of external
advertising. Privately-owned passenger cars used for home delivery of
commercially prepared food may be equipped with one steady burning white light
for the nighttime illumination of a sign identifying the business delivering
the food. Do not reject approved identification lights.
6. 8. Any lamp is not of an approved type or if
lamps to be burned together as a pair do not emit the same color light.
7. 9. The lens has a piece broken from it. The
lens may have one or more cracks provided an off-color light does not project
through the crack or cracks. Taping or gluing cracks or pieces is not
permitted.
8. 10. Backup lamps are not required. However,
if installed they must operate and be inspected.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. Lamps Required lamps are not of an approved
type (DOT or SAE-R) or a lamp has been altered;
b. Wiring or electrical connections are defective or filaments
do not burn;
c. The lens has a piece broken from it. The lens may have one
or more cracks provided an off-color light does not project through the crack or
cracks. Taping or gluing cracks or pieces is not permitted;
d. Lens is other than clear. LED (light-emitting diode) lights
with a clear lens are acceptable if of an approved type. For those vehicles
that are equipped with a multiple LED light (not filament-burning bulbs), they
will pass inspection if more than 50% of the diode lights are burning;
e. Lamps are not wired into the reverse gear. Vehicles
manufactured without backup lamps may be wired into an independent circuit.
9. 11. Cornering lamps are not required.
However, if installed they must operate and be inspected.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. Lamps Required lamps are not of an approved
type (DOT or SAE-K) or a lamp has been altered;
b. Wiring or electrical connections are defective or filaments
do not burn;
c. The lens has a piece broken from it. The lens may have one
or more cracks provided an off-color light does not project through the crack or
cracks. Taping or gluing cracks or pieces is not permitted;
d. The color of the light is other than clear or amber;
e. The lamps do not burn in conjunction with the turn signals.
10. 12. Driving lamps are not required. However,
if installed they must operate and be inspected.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. Driving lamps are installed on vehicles equipped with the
four-headlamp system, except the "F" type headlamp system;
b. A vehicle is equipped with more than two driving lamps;
c. Driving lamps are not of an approved type or have
been altered;
d. c. The color of the lamp is other than white;
e. d. The lens has a piece broken from it or is
rotated away from its proper position. The lens may have one or more cracks
provided an off-color light does not project through the crack or cracks.
Taping or gluing cracks or pieces is not permitted;
f. e. Wiring or electrical connections are
defective;
g. f. Any driving lamp is mounted above the
level of the regular headlamps, or is not mounted firmly to prevent excessive
vibration;
h. g. Driving lamps are not wired so that they
will burn only when the high beams of the regular headlamps are activated;
i. h. Driving lamps are not aimed so that
the center of the hot spot drops three inches in 25 feet so that the hot spot
is directly ahead of the lamp.
NOTE: Driving lamps must be aimed using the optical headlight
aimer. A tolerance of four inches in 25 feet is allowed in both the horizontal
and the vertical adjustment.
11. 13. Fog lamps are not required. However, if
installed they must operate and be inspected.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. A vehicle may be equipped with more than two fog lamps;
however, not more than two fog lamps can be illuminated at any time;
b. Lamps are not of an approved type (DOT or SAE-F on front
or F2 on rear plus two-digit year and manufacturer) or a lamp has been altered;
c. The lens is other than clear or amber. Fog lamps may
have black-end bulbs or small metal caps over the end of the bulb;
d. c. The lens has a piece broken from it or is
rotated away from its proper position. The lens may have one or more cracks
provided an off-color light does not project through the crack or cracks.
Taping or gluing cracks or pieces is not permitted;
e. d. Wiring or electrical connections are
defective or filaments do not burn;
f. e. Any fog lamp is mounted above the level of
the regular headlamps, or is not mounted firmly;
g. f. Lamps are not wired and aimed according to
the following instructions:
(1) Fog lamps are general illumination lamps as covered in
subsection A of this section. They must burn through the tail light circuit
even if on a separate switch. If installed on a vehicle with a four-headlamp
system, or a vehicle equipped with driving lamps, they must be wired into the
low beam circuit.
(2) Fog lamps must be aimed so that the top edge of the high
intensity zone is set at the horizontal centerline and the left edge of the
high intensity zone is set at the vertical centerline. (Same as low beam
headlights.)
NOTE: Fog lamps must be aimed using the optical headlight
aimer. A tolerance of four inches in 25 feet is allowed in both the horizontal
and the vertical adjustment.
12. 14. Spot lamps are not required; however, if
installed they must operate and be inspected.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. Vehicle is equipped with more than two spot lamps;
b. Lamps are not of an approved type (DOT or SAE-O) or a lamp
has been altered;
c. The lens in any spot lamp is other than clear;
d. The lens has a piece broken from it or is rotated away from
its proper position. The lens may have one or more cracks provided an off-color
light does not project through the crack or cracks. Taping or gluing
cracks or pieces is not permitted;
e. Wiring or electrical connections are defective or filaments
do not burn.
13. 15. Daytime running lamps (DRLs) are not
required. However, if installed they must operate and be inspected. DRLs must
be installed in pairs.
NOTE: DRLs may or may not be wired into the tail light
circuit.
Inspect for and reject if:
a. Any lamp, except headlamps, used as DRLs if not an approved
type (SAE-Y2) and is not marked "DRL";
b. Fog lamps or parking lamps are used as DRLs;
c. More than one pair of lamps is used and designated as DRLs;
d. A DRL is mounted higher than 34 inches measured to the
center of the lamp;
e. The color is other than white to amber;
f. DRLs do not deactivate when the headlamps are in any
"on" position.
Any DRL optically combined with a turn signal or hazard lamp
must deactivate when the turn signal or hazard lamp is activated and then
reactivate when the turn signal or hazard lamp deactivates.
19VAC30-70-210. Glass and glazing.
A. Motor vehicles may be inspected without windshields, side
glasses, or any kind of glazing, except that any motor vehicle other than a
motorcycle that was manufactured, assembled, or reconstructed after July 1,
1970, must be equipped with a windshield. If glass or other glazing is
installed, it must be inspected. If no windshield is installed, see
19VAC30-70-50 C for location of the sticker.
B. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Any motor vehicle manufactured or assembled after January
1, 1936, or any bus, taxicab or school bus manufactured or assembled after
January 1, 1935, is not equipped throughout with safety glass, or other safety
glazing material. (This requirement includes slide-in campers used on pickups
or trucks, caps, or covers used on pickup trucks, motor homes, and vans.)
2. Any safety glass or glazing used in a motor vehicle is not
of an approved type and properly identified (refer to approved equipment
section). (Replacement safety glass installed in any part of a vehicle other
than the windshield need not bear a trademark or name, provided the glass
consists of two or more sheets of glass separated by a glazing material, and
provided the glass is cut from a piece of approved safety glass, and provided
the edge of the glass can be observed.)
NOTE: A number of 1998 and 1999 model year Ford
Contour/Mystique, Econoline and Ranger vehicles were produced without the AS-1
windshield marking as required by FMVSS #205. Ford has certified that these
vehicles' windshields meet all performance standards and will not be rejected.
3. Any glass at any location where glass is used is cracked or
broken so that it is likely to cut or injure a person in the vehicle.
4. Windshield has any cloudiness more than three inches above
the bottom, one inch inward from the outer borders, one inch down from the top,
or one inch inward from the center strip. The bottom of the windshield shall be
defined as the point where the top of the dash contacts the windshield.
5. Any distortion or obstruction that interferes with a
driver's vision; any alteration that has been made to a vehicle that obstructs
the driver's clear view through the windshield. This may include large objects
hanging from the inside mirror or mounted to the windshield, cell phone
mounts, GPS devices, CB radios or tachometers mounted on the dash or
windshield, hood scoops, and other ornamentation on or in front of the hood
that is not transparent.
a. Any hood scoop installed on any motor vehicle manufactured
for the year 1990 or earlier model year cannot exceed 2-1/4 inches high at its
highest point measured from the junction of the dashboard and the windshield.
b. Any hood scoop installed on any motor vehicle manufactured
for the 1991 or subsequent model year cannot exceed 1-1/8 inches high at its
highest point measured from the junction of the dashboard and the windshield.
6. Windshield glass, on the driver's side, has any scratch
more than 1/4 inch in width and six inches long within the area covered by the
windshield wiper blade, excluding the three inches above the bottom of the
windshield. A windshield wiper that remains parked within the driver's side
windshield wiper area shall be rejected.
EXCEPTION: Do not reject safety grooves designed to clean
wiper blades if the grooves do not extend upward from the bottom of the
windshield more than six inches at the highest point.
7. There is a pit, chip, or star crack larger than 1-1/2
inches in diameter at any location in the windshield above the three-inch line
at the bottom.
8. At any location in the windshield above the three-inch line
at the bottom (as measured from the junction of the dash board and the
windshield) there is more than one crack from the same point if at least one of
the cracks is more than 1-1/2 inches in length. There is any crack that weakens
the windshield so that one piece may be moved in relation to the other. (If
there is more than one crack running from a star crack that extends above the
three-inch line, the windshield shall be rejected.)
EXCEPTION: Windshield repair is a viable option to windshield
replacement. A windshield that has been repaired will pass inspection unless:
a. It is likely to cut or injure a person.
b. There is any distortion that interferes with a driver's
vision.
c. The windshield remains weakened so that one piece may be
moved in relation to the other.
d. The integrity of the windshield has obviously been
compromised by the damage or the repair.
9. Any sticker is on the windshield other than an official one
required by law or permitted by the superintendent. Authorization is hereby
granted for stickers or decals, to include those required by any county, town,
or city, measuring not more than 2-1/2 inches in width and four inches in
length to be placed in the blind spot behind the rear view mirror. The normal
location for any required county, town, or city sticker is adjacent to the
right side of the official inspection sticker when viewed from inside the
vehicle. The top edge of the sticker is to be approximately four inches from
the bottom of the windshield. The left side edge adjacent to the official
inspection sticker shall not be more than 1/4 inch from the right edge of the
official inspection sticker when viewed from inside the vehicle. Valid
Commercial Vehicle Safety Alliance (CVSA) inspection decals or similar
commercial vehicle inspection decal issued by local law enforcement may be
placed at the bottom right corner of the windshield when viewed from inside the
vehicle. The top edge of such decals are to be approximately four inches from
the bottom of the windshield when viewed from inside the vehicle and are to be
located outside the area swept by the windshield wipers.
Any sticker or decal required by the laws of any other state
or the District of Columbia and displayed upon the windshield of a vehicle
submitted for inspection in this state is permitted by the superintendent,
provided the vehicle is currently registered in that jurisdiction, and the
sticker is displayed in a manner designated by the issuing authority and has
not expired. This includes vehicles with dual registration; (i.e., Virginia and
the District of Columbia).
NOTE: Any Virginia registered vehicle displaying a valid
sticker or decal required by a county, town, or city is permitted by the
superintendent to remain in its current location through December 31, 2018,
unless such location conflicts with the inspection sticker placement. This
provision will afford localities time to enact changes to regulations governing
required stickers or decals that may be impacted by the 2018 inspection sticker
placement change.
NOTE: Toll transponder devices may be affixed to the inside
center of the windshield at the roof line just above the rear view mirror. If
space does not allow, then the transponder device may be affixed to the
immediate right of the mirror at the roof line.
NOTE: A licensed motor vehicle dealer may apply one
transponder sticker no larger than one inch by four inches and one barcode
sticker no larger than three inches by four inches to the driver's side edge of
a vehicle's windshield to be removed upon the sale or lease of the vehicle
provided that it does not extend below the AS-1 line. In the absence of an AS-1
line the sticker cannot extend more than three inches downward from the top of
the windshield.
NOTE: Any vehicle displaying an expired sticker or decal on
its windshield at the time of inspection, excluding a rejection sticker, shall
not be issued an approval sticker unless the owner or operator authorizes its
removal. A rejection sticker will be issued versus an involuntary removal.
10. Sunshading material on the windshield or words,
lettering, numbers or pictures on the windshield that do not
extend below the AS-1 line will not be considered for inspection or
three inches downward from the top of the windshield in the absence of an AS-1
line. In the absence of an AS-1 line sunshading material on the
windshield displaying words, lettering, numbers or pictures cannot extend more
than three inches downward from the top of the windshield, unless Sunshading
is permitted on the windshield if authorized by the Virginia Department of
Motor Vehicles and indicated on the vehicle registration.
NOTE: Vehicles with permitted sunshading on the windshield
must have a cut-out to accommodate the direct application of an approval or
rejection sticker to the windshield in the location indicated in 19VAC30-70-50
C of 19VAC30-70-60 E.
NOTE: Vehicles with logos made into the glass at the factory
meet federal standards and will pass state inspection.
11. Any sunscreening material is scratched, distorted,
wrinkled or obscures or distorts clear vision through the glazing.
12. Front side windows have cloudiness above three inches from
the bottom of the glass or other defects that affect the driver's vision or one
or more cracks that permit one part of the glass to be moved in relation to
another part. Wind silencers, breezes or other ventilator adaptors are not made
of clear transparent material.
EXCEPTION: Colored or tinted ventvisors that do not exceed
more than two inches from the forward door post into the driver's viewing area
are permitted.
13. Glass in the left front door cannot be lowered so a hand
signal can be given. (This does not apply to vehicles that were not designed or
manufactured for the left front glass to be lowered, provided the vehicle is
equipped with approved turn signals.) If either front door has the glass
removed and material inserted in place of the glass that could obstruct the
driver's vision.
EXCEPTION: Sunscreening material is permissible if the vehicle
is equipped with a mirror on each side.
14. Any sticker or other obstruction is on either front side
window, rear side windows, or rear windows. (The price label, fuel economy
label and the buyer's guide required by federal statute and regulations to be
affixed to new or used vehicles by the manufacturer shall normally be affixed
to one of the rear side windows.) If a vehicle only has two door windows, the
labels may be affixed to one of these windows. If a vehicle does not have any door
or side windows the labels may be temporarily affixed to the right side of the
windshield until the vehicle is sold to the first purchaser.
NOTE: A single sticker no larger than 20 square inches in
area, if such sticker is totally contained within the lower five inches of the
glass in the rear window if a vehicle has only one outside mirror, a single
sticker or decal no larger than 10 square inches located in an area not more
than three inches above the bottom and not more than eight inches from the
rearmost edge of either front side window, is permissible and should not be
rejected.
A single sticker issued by the Department of Transportation to
identify a physically challenged driver, no larger than two inches by two
inches, located not more than one inch to the rear of the front door post, or
one inch to the rear of the front ventilator glass, if equipped with a
ventilator glass and no higher than one inch from the bottom of the window
opening, is permitted on the front driver's side window on a vehicle specially
equipped for the physically challenged.
15. Rear window is clouded or distorted so that the driver
does not have a view 200 feet to the rear.
EXCEPTIONS: The following are permissible if the vehicle is
equipped with a mirror on each side:
a. There is attached to one rear window of such motor vehicle
one optically grooved clear plastic right angle rear view lens, not exceeding
18 inches in diameter in the case of a circular lens or not exceeding 11 inches
by 14 inches in the case of a rectangular lens, which enables the operator of
the motor vehicle to view below the line of sight as viewed through the rear
window.
b. There is affixed to the rear side windows, rear window, or
windows of such motor vehicle any sticker or stickers, regardless of size.
c. There is affixed to the rear side windows, rear window, or
windows of such motor vehicle a single layer of sunshading material.
d. Rear side windows, rear window, or windows is clouded or
distorted.
19VAC30-70-290. Seat belts; definitions.
A. Definitions:
"Bus" means a motor vehicle with motive power
designed to carry more than 10 persons.
"Designated seating position" means any plain view
(looking down from the top) location intended by the manufacturer to provide
seating accommodations while the vehicle is in motion, except auxiliary seating
accommodations as temporary or folding jump seats.
"Front outboard designated seating positions" means
those designated seating positions for the driver and outside front seat
passenger (except for trucks which have the passenger seat nearest the
passenger side door separated from the door by a passageway used to access the
cargo area).
"GVWR" means Gross Vehicle Weight Rating as
specified by the manufacturer (loaded weight of a single vehicle).
"Multi-purpose passenger vehicle" means any motor
vehicle that is (i) designed to carry no more than 10 persons and (ii)
constructed either on a truck chassis or with special features for occasional
off-road use. This shall include a mini-van.
"Open-body type vehicle" means a vehicle having no
occupant compartment top or an occupant compartment top that can be installed
or removed by the user at his convenience.
"Passenger car" means a motor vehicle with motive
power except a multipurpose passenger vehicle or motorcycle designed for
carrying 10 persons or less.
"Rear outboard front facing designated seating
positions" means those designated seating positions for passengers in
outside front facing seats behind the driver and front passenger seat, except
any designated seating position adjacent to a walk-way, that is located between
the seat and the near side of the vehicle and is designated to allow access to
more rearward seating positions.
"Truck" means a motor vehicle with motive power
designed primarily for the transportation of property or special purpose
equipment.
B. Passive Restraint
System restraint system.
A. 1. Inflatable occupant restraint (commonly
known as air bags).
B. 2. Passive belt system (automatic deployment
around the occupant after the occupant enters the vehicle and closes the door).
C. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Not of an approved type; (see approved equipment section
for seat belts)
2. Installation not in compliance as follows:
a. All motor vehicle seat belt anchorages and attachment
hardware must meet the standards and specifications set forth by the Society of
Automotive Engineers, Inc., and Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 209
(49 CFR 571.209), for such anchorages and attachment hardware;
b. Any questions concerning the proper installation of seat
belt assemblies should be directed to the nearest Safety Division office.
3. Any 1963 and subsequent model vehicle, designed and
licensed primarily for private passenger use, is not equipped with adult safety
lap belts for at least two front seats or a combination of lap belts and
shoulder straps or harnesses.
4. Any passenger car manufactured on or after January 1, 1968,
is not equipped with lap/shoulder or harness seat belt assemblies located at
the front outboard designated seating positions (except in convertibles) and
lap seat belt assemblies located at all other designated seating positions.
5. Any convertible passenger car manufactured on or after
January 1, 1968, does not have a lap seat belt assembly for each designated
seating position.
6. Any passenger car manufactured on or after December 11,
1989, (except convertibles) not equipped with lap/shoulder seat belt assemblies
located at all forward facing rear outboard designated seating positions.
a. Any passenger car manufactured on or after September 1,
1991, (including convertibles) is not equipped with a lap/shoulder seatbelt
assembly located at all forward facing rear outboard designated seating
positions.
b. Any truck, multipurpose vehicle, or bus (except school
buses and motor homes) with a gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) of 10,000
pounds or less, manufactured on or after September 1, 1991, is not equipped
with a lap/shoulder seatbelt assembly at all forward facing rear outboard
designated seating positions.
c. Any of the heretofore described vehicles manufactured on or
after September 1, 1992, are not equipped with lap/shoulder seatbelt assembly
located at all forward facing rear outboard designated seating positions on a
readily removable seat.
7. Any of the following motor vehicles manufactured on or
after July 1, 1971, do not have a lap seat belt assembly for each designated
seating position:
a. Open-body type vehicles;
b. Walk-in van type trucks;
c. Trucks (GVWR in excess of 10,000 pounds);
d. Multipurpose passenger vehicles (GVWR in excess of 10,000
pounds).
8. Any buses manufactured on or after July 1, 1971, do not
have a lap seat belt assembly for the driver's seating position.
9. All other motor vehicles manufactured on or after January
1, 1976, except those for which requirements are specified in subdivisions 3
and 4 of this subsection, do not have lap/shoulder or harness seat belt
assemblies installed for each front outboard designated seating position. Those
vehicles originally equipped and sold by the manufacturer with only a lap belt
installed for each designated seating position in compliance with Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards (49 CFR Part 571) will be deemed to be in compliance
with this section.
10. Any seat belt buckle, webbing, or mounting is cut, torn,
frayed or no longer operates properly.
11. Any seat belt anchorage is loose, badly corroded, missing
or not fastened to belt.
D. Safety belts (motorized). Enter the vehicle and close the
door. Insert the key into the ignition and turn to the on position. A motor
causes the shoulder belt to slide along a track (Figure 1) starting at the
front body "A" pillar and moving rearward to its locked position at
the "B" pillar. The seat belt warning indicator lamp should
illuminate with the lap belt unbuckled. When the ignition is turned to the off
position and the door is opened, the shoulder belt moves forward to the
"A" pillar.
NOTE: Do not reject if the motor is inoperative and the
shoulder belt is permanently "locked" at pillar "B."
E. Air bag and air bag readiness light.
Inspect for and reject if:
1. Any defects in the air bag system are noted by the air bag
readiness light or otherwise indicated;
2. The air bag has been deployed and has not been replaced (and
is not deactivated because of a medical or other exemption and a notice is
posted to indicate that it has been deactivated);
3. Any part of the air bag system has been disabled or
removed from the vehicle; or
4. If the air bag indicator fails to light or stays on
continuously.
NOTE: Checking the air bag readiness light. Turn the ignition
key to the on position; the air bag readiness light will indicate normal
operation by lighting for six to eight seconds, then turning off. A system
malfunction is indicated by the flashing or continuous illumination of the
readiness light or failure of the light to turn on.
NOTE: Any vehicle not originally manufactured with an air bag
readiness light shall not be rejected for not having this item.
19VAC30-70-350. Motorcycle airbag, seat, steering, and
suspension.
Inspect for and reject if:
1. Frame is bent or damaged so as to constitute a hazard in
proper operation.
2. Wheels are out of line to a degree steering and control is
affected.
3. Steering-head bearing is loose, broken, defective or out of
adjustment.
4. Handlebars are loose, bent, broken or damaged in such a
manner as to affect proper steering.
5. Shock absorbers are broken, worn, missing, defective,
disconnected or do not function properly.
6. Any spring in the suspension system is broken or sagging.
NOTE: If a motorcycle or autocycle is equipped or designed
with steering or suspension components similar in design to a passenger
vehicle, the steering or suspension will be inspected as if the motorcycle or
autocycle were a passenger vehicle.
7. If motorcycle seat or seats are not securely fastened.
8. Any motorcycle designed to carry more than one person is
not equipped with a footrest for each passenger.
9. The battery is not attached to a fixed part of the
motorcycle and protected by a removable cover or enclosure if the battery is
installed in a location other than the engine compartment. This includes all
brackets, hardware, bolts, and bushings used for securely mounting the battery
to the motorcycle.
a. Removable covers or enclosures shall be substantial and
shall be securely latched or fastened.
b. The battery compartment shall have openings to provide
ample battery ventilation and drainage.
c. Whenever the cable to the starting motor passes through a
metal compartment, the cable shall be protected against grounding by an acid
and waterproof insulating bushing.
d. Whenever a battery and a fuel tank are both placed under
the driver's seat, they shall be partitioned from each other and each compartment
shall be provided with an independent cover, ventilation, and drainage.
10. Air bag and air bag readiness light. Inspect for and
reject if:
a. Any defects in the air bag system are noted by the air bag
readiness light or otherwise indicated;
b. The air bag has been deployed and has not been replaced
(and is not deactivated because of a medical or other exemption and a notice is
posted to indicate that it has been deactivated);
c. Any part of the air bag system has been disabled or
removed from the motorcycle; or
d. If the air bag indicator fails to light or stays on
continuously.
NOTE: Checking the air bag readiness light. Turn the ignition
key to the on position; the air bag readiness light will indicate normal
operation by lighting for six to eight seconds, then turning off.
A system malfunction is indicated by the flashing or
continuous illumination of the readiness light or failure of the light to turn
on.
NOTE: Any motorcycle not originally manufactured with an air
bag readiness light shall not be rejected for not having this item.
19VAC30-70-360. Motorcycle lights: auxiliary, headlamp,
rear, signal, warning.
A. Headlamps. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Motorcycle is not equipped with at least one motorcycle
headlamp.
2. Any motorcycle headlamp is not of an approved type (SAE-M).
A motorcycle may have one or more headlamps. In addition to the headlamp(s)
headlamp or headlamps, a motorcycle may be equipped with not more than
two auxiliary headlamps of a type approved (SAE-C) by the superintendent and
identified as "auxiliary front lamps."
3. Lens and reflector do not match except in sealed units, or
if the lens is cracked, broken or rotated, or if the lens and reflector are not
clean or bright.
4. Any motorcycle lights-headlamp, rear lamp, signal or
warning lamp has any wire, unapproved lens or plastic covers, any other
materials that are not original equipment or any colored material placed on or
in front of lamp or lens.
5. Lamp is not focused or any filament or bulb fails to burn.
6. Lamp is not mounted securely or if switch does not operate
properly.
7. The center of the hot spot is set more than four inches up
or down from the horizontal centerline or more than four inches to the left or
right from the vertical centerline. The headlamp shall be checked for proper
aim by using an optical headlamp aimer.
8. The high beam indicator does not burn when the high beam is
on or does not go off when the low beam is on.
NOTE: Motorcycles may be equipped with means of modulating the
high beam of their headlights between high and low beam at a rate of 200 to 280
flashes per minute, provided they are equipped with a switch or device that
prevents flashing of headlights when headlights are required to be lighted.
NOTE: Inspection is to be performed with lamp on high beam.
NOTE: The use of strobe lights being placed inside the
headlamps of police motorcycles is permitted. The strobe light system developed
by Harley-Davidson for use in police motorcycle headlamps has been tested and
does meet the current standard; therefore, strobe light systems of this type
and similar types may be used in police motorcycle headlamp systems.
B. Aiming the headlamp. All headlamps that do not comply with
subdivision A 7 of this section shall be aimed straight ahead. (Zero inches up
or down and zero inches to the right or left.)
C. Rear lamp. Inspect for and reject if:
1. The motorcycle is not equipped with a rear lamp of approved
type (SAE-T-S-P-A).
2. The lamp is not mounted near rear of vehicle, or is not
mounted securely, or if lamp does not make a good electrical connection.
3. Lenses are not red to the rear and clear or amber to the
front or any lens has a piece broken from it. The lens may have one or more
cracks provided an off-color light does not project through the cracks.
NOTE: LED (light-emitting diode) lights with a clear lens are
acceptable if of an approved type. For those vehicles that are equipped with a
multiple LED light (not filament-burning bulbs), they will pass inspection if
more than 50% of the diode lights are burning.
4. Filaments in all lamps do not burn when headlamp switch is
turned on to any position.
5. The rear license plate is not illuminated by an approved
license plate bulb.
D. Signal device (intention to stop or turn).
1. Signal devices are not required on motorcycles; however, if
installed, they must operate and be inspected.
2. Signal lamp lenses installed on the front of the motorcycle
shall be amber and be located on each side of the vertical centerline of the
motorcycle and as far apart as practicable and not closer than nine inches,
measured from the optical centerline of the lamps, and to be located on the
same level and not less than 20 inches above the ground level. The optical
centerline of the lamp shall not be less than four inches from the retaining
ring of the headlamp unit.
3. Signal lamps installed on the rear of the motorcycle shall
be red or amber and shall be located on each side of the vertical centerline of
the motorcycle as far apart as practicable but not closer than nine inches,
measured from the optical centerline of the lens, and shall be located on the
same level and not less than 20 inches above the ground level.
4. Inspect for and reject if:
a. Motorcycle, except an antique vehicle not originally
equipped with a stop lamp, is not equipped with at least one stop lamp of an
approved type that automatically exhibits a red or amber light to the rear when
the brake control foot pedal or hand grip brake control device is activated.
(On motorcycles manufactured prior to January 1, 1972, the activation of the
front wheel brake control device is not required to activate the stop lamp.)
NOTE: Motorcycles may be equipped with a means of varying the
brightness of the vehicle's brake light upon application of the vehicle's
brakes.
b. The signal lamp is not of an approved type (SAE-D) or does
not flash.
c. Lens in brake lamp or signal lamp has a piece broken from
it. (Lens in brake lamp or signal lamp may have one or more cracks provided an
off-color light does not project through the crack or cracks.)
d. Wiring or electrical connections are defective or any
filaments do not burn.
e. Switch is not convenient to the driver and not of an
approved type.
f. Signal devices are not installed as provided in
subdivisions D 1, 2, and 2 3 of this section.
E. Warning lights. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Warning lamps are not of an approved type or have been
altered.
2. Any lighted advertising sign is present.
F. Auxiliary lights. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Motorcycle or autocycles are equipped with any color
other than red or amber standard bulb running lights or light-emitting diode
(LED) pods or strips.
2. Auxiliary lights are not directed toward the ground.
3. Auxiliary lights are not designed for vehicular use.
4. Auxiliary lights project a beam of light greater than 25
candlepower per bulb.
5. Auxiliary lights display a blinking, flashing,
oscillating, or rotating pattern.
6. Auxiliary lights are attached to the wheels.
NOTE: Such lighting is not subject to approval by the
Superintendent of the State Police.
19VAC30-70-580. Glass and glazing.
A. Motor vehicles may be inspected without windshields, side
glasses, or any kind of glazing except that any motor vehicle other than a
motorcycle which that was manufactured, assembled, or
reconstructed after July 1, 1970, must be equipped with a windshield. If glass
or other glazing is installed, it must be inspected. If no windshield is
installed, see 19VAC30-70-50, C, for location of the sticker.
B. Inspect for and reject if:
1. Any motor vehicle manufactured or assembled after January
1, 1936, or any bus or school bus manufactured or assembled after January 1,
1935, is not equipped throughout with safety glass, or other safety glazing
material. (This requirement includes slide-in campers used on pickups or
trucks, caps, or covers used on pickup trucks, motor homes, and vans.)
2. Any safety glass or glazing used in a motor vehicle is not
of an approved type and properly identified (DOT and AS-1, AS-2, or AS-3)
(refer to approved equipment section). (Replacement safety glass
installed in any part of a vehicle other than the windshield need not bear a
trademark or name, provided the glass consists of two or more sheets of glass
separated by a glazing material, and provided the glass is cut from a piece of
approved safety glass, and provided the edge of the glass can be observed.)
3. Any glass at any location where glass is used is cracked or
broken so that it is likely to cut or injure a person in the vehicle.
4. Windshield has any cloudiness more than three inches above
the bottom, one inch inward from the outer borders, one inch down from the top,
or one inch inward from the center strip. The bottom of the windshield shall be
defined as the point where the top of the dash contacts the windshield.
5. Any distortion or obstruction that interferes with a driver's
vision. Any; any alteration has been made to a vehicle that
obstructs the driver's clear view through the windshield. This may include but
is not limited to large objects hanging from the inside mirror or
mounted to the windshield, cell phone mounts, GPS devices, CB radios
or tachometers mounted on the dash or windshield, hood scoops,
and other ornamentation on or in front of the hood that is not transparent.
a. Any hood scoop installed on any motor vehicle manufactured
for the year 1990 or earlier model year cannot exceed 2-1/4 inches high
at its highest point measured from the junction of the dashboard and the
windshield.
b. Any hood scoop installed on any motor vehicle manufactured
for the year 1991 or subsequent model year cannot exceed 1-1/8 inches high at
its highest point measured from the junction of the dashboard and the
windshield.
NOTE: Antennas, transponders, and similar devices must not be
mounted more than 152 mm (six inches) below the upper edge of the windshield.
These devices must be located outside the area swept by the windshield wipers,
and outside the driver's sight lines to the road and highway signs and signals.
6. Windshield glass, on the driver's side, has any scratch
more than 1/4 inch in width and six inches long within the area covered by the
windshield wiper blade, excluding the three inches above the bottom of the
windshield. A windshield wiper that remains parked within the driver's side
windshield wiper area shall be rejected.
EXCEPTION: Do not reject safety grooves designed to clean
wiper blades if the grooves do not extend upward from the bottom of the
windshield more than six inches at the highest point.
7. There is a pit, chip, or star crack larger than 3/4 inch in
diameter at any location in the windshield above the topmost portion of the
steering wheel except the two-inch border at each side.
8. At any location above the topmost portion of the steering
wheel excluding a two-inch border at the top and one-inch border at the sides
there is:
a. Any crack over 1/4 inch in width.
b. Any crack 1/4 inch or less in width intersected by another
crack.
c. Any damage area 3/4 inch or less in diameter if within
three inches of any other damage area.
9. Any sticker is on the windshield other than an official one
required by law, or permitted by the superintendent. Authorization is hereby
granted for stickers or decals, to include those required by any county,
town, or city, measuring not more than 2-1/2 inches in width and four
inches in length to be placed in the blind spot behind the rearview rear
view mirror. Department of Defense decals measuring no more than three
inches in width and eight inches in length may be affixed to the upper edge of
the center of the windshield. At the option of the motor vehicle's owner, the
decal may be affixed at the lower left corner of the windshield so that the
inside or left edge of the sticker or decal is within one inch of the extreme
left edge of the windshield when looking through the windshield from inside the
vehicle. When placed at this location, the bottom edge of the sticker or decal
must be affixed within three inches of the bottom of the windshield. This
location can only be used if the owner of the vehicle has chosen not to place
any required county, town or city decal there. The normal location for any
required county, town, or city sticker or decal is adjacent to the right
side of official inspection sticker and must not extend upward more than
three inches from the bottom of the windshield when viewed from inside
the vehicle. The top edge of the sticker is to be approximately four inches
from the bottom of the windshield. The left side edge adjacent to the official
inspection sticker shall not be more than 1/4-inch from the right edge of the
official inspection sticker when viewed from inside the vehicle. Valid
Commercial Vehicle Safety Alliance (CVSA) inspection decals, or similar
commercial vehicle inspection decal issued by local law enforcement, may be
placed at the bottom or sides right corner of the windshield provided
when viewed from inside the vehicle. The top edge of such decals do
not extend more that 4-1/2 are to be approximately four inches from
the bottom of the windshield when viewed from inside the vehicle and are
to be located outside the area swept by the windshield wipers and
outside of the driver's sight line.
Fastoll transponder devices may be affixed to the inside
center of the windshield at the roof line just above the rear view mirror. If
space does not allow, then it may be affixed to the immediate right of the mirror
at the roof line.
Any sticker or decal required by the laws of any other
state or the District of Columbia and displayed upon the windshield of a
vehicle submitted for inspection in this state is permitted by the
superintendent, provided the vehicle is currently registered in that
jurisdiction, and the sticker is displayed in a manner designated
by the issuing authority and has not expired. This includes vehicles with dual
registration, i.e., Virginia and the District of Columbia.
NOTE: Stickers or decals used by counties, cities and towns
in lieu of license plates may be placed on the windshield without further
authority. Except on privately owned yellow school buses, the sticker or decal
shall be placed on the windshield adjacent to the right side of the official
inspection sticker or the optional placement to the extreme lower left side of
the windshield. The top edge of the sticker or decal shall not extend upwards
more than three inches from the bottom of the windshield. The left side edge
adjacent to the official inspection sticker shall not be more than 1/4 inch
from the right edge of the official inspection sticker when looking through the
windshield from inside the vehicle. However, at the option of the motor vehicle
owner, the sticker or decal may be affixed to the upper edge of the center of
the windshield. (Any expired sticker or decal, excluding a rejection sticker,
that is present on the windshield at the time of inspection shall not be issued
an approval sticker unless the owner/operator "authorizes" its
removal. A rejection sticker will be issued versus an involuntary removal.) On
privately owned yellow school buses, the sticker or decal shall be placed on
the windshield adjacent to the left side of the official inspection sticker, and
not more than 1/4 inch from the official inspection sticker when looking
through the windshield from inside the vehicle. The top edge of the sticker
shall not extend upward more than three inches from the bottom of the
windshield. Any Virginia registered vehicle displaying a valid sticker
or decal required by a county, town, or city is permitted by the superintendent
to remain in its current location through December 31, 2018, unless such
location conflicts with the inspection sticker placement. This will afford
localities time to enact changes to regulations governing required stickers or
decals, which may be impacted by the 2018 inspection sticker placement change.
NOTE: Toll transponder devices may be affixed to the inside
center of the windshield at the roof line just above the rear view mirror. If
space does not allow, then it may be affixed to the immediate right of the
mirror at the roof line.
NOTE: A licensed motor vehicle dealer may apply one
transponder sticker no larger than one inch by four inches and one barcode
sticker no larger than three inches by four inches to the driver's side edge of
a vehicle's windshield to be removed upon the sale or lease of the vehicle
provided that it does not extend below the AS-1 line. In the absence of an AS-1
line, the sticker cannot extend more than three inches downward from the top of
the windshield.
NOTE: Any vehicle displaying an expired sticker or decal on
its windshield at the time of inspection, excluding a rejection sticker, shall
not be issued an approval sticker unless the owner or operator authorizes its
removal. A rejection sticker will be issued versus an involuntary removal.
10. Sunshading material attached to the windshield extends
more than three inches downward from the top of the windshield, unless authorized
by the Virginia Department of Motor Vehicles and indicated on the vehicle
registration.
NOTE: Sunshading material on the windshield displaying words,
lettering, numbers or pictures that do not extend below the AS-1 line are
permitted.
NOTE: Vehicles with logos made into the glass at the factory
that meet federal standards will pass state inspection.
11. Any sunscreening material is scratched, distorted,
wrinkled or obscures or distorts clear vision through the glazing.
12. Front side windows have cloudiness above three inches from
the bottom of the glass, or other defects that affect the driver's vision or
one or more cracks which permit one part of the glass to be moved in relation
to another part. Wind silencers, breezes or other ventilator adaptors are not
made of clear transparent material.
13. Glass in the left front door cannot be lowered so a hand
signal can be given. (This does not apply to vehicle equipped with approved
turn signals which were not designed and/or or manufactured for
left front glass to be lowered.) If either front door has the glass removed and
material inserted in place of the glass which could obstruct the driver's
vision.
Exception: Sunscreening material is permissible if the vehicle
is equipped with a mirror on each side.
14. Any sticker or other obstruction is on either front side
window, rear side windows, or rear windows. (The price label, fuel economy
label and the buyer's guide required by federal statute and regulations to be
affixed to new/used new or used vehicles by the manufacturer
shall normally be affixed to one of the rear side windows.) If a vehicle only
has two door windows, the labels may be affixed to one of these windows. If a
vehicle does not have any door or side windows, the labels may be
temporarily affixed to the right side of the windshield until the vehicle is
sold to the first purchaser.
NOTE: A single sticker no larger than 20 square inches in
area, if such sticker is totally contained within the lower five inches of the
glass in the rear window or a single sticker or decal no larger than 10 square
inches located in an area not more than three inches above the bottom and not
more than eight inches from the rearmost edge of either front side window, is
permissible and should not be rejected.
Do not reject a tractor truck having a gross vehicle weight
rating of 26,001 pounds or more equipped with one optically grooved clear
plastic wide angle lens affixed to the right front side window. Such wide angle
lens shall not extend upward from the bottom of the window opening more than
six inches or backward from the front of the window opening more than eight
inches.
15. Rear window is clouded or distorted so that the driver
does not have a view 200 feet to the rear.
EXCEPTIONS: The following are permissible if the vehicle is
equipped with a mirror on each side:
a. There is attached to one rear window of such motor vehicle
one optically grooved clear plastic right angle rear view lens, not exceeding
18 inches in diameter in the case of a circular lens or not exceeding 11 inches
by 14 inches in the case of a rectangular lens, which enables the operator of
the motor vehicle to view below the line of sight as viewed through the rear
window.
b. There is affixed to the rear side windows, rear window or
windows of such motor vehicle any sticker or stickers, regardless of size.
c. There is affixed to the rear side windows, rear window or
windows of such motor vehicle a single layer of sunshading material.
d. Rear side windows, rear window or windows is clouded or distorted.
19VAC30-70-660. Seat belts.
A. Definitions:
"Bus" means a motor vehicle with motive power
designed to carry more than 10 persons.
"Designated seating position" means any plain view
(looking down from the top) location intended by the manufacturer to provide
seating accommodations while the vehicle is in motion, except auxiliary seating
accommodations as temporary or folding jump seats.
"Front outboard designated seating positions" means
those designated seating positions for the driver and outside front seat
passenger (except for trucks which have the passenger seat nearest the
passenger side door separated from the door by a passageway used to access the
cargo area.)
"GVWR" means gross vehicle weight rating as
specified by the manufacturer (loaded weight of a single vehicle.)
"Multipurpose passenger vehicle" means any motor
vehicle that is (i) designed to carry no more than 10 persons and (ii)
constructed either on a truck chassis or with special features for occasional
off-road use. This shall include a minivan.
"Open-body type vehicle" means a vehicle having no
occupant compartment top or an occupant compartment top that can be installed
or removed by the user at his convenience.
"Rear outboard front facing designated seating
positions" means those designated seating positions for passengers in
outside front facing seats behind the driver and front passenger seat, except
any designated seating position adjacent to a walkway, that is located between
the seat and the nearside of the vehicle and is designated to allow access to
more rearward seating positions.
"Truck" means a motor vehicle with motive power
designed primarily for the transportation of property or special purpose
equipment.
B. Passive Restraint System:
Inflatable occupant restraint (commonly known as air bags).
Passive belt system (automatic deployment around the occupant
after the occupant enters the vehicle and closes the door).
Inspect for and reject if:
1. Not of an approved type.
2. Installation not in compliance as follows:
a. All motor vehicle seat belt anchorages and attachment
hardware must meet the standards and specifications set forth by the Society of
Automotive Engineers, Inc., and Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Number
209, for such anchorages and attachment hardware.
b. Any questions concerning the proper installation of seat
belt assemblies should be directed to the nearest Safety Division office.
3. Any of the following motor vehicles manufactured on or
after July 1, 1971, not having a lap seat belt assembly for each designated
seating position:
a. Open-body type vehicles;
b. Walk-in van type trucks;
c. Trucks (GVWR in excess of 10,000 pounds);
d. Multipurpose passenger vehicles (GVWR in excess of 10,000
pounds).
4. Any buses manufactured on or after July 1, 1971, not having
a lap seat belt assembly for the driver's seating position.
5. All other motor vehicles manufactured on or after January
1, 1976, except those for which requirements are specified in subdivisions 3
and 4 of this subsection, not having lap/shoulder or harness seat belt
assemblies installed for each front outboard designated seating position.
Those vehicles originally equipped and sold by the
manufacturer with only a lap belt installed for each designated seating
position, in compliance with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards, will be
deemed to be in compliance with this section.
6. Any seat belt buckle, webbing, or mounting is cut, torn,
frayed, or no longer operates properly.
7. Any seat belt anchorage is loose, badly corroded, missing
or not fastened to belt.
8. Any truck, multi-purpose vehicle, or bus (except school
buses and motor homes) with a GVWR of 10,000 pounds or less, manufactured on or
after September 1, 1991, is not equipped with a lap/shoulder seatbelt assembly
at all forward facing rear outboard designated seating positions.
9. Any of the heretofore described vehicles manufactured on or
after September 1, 1992, are not equipped with lap/shoulder seatbelt assembly
located at all forward facing rear outboard designated seating positions on a
readily removable seat.
C. Air bag and air bag readiness light. Inspect for and
reject if:
1. Air bag. Any defects in the air bag system are noted by the
air bag readiness light or otherwise indicated;
2. The air bag has been deployed and has not been replaced
(and is not deactivated because of a medical or other exemption and a notice is
posted to indicate that it has been deactivated);
3. Any part of the air bag system has been disabled or
removed from the vehicle; or
4. If the air bag indicator fails to light or stays on
continuously.
NOTE: Air bag readiness light. Turn the ignition key to the on
position; the air bag readiness light will indicate normal operation by
lighting for six to eight seconds, then turning off. A system malfunction is
indicated by the flashing or continuous illumination of the readiness light or
failure of the light to turn on.
NOTE: Any vehicle not originally manufactured with an air bag
readiness light shall not be rejected for not having this item.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5604; Filed August 3, 2018, 3:37 p.m.
TITLE 20. PUBLIC UTILITIES AND TELECOMMUNICATIONS
STATE CORPORATION COMMISSION
Proposed Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
State Corporation Commission is claiming an exemption from the Administrative
Process Act in accordance with § 2.2-4002 A 2 of the Code of Virginia,
which exempts courts, any agency of the Supreme Court, and any agency that by
the Constitution is expressly granted any of the powers of a court of record.
Title of Regulation: 20VAC5-316. Regulations
Governing Exemptions for Large General Services Customers under § 56-585.1
A 5 c of the Code of Virginia (repealing 20VAC5-316-10 through
20VAC5-316-50).
Statutory Authority: §§ 12.1-13 and 56-585.1 of the
Code of Virginia.
Public Hearing Information: A public hearing will be
held upon request.
Public Comment Deadline: September 17, 2018.
Agency Contact: Andrea B. Macgill, Associate General
Counsel, Office of General Counsel, State Corporation Commission, P.O. Box
1197, Richmond, VA 23218, telephone (804) 371-9064, FAX (804) 371-9240, or
email andrea.macgill@scc.virginia.gov.
Summary:
Chapter 296 of the 2018 Acts of Assembly repeals the
provisions (i) requiring a large general service customer with a verifiable
history of using more than 500 kilowatts, that does not wish to participate in
an electric utility's energy efficiency program, to demonstrate that it has
implemented an energy efficiency program, at the customer's expense, that has
produced or will produce measured and verified results and (ii) requiring the
State Corporation Commission to promulgate regulations regarding the process
under which such large general service customers file notice of such exemption.
Therefore, the Large General Service Customer Rules (20VAC5-316, Regulations
Governing Exemptions for Large General Services Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5
C of the Code of Virginia) are repealed.
AT RICHMOND, AUGUST 13, 2018
COMMONWEALTH OF VIRGINIA, ex rel.
STATE CORPORATION COMMISSION
CASE NO. PUR-2018-00126
Ex Parte: In the matter of repealing Regulations
Governing Exemptions for Large General Service
Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code of Virginia
ORDER FOR NOTICE AND COMMENT
The Regulations Governing Exemptions for Large General
Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code of Virginia, 20 VAC
5-316-10 et seq. ("LGS Customer Exemption Rules"), adopted by the
State Corporation Commission ("Commission") pursuant to § 56-585.1 of
the Virginia Electric Utility Regulation Act, Chapter 23 (§ 56-576 et
seq.) of Title 56 of the Code of Virginia ("Code"), apply to the
large general service customers of Virginia's electric utilities subject to the
provisions of § 56-585.1 A 5 c that have verifiable histories of using
more than 500 kilowatts ("kW") but no more than 10 megawatts of demand
from a single metering point. The LGS Customer Exemption Rules establish
requirements for such large general service customers to request exemption from
any rate adjustment clause approved by the Commission pursuant to
§ 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code, if the customer can demonstrate that it has
implemented an energy efficiency program, at the customer's expense, that has
produced or will produce measured and verified results.1
Effective July 1, 2018, Chapter 296 of the 2018 Acts of
Assembly ("Chapter 296") amended § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code to
state, in part:
None of the costs of new energy efficiency programs of an
electric utility, including recovery of revenue reductions, shall be assigned
to any large general service customer. A large general service customer is a
customer that has a verifiable history of having used more than 500 kilowatts
of demand from a single meter of delivery.
Chapter 296 eliminated from Code § 56-585.1 A 5 c the
language requiring a large general service customer with a verifiable history
of using more than 500 kW, who does not wish to participate in an electric
utility's energy efficiency program or programs, to demonstrate that it has
implemented an energy efficiency program, at the customer's expense, that has
produced or will produce measured and verified results. Chapter 296 also
eliminated the language in § 56-585.1 A 5 c that required the
Commission to "promulgate rules and regulations to accommodate the process
under which such large general service customers shall file notice of such
exemption. . . ." Accordingly, there appears to be no need to retain the
LGS Customer Exemption Rules.
NOW THE COMMISSION, having considered the amendments to §
56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code by Chapter 296, finds that interested parties should
be permitted to comment on the need to retain any portion of the Regulations
Governing Exemptions for Large General Service Customers under § 56-585.1
A 5 c of the Code of Virginia, 20 VAC 5-316-10, et seq.
Accordingly, IT IS ORDERED THAT:
(1) This case is docketed and assigned Case No.
PUR-2018-00126.
(2) The Commission's Division of Information Resources shall
forward the proposed repeal of the Regulations Governing Exemptions for Large
General Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code of Virginia,
Appendix A hereto, to the Registrar of Virginia for publication in the Virginia
Register of Regulations.
(3) The Commission's Division of Information Resources shall
make a downloadable version of the proposed repeal of the Regulations Governing
Exemptions for Large General Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of
the Code of Virginia, Appendix A, available for access by the public at the
Commission's website, http://www.scc.virginia/gov/case. The Clerk of the
Commission shall make a copy of the proposed repeal of Regulations Governing
Exemptions for Large General Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of
the Code available for public inspection and provide a copy, free of charge, in
response to any written request for one.
(4) On or before September 17, 2018, any interested person
may comment on, propose modifications or supplements to, or request a hearing
on the proposed repeal of Regulations Governing Exemptions for Large General
Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code by filing an original
and fifteen (15) copies of such comments or requests with
Joel H. Peck, Clerk, State Corporation Commission, c/o Document
Control Center, P.O. Box 2118, Richmond, Virginia 23218. Interested persons
desiring to submit comments or hearing requests electronically may do so by
following the instructions available at the Commission's website:
http://www.scc.virginia/gov/case. Individuals shall be specific in their
comments to the proposed repeal of Regulations Governing Exemptions for Large
General Service Customers under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code of Virginia
and shall address only those issues pertaining to the amendment of § 56-585.1 A
5 c of the Code pursuant to Chapter 296. Issues outside the scope of
implementing this amendment will not be open for consideration. Any request for
hearing shall state with specificity why the issues raised in the request for
hearing cannot be adequately addressed in written comments. Interested parties
shall refer in their comments or requests to Case No. PUR-2018-00126.
(5) If no written request for a hearing on the proposal to
repeal the Regulations Governing Exemptions for Large General Service Customers
under § 56-585.1 A 5 c of the Code of Virginia, as outlined in this Order,
is received on or before September 17, 2018, the Commission may, upon
consideration of any comments submitted in support of or in opposition to the
proposal, enter an order based upon the papers filed herein.
(6) This matter is continued.
AN ATTESTED COPY hereof shall be sent by the Clerk of the
Commission to all persons on Attachment A hereto and C. Meade Browder, Jr.,
Senior Assistant Attorney General, Office of the Attorney General, Division of
Consumer Counsel, 202 N. 9th Street, 8th Floor, Richmond, Virginia 23219-3424.
A copy hereof shall be delivered to the Commission's Office of General Counsel
and the Divisions of Public Utility Regulation and Utility Accounting and
Finance.
________________
1See 20 VAC 5-316-10.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5630; Filed August 13, 2018, 1:36 p.m.
TITLE 22. SOCIAL SERVICES
DEPARTMENT FOR AGING AND REHABILITATIVE SERVICES
Final Regulation
REGISTRAR'S NOTICE: The
following regulatory action is exempt from Article 2 of the Administrative
Process Act in accordance with § 2.2-4006 A 4 c of the Code of Virginia,
which excludes regulations that are necessary to meet the requirements of
federal law or regulations provided such regulations do not differ materially
from those required by federal law or regulation. The Department for Aging and
Rehabilitative Services will receive, consider, and respond to petitions by any
interested person at any time with respect to reconsideration or revision.
Title of
Regulation: 22VAC30-20. Provision of Vocational Rehabilitation Services (amending 22VAC30-20-10, 22VAC30-20-20,
22VAC30-20-30, 22VAC30-20-40, 22VAC30-20-70, 22VAC30-20-80, 22VAC30-20-95,
22VAC30-20-100, 22VAC30-20-110, 22VAC30-20-120, 22VAC30-20-130, 22VAC30-20-150,
22VAC30-20-170, 22VAC30-20-181, 22VAC30-20-190, 22VAC30-20-200; adding
22VAC30-20-195, 22VAC30-20-210; repealing 22VAC30-20-60).
Statutory Authority: § 51.5-131 of the Code of Virginia.
Effective Date: October 3, 2018.
Agency Contact: Leah Mills, Policy Analyst, Department
for Aging and Rehabilitative Services, 8004 Franklin Farms Drive, Richmond, VA
23229, telephone (804) 662-7610, FAX (804) 662-7663, TTY (800) 464-9950, or
email leah.mills@dars.virginia.gov.
Summary:
The amendments (i) provide for reemployment transition
services for students with disabilities; (ii) require that an individual obtain
competitive integrated employment before his vocational rehabilitation case can
be closed as successfully employed; (iii) disallow the case of a vocational
rehabilitation recipient to be closed as successful if the recipient is earning
less than the prevailing wage for the individual's employment; and (iv) require
that individuals with disabilities receive vocational counseling before they
can be employed in positions earning less than minimum wage. The amendments
bring the existing regulation into conformity with the federal regulations for
the Workforce Innovation and Opportunity Act (WIOA).
22VAC30-20-10. Definitions.
The following words and terms when used in this chapter shall
have the following meanings, unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.
"Act" means the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (29 USC
§ 701 et seq.), as amended.
"Applicant" means an individual who submits an
application for vocational rehabilitation services.
"Appropriate modes of communication" means
specialized aids and supports that enable an individual with a disability to
comprehend and respond to information that is being communicated. Appropriate
modes of communication include, but are not limited to, the use of
interpreters, open and closed captioned videos, specialized telecommunications
services and audio recordings, Brailled and large-print materials, materials in
electronic formats, augmentative communication devices, graphic presentations,
and simple language materials.
"Assessment for determining eligibility and
vocational rehabilitation needs" means, as appropriate in each case, a
review of existing data as described in 22VAC30-20-30 to determine if an
individual meets the eligibility requirements for vocational rehabilitation
services as described in 22VAC30-20-40, and to assign priority for an order of
selection described in 22VAC30-20-90.
"Assistive technology" means any item, piece of
equipment, or product system, whether acquired commercially off the shelf,
modified, or customized, that is used to increase, maintain, or improve the
functional capabilities of an individual with a disability.
"Assistive technology service" means any service
that directly assists an individual with a disability in the selection,
acquisition, or use of an assistive technology device, including:
1. The evaluation of the needs of an individual with a
disability, including a functional evaluation of the individual in his
customary environment;
2. Purchasing, leasing, or otherwise providing for the
acquisition by an individual with a disability of an assistive technology
device;
3. Selecting, designing, fitting, customizing, adapting,
applying, maintaining, repairing, or replacing assistive technology devices;
4. Coordinating and using other therapies, interventions, or
services with assistive technology devices, such as those associated with
existing education and rehabilitation plans and programs;
5. Training or technical assistance for an individual with a
disability or, if appropriate, the family members, guardians, advocates, or
authorized representatives of the individual; and
6. Training or technical assistance for professionals
(including individuals providing education and rehabilitation services),
employers, or others who provide services to, employ, or are otherwise
substantially involved in the major life functions of individuals with
disabilities, to the extent that training or technical assistance is necessary
to the achievement of an employment outcome by an individual with a disability.
"Audiological examination" means the testing of the
sense of hearing.
"Clear and convincing evidence" means that the
designated state unit shall have a high degree of certainty before it can
conclude that an individual is incapable of benefiting from services in terms
of an employment outcome. The clear and convincing standard constitutes the
highest standard used in our civil system of law and is to be individually
applied on a case-by-case basis. The term "clear" means unequivocal.
Given these requirements, a review of existing information generally would not
provide clear and convincing evidence. For example, the use of an intelligence
test result alone would not constitute clear and convincing evidence. Clear and
convincing evidence might include a description of assessments, including
situational assessments and supported employment assessments, from service
providers who have concluded that they would be unable to meet the individual's
needs due to the severity of the individual's disability. The demonstration of
clear and convincing evidence must include, if appropriate, a functional
assessment of skill development activities, with any necessary supports
(including assistive technology), in real life settings. (S. Rep. No. 357, 102d
Cong., 2d. Sess. 37-38 (1992))
"Client Assistance Program" means the program
located within the disAbility Law Center of Virginia for the purpose of
advising applicants or eligible individuals about all available services under
the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (29 USC § 701 et seq.), as amended,
and to assist applicants and eligible individuals in their relationship with
programs, projects, and facilities providing vocational rehabilitation
services.
"Commissioner" means the Commissioner of the
Department for Aging and Rehabilitative Services.
"Community rehabilitation program" means a program
that directly provides or facilitates the provision of one or more of the
following vocational rehabilitation services to individuals with disabilities
to enable those individuals to maximize their opportunities for employment,
including career advancement:
1. Medical, psychiatric, psychological, social, and vocational
services that are provided under one management;
2. Testing, fitting, or training in the use of prosthetic and
orthotic devices;
3. Recreational therapy;
4. Physical and occupational therapy;
5. Speech, language, and hearing therapy;
6. Psychiatric, psychological, and social services, including
positive behavior management;
7. Assessment for determining eligibility and vocational
rehabilitation needs;
8. Rehabilitation technology;
9. Job development, placement, and retention services;
10. Evaluation or control of specific disabilities;
11. Orientation and mobility services for individuals who are
blind;
12. Extended employment;
13. Psychosocial rehabilitation services;
14. Supported employment services and extended services;
15. Customized employment;
16. Services to family members, if necessary, to enable
the applicant or eligible individual to achieve an employment outcome;
16. 17. Personal assistance services; or
17. 18. Services similar to the services
described in subdivisions 1 through 16 17 of this definition.
For the purposes of this definition, the word
"program" means an agency, organization, or institution, or unit of
an agency, organization, or institution, that directly provides or
facilitates the provision of vocational rehabilitation services as one of its
major functions.
"Comparable services and benefits" means services
and benefits, including accommodations and auxiliary aids and services,
that are provided or paid for, in whole or in part, by other federal, state, or
local public agencies, by health insurance, or by employee benefits; available
to the individual at the time needed to ensure the individual's progress toward
achieving the employment outcome in the individual's individualized plan for
employment; and commensurate to the services that the individual would
otherwise receive from the vocational rehabilitation agency. For the purposes
of this definition, comparable benefits do not include awards and scholarships
based on merit.
"Competitive integrated employment" means
work in the competitive labor market that (i) is performed on a
full-time or part-time basis in an integrated setting, (including
self-employment) and for which an individual is compensated at or above the
minimum wage, rate required under state or local minimum wage law for
the place of employment but not less than the customary wage and level of
benefits paid by the employer for the same or similar work performed by
individuals who are not disabled without disabilities in comparable
positions who have similar training, experience, and skills; (ii) in the case
of an individual who is self-employed, yields an income that is comparable to
the income received by other individuals who are not individuals with
disabilities and who are self-employed in similar occupations or similar tasks
and who have similar training, experience, and skills; (iii) is typically found
in the community where the employee with a disability interacts for the purpose
of performing the duties of the position with other individuals without
disabilities to the same extent that employees who do not have disabilities
interact in comparable positions; and (iv) presents, as appropriate,
opportunities for advancement that are similar to those for other individuals
who are not individuals with disabilities and who have similar positions.
"Customized employment" means competitive
integrated employment based on the unique strengths, needs, and interests of an
individual with a significant disability, which is designed to meet the
specific abilities of the individual with a significant disability and the
business needs of the employer and is carried out through flexible strategies,
such as (i) job exploration by the individual; (ii) customizing a job
description based on current employer needs or on previously unidentified and
unmet employer needs; (iii) developing a set of job duties, a work schedule and
job arrangements, and specifics of supervision (including performance
evaluation and reviews) and determining job location; (iv) using a professional
representative chosen by the individual, or if elected self-representation, to
work with an employer to facilitate placement; and (v) providing services and
supports at the job location.
"Department" means the Department for Aging and
Rehabilitative Services. The department is considered the "designated
state agency" or "state agency," meaning the sole state agency
designated in accordance with 34 CFR 361.13(a) to administer or supervise local
administration of the state plan for vocational rehabilitation
services. The department also is considered the "designated state
unit" or "state unit," meaning the state agency, vocational rehabilitation
bureau, division, or other organizational unit that is primarily concerned with
vocational rehabilitation or vocational and other rehabilitation of individuals
with disabilities and that is responsible for the administration of the vocational
rehabilitation program of the state agency as required under 34 CFR
361.13(b), or the state agency that is primarily concerned with vocational
rehabilitation or vocational and other rehabilitation of individuals with
disabilities.
"Eligible individual" means an applicant for
vocational rehabilitation services who meets the eligibility requirements of
22VAC30-20-40.
"Employment outcome" means, with respect to an
individual, entering, advancing in, or retaining full-time or, if appropriate,
part-time competitive integrated employment in the integrated labor
market;, as defined in this section (including customized employment,
self-employment, telecommuting, or business ownership), or supported
employment or any other type of employment in an integrated setting
including self-employment, telecommuting, or business ownership as
defined in this section, that is consistent with an individual's strengths,
resources, priorities, concerns, abilities, capabilities, interests, and
informed choice. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(16)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(15))
"Evaluation of vocational rehabilitation
potential" means, as appropriate, in each case (i) a preliminary
diagnostic study to determine that an individual is eligible for vocational
rehabilitation services; (ii) a thorough diagnostic study consisting of a
comprehensive evaluation of pertinent factors bearing on the individual's
impediment to employment and vocational rehabilitation potential, in order to
determine which vocational rehabilitation services may be of benefit to the
individual in terms of employability; (iii) the provision of goods or services
necessary to determine the nature of the disability and whether it may
reasonably be expected that the individual can benefit from vocational
rehabilitation services in terms of an employment outcome; (iv) referrals to
other agencies or organizations for services, when appropriate; and (v) the
provision of vocational rehabilitation services to an individual during an
extended evaluation of rehabilitation potential for the purpose of determining
whether the individual with a disability is capable of achieving an employment
outcome.
"Extended employment" means work in a nonintegrated
or sheltered setting for a public or private nonprofit agency or organization that
provides compensation in accordance with the Fair Labor Standards Act (29 USC
§ 201 et seq.). (34 CFR 361.5(b)(20)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(18))
"Extended evaluation" means the provision of
vocational rehabilitation services necessary for a determination of vocational
rehabilitation potential.
"Extended services" as used in the definition of
"supported employment" means ongoing support services and other
appropriate services that are (i) needed to support and maintain an
individual with a most significant disability in supported employment and
that are; (ii) organized or made available, singly or in combination, in
such a way as to assist an eligible individual in maintaining supported
employment; (iii) based on the needs of an eligible individual, as specified in
an individualized plan for employment; (iv) provided by a state agency, a
private nonprofit organization, employer, or any other appropriate resource,
from funds other than funds received under 34 CFR Part 363 after an
individual with a most significant disability has made the transition from
support provided by the department.; and (v) provided to a youth with
a most significant disability by the department in accordance with requirements
set forth in 22VAC30-20-110 and 22VAC30-20-120 of this chapter and 34 CFR Part
363 for a period of time not to exceed four years, or at such time a youth
reached age 25 years and no longer meets the definition of youth with a
disability in this section, whichever occurs first.
"Extreme medical risk" means a probability of
substantially increasing functional impairment or death if medical services,
including mental health services, are not provided expeditiously.
"Family member" or "member of the family"
means an individual (i) who is either a relative or guardian of an applicant or
eligible individual, or lives in the same household as an applicant or eligible
individual; (ii) who has a substantial interest in the well-being of that
individual; and (iii) whose receipt of vocational rehabilitation services is
necessary to enable the applicant or eligible individual to achieve an
employment outcome.
"Higher education" means training or training
services provided by universities, colleges, community or junior colleges,
vocational schools, technical institutes, or hospital schools of nursing.
"IDEA" means the federal Individuals with
Disabilities Education Act (20 USC § 1400 et seq.).
"Impartial hearing officer" means an individual who
is not an employee of a public agency (other than an administrative law judge,
hearing examiner, or employee of an institution of higher education); is not a
member of the State Rehabilitation Council for the department; has not been
involved previously in the vocational rehabilitation of the applicant or eligible
individual recipient of services; has knowledge of the delivery of
vocational rehabilitation services, the vocational rehabilitation portion of
the unified or combined state plan, and the federal and state regulations
governing the provision of services; has received training with respect to the
performance of official duties; and has no personal, professional, or financial
interest that would be in conflict with the objectivity of the individual. An
individual is not considered to be an employee of a public agency for the
purposes of this definition solely because the individual is paid by the agency
to serve as a hearing officer. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(25)) (34 CFR
361.5(c)(24))
"Individual who is blind" means a person who is
blind within the meaning of applicable state law.
"Individual with a disability," except as provided
in 34 CFR 361.5(b)(29) 34 CFR 361.5(c)(28), means an individual
(i) who has a physical or mental impairment; (ii) whose impairment constitutes
or results in a substantial impediment to employment; and (iii) who can benefit
in terms of an employment outcome from the provision of vocational
rehabilitation services. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(28)) (34 CFR
361.5(c)(27))
"Individual with a most significant disability"
means an individual with a significant disability who meets the department's
criteria for an individual with a most significant disability. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(30)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(29))
"Individual with a significant disability" means an
individual with a disability (i) who has a severe physical or mental impairment
that seriously limits one or more functional capacities (such as mobility,
communication, self-care, self-direction, interpersonal skills, work tolerance,
or work skills) in terms of an employment outcome; (ii) whose vocational
rehabilitation can be expected to require multiple vocational rehabilitation
services over an extended period of time; and (iii) who has one or more
physical or mental disabilities resulting from amputation, arthritis, autism,
blindness, burn injury, cancer, cerebral palsy, cystic fibrosis, deafness, head
injury, heart disease, hemiplegia, hemophilia, respiratory or pulmonary
dysfunction, intellectual disability, mental illness, multiple sclerosis,
muscular dystrophy, musculoskeletal disorders, neurological disorders
(including stroke and epilepsy), spinal cord conditions (including paraplegia
and quadriplegia), sickle cell anemia, specific learning disability, end-stage
renal disease, or another disability or combination of disabilities determined
on the basis of an assessment for determining eligibility and vocational
rehabilitation needs to cause comparable substantial functional limitation. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(31)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(30))
"Individual's representative" means any
representative chosen by an applicant or eligible individual, as appropriate,
including a parent, guardian, other family member, or advocate, unless a
representative has been appointed by a court to represent the individual, in
which case the court-appointed representative is the individual's
representative. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(32)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(31))
"Integrated setting," with respect to the provision
of services, means a setting typically found in the community in which
applicants or eligible individuals interact with nondisabled individuals other
than nondisabled individuals who are providing services to those applicants or
eligible individuals. "Integrated setting," with respect to an
employment outcome, means a setting typically found in the community in
which applicants or eligible individuals interact with nondisabled individuals,
other than nondisabled individuals who are providing services to those
applicants or eligible individuals, to the same extent that nondisabled
individuals in comparable positions interact with other persons. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(33)) where the employee with a disability interacts, for the
purposes of performing the duties of the position, with other employees within
the particular work unit and the entire work site, and, as appropriate to the
work performed, other persons (e.g., customers and vendors) who are not
individuals with disabilities (not including supervisory personnel or
individuals who are providing services to such employee) to the same extent
that employees who are not individuals with disabilities and who are in
comparable positions interact with these persons. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(32))
"Local workforce investment development
board" means a local workforce investment board established
under § 117 of the Workforce Investment Act of 1998. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(34)) as defined in § 3 of the Workforce Innovation and
Opportunity Act (20 USC § 3101 et seq.). (34 CFR 361.5(c)(33))
"Maintenance" means monetary support provided to an
individual for expenses, such as food, shelter, and clothing, that are in
excess of the normal expenses of the individual and that are necessitated by
the individual's participation in an assessment for determining eligibility and
vocational rehabilitation needs or the individual's receipt of vocational
rehabilitation services under an individualized plan for employment. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(35)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(34))
"Mediation" means the act or process of using an
independent third party to act as a mediator, intermediary, or conciliator to
assist persons or parties in settling differences or disputes prior to pursuing
formal administrative or other legal remedies. Mediation under the program must
be conducted in accordance with the requirements in 34 CFR 361.57(d) by a
qualified impartial mediator. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(36)) (34 CFR
361.5(c)(35))
"Nonprofit," with respect to a community
rehabilitation program, means a community rehabilitation program carried out by
a corporation or association, no part of the net earnings of which inures, or
may lawfully inure, to the benefit of any private shareholder or individual and
the income of which is exempt from taxation under § 501(c)(3) of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(37)) (34 CFR
361.5(c)(36))
"One-stop center" means a center established
under the Workforce Innovation and Opportunity Act (20 USC § 3101 et seq.) and
designed to provide a full range of assistance to job seekers under one
roof. Established under the Workforce Investment Act of 1998, the. The
centers offer training, career counseling, job listings, and similar employment
related services.
"Ongoing support services," as used in the
definition of "supported employment," means services that are needed
to support and maintain an individual with a most significant disability,
including a youth with a most significant disability, in supported
employment; identified based on a determination by the department of the
individual's needs as specified in an individualized plan for employment; and
furnished by the department from the time of job placement until transition to
extended services, unless post-employment services are provided following
transition, and thereafter by one or more extended services providers
throughout the individual's term of employment in a particular job placement or
multiple placements if those placements are being provided under a
program of transitional employment. These services shall include an
assessment of employment stability and provision of specific services or the
coordination of services at or away from the worksite that are needed to
maintain stability based on, at a minimum, twice-monthly monitoring at the
worksite of each individual in supported employment;, or if under
specific circumstances, especially at the request of the individual, the
individualized plan for employment provides for off-site monitoring,
twice-monthly meetings with the individual. These services shall consist of any
particularized assessment supplementary to the comprehensive assessment of rehabilitation
needs described in subsection A of 22VAC30-20-100; the provision of skilled job
trainers who accompany the individual for intensive job skill training at the
worksite; job development and training; social skills training; regular
observation or supervision of the individual; follow-up services including
regular contact with the employers, the individuals, the parents, family
members, guardians, advocates or authorized representatives of the individuals,
and other suitable professional and informed advisors in order to reinforce and
stabilize the job placement; facilitation of natural supports at the worksite;
any other service identified in the scope of vocational rehabilitation services
for individuals described in 22VAC30-20-120; or any service similar to the
foregoing services. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(38)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(37))
"Personal assistance services" means a range of
services, including, among other things, training in managing, supervising,
and directing personal assistance services, provided by one or more persons
designed to assist an individual with a disability to perform daily living
activities on or off the job that the individual would typically perform
without assistance if the individual did not have a disability. The services
must be designed to increase the individual's control in life and ability to
perform everyday activities on or off the job. The services must be necessary
to the achievement of an employment outcome and may be provided only while the
individual is receiving other vocational rehabilitation services. The services
may include training in managing, supervising, and directing personal
assistance services. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(38))
"Physical and mental restoration services" means
corrective surgery or therapeutic treatment that is likely, within a reasonable
period of time, to correct or modify substantially a stable or slowly
progressive physical or mental impairment that constitutes a substantial
impediment to employment; diagnosis of and treatment for mental or emotional disorders
by qualified personnel in accordance with state licensure laws; dentistry;
nursing services; necessary hospitalization (either inpatient or outpatient
care) in connection with surgery or treatment and clinic services; drugs and
supplies; prosthetic, orthotic, or other assistive devices, including hearing
aids; eyeglasses and visual services, including visual training, and the
examination and services necessary for the prescription and provision of
eyeglasses, contact lenses, microscopic lenses, telescopic lenses, and other
special visual aids provided by the department in accordance with the
cooperative agreement established with the Department for the Blind and Vision
Impaired and prescribed by personnel that are qualified in accordance with
state licensure laws; podiatry; physical therapy; occupational therapy; speech
or hearing therapy; mental health services; treatment of either acute or
chronic medical complications and emergencies that are associated with or arise
out of the provision of physical and mental restoration services or that are
inherent in the condition under treatment; special services for the treatment
of individuals with end-stage renal disease, including transplantation,
dialysis, artificial kidneys, and supplies; and other medical or medically
related rehabilitation services.
"Physical or mental impairment" means any
physiological disorder or condition, cosmetic disfigurement, or anatomical loss
affecting one or more of the following body systems: neurological,
musculoskeletal, special sense organs, respiratory (including speech organs),
cardiovascular, reproductive, digestive, genitourinary, hemic, and lymphatic,
skin, and endocrine; or any mental or psychological disorders such as
intellectual disability, organic brain syndrome, emotional or mental illness,
and specific learning disabilities. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(41)) (34 CFR
361.5(c)(40))
"Post-employment services" means one or more of the
services identified in 22VAC30-20-120 that are provided subsequent to the
achievement of an employment outcome and that are necessary for an individual
to maintain, regain, or advance in employment consistent with the individual's unique
strengths, resources, priorities, concerns, abilities, capabilities, and
interests, and informed choice. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(42)) (34
CFR 361.5(c)(41))
"Pre-employment transition services" means the
required activities and authorized activities specified in 34 CFR
361.48(a)(2) and (3). (34 CFR 361.5(c)(42))
"Prevocational training" means individual and group
instruction or counseling, the controlled use of varied activities, and the
application of special behavior modification techniques. Individuals or
patients are helped to (i) develop physical and emotional tolerance for work
demands and pressures, (ii) acquire personal-social behaviors which would make
them acceptable employees and coworkers on the job, and (iii) develop the basic
manual, academic, and communication skills needed to acquire basic job skills.
"Qualified and impartial mediator" means an
individual who is not an employee of a public agency (other than an
administrative law judge, hearing examiner, employee of a state office of
mediators, or employee of an institution of higher education); is not a member
of the State Rehabilitation Council for the department; has not been involved
previously in the vocational rehabilitation of the applicant or eligible
individual recipient of services; is knowledgeable of the vocational
rehabilitation program and the applicable federal and state laws, regulations,
and policies governing the provision of vocational rehabilitation services; has
been trained in effective mediation techniques consistent with any state
approved or recognized certification, licensing, registration, or other
requirements; and has no personal, professional, or financial interest that
would be in conflict with the objectivity of the individual during the
mediation proceedings. An individual serving as a mediator is not considered to
be an employee of the department for the purposes of this definition solely
because the individual is paid by the department to serve as a mediator. (34
CFR 361.5(b)(43)) (34 CFR 361.5(c)(43))
"Rehabilitation technology" means the systematic
application of technologies, engineering methodologies, or scientific
principles to meet the needs of, and address the barriers confronted by,
individuals with disabilities in areas that include education, rehabilitation,
employment, transportation, independent living, and recreation. The term
includes rehabilitation engineering, assistive technology devices, and
assistive technology services. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(45))
"State" means the Commonwealth of Virginia.
"State plan" means the state plan for
vocational rehabilitation services portion of the unified or combined state
plan submitted under 34 CFR 361.10(c). (34 CFR 361.5(b)(51)) 34
CFR 361.10.
"State workforce investment development
board" means a state workforce investment development board as
established under § 111 of the Workforce Investment Act of 1998. (34 CFR
361.5(b)(49)) § 3 of the Workforce Innovation and Opportunity Act
(20 USC 3101 et seq.). (34 CFR 361.5(c)(49))
"Student with a disability" means an individual
with a disability in secondary, postsecondary, or other recognized education
program who (i) is not younger than the earliest age for the provision of
transition services under § 614(d)(1)(A)(i)(VIII) of IDEA, or if the state
elects to use a lower minimum age for the receipt of pre-employment transition
services under IDEA, is not younger than that minimum age; (ii) is not older
than the maximum age allowed by state law for receipt of services under IDEA;
and (iii) is eligible for and receiving special education or related services
under Part B of IDEA or is a student who is an individual with a disability for
purposes of § 504 of the Act. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(51))
"Substantial impediment to employment" means that a
physical or mental impairment (in light of attendant medical, psychological,
vocational, educational, and other related factors) hinders an individual from
preparing for, entering into, engaging in, advancing in, or retaining
employment consistent with the individual's abilities and capabilities. (34 CFR
361.5(c)(52))
"Supported employment" means (i) competitive integrated
employment in an integrated setting or employment in integrated work
settings in which individuals are working toward competitive employment,
including customized employment, that is individualized and customized,
consistent with the strengths, resources, priorities, concerns, abilities,
capabilities, unique strengths, abilities, interests, and informed
choice of the individuals with individual, including ongoing
support services for individuals with the most significant disabilities,
for whom competitive integrated employment has not traditionally historically
occurred or for whom competitive integrated employment has been
interrupted or intermittent as a result of a significant disability, and
who, because of the nature and severity of their the
individual's disabilities, need needs intensive supported
employment services from the department and extended services and
extended services after the transition from support by the
department, in order to perform this work or (ii) transitional employment
for individuals with the most significant disabilities due to mental illness.
(34 CFR 361.5(b)(53)). (34 CFR 361.5(c)(53))
"Supported employment services" means ongoing
support services, including customized employment, and other appropriate
services needed to support and maintain an individual with a most significant
disability, including a youth with a most significant disability, in
supported employment that are provided by the department (i) for a period of
time not to exceed 18 months, unless under special circumstances the eligible
individual and the rehabilitation counselor or coordinator jointly agree to
extend the time to achieve the employment outcome identified in the
individualized plan for employment and (ii) following transition as post-employment
services that are unavailable from an extended services provider and that are
necessary to maintain or regain the job placement or advance in employment. (34
CFR 361.5(b)(54)) (i) organized and made available, singly or in
combination, in such a way as to assist an eligible individual to achieve
competitive integrated employment; (ii) based on a determination of the needs
of an eligible individual, as specified in an individualized plan for
employment; (iii) provided by the department for a period of time not to exceed
24 months, unless under special circumstances the eligible individual and the
rehabilitation counselor jointly agree to extend the time to achieve the
employment outcome identified in the individualized plan for employment; and (iv)
following transition, as post-employment services that are unavailable from an
extended services provider and that are necessary to maintain or regain the job
placement or advance in employment. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(54))
"Transition services" means a coordinated set of
activities for a student or youth with a disability designed within
an outcome-oriented process that promotes movement from school to post-school
activities, including postsecondary education, vocational training, competitive
integrated employment (including supported employment), supported
employment, continuing and adult education, adult services, independent
living, or community participation. The coordinated set of activities must be
based upon the individual student's or youth's needs, taking into
account the student's or youth's preferences and interests, and must
include instruction, community experiences, the development of employment and
other post-school adult living objectives, and, if appropriate, acquisition of
daily living skills and functional vocational evaluation. Transition services
must promote or facilitate the achievement of the employment outcome identified
in the student's or youth's individualized plan for employment. (34
CFR 361.5(b)(55)) and include outreach to and engagement of the parents,
or as appropriate, the representative of such a student or youth with a
disability. (34 CFR 361.5(c)(55)
"Transitional employment," as used in the
definition of "supported employment," means a series of temporary job
placements in competitive work in integrated settings with ongoing support
services for individuals with the most significant disabilities due to mental
illness. In transitional employment, the provision of ongoing support services
must include continuing sequential job placements until job permanency is
achieved.
"Transportation" means travel and related expenses
that are necessary to enable an applicant or eligible individual to participate
in a vocational rehabilitation service, including expenses for training in the
use of public transportation vehicles and systems. (34 CFR 361.5(b)(57))
(34 CFR 361.5(c)(56))
"Vocational rehabilitation potential" mean means
the ability of the individual with a disability to benefit in terms of an
employment outcome from the provision of vocational rehabilitation services.
"Vocational rehabilitation services" means those
services listed in 22VAC30-20-120.
"WIOA" means the federal Workforce Innovation
and Opportunity Act (29 USC § 3101 et seq.).
"Youth with a disability" means an individual
with a disability who is not younger than 14 years of age and not older than 24
years of age.
22VAC30-20-20. Processing referrals and applications.
A. Referrals. The department must establish and implement
standards for the prompt and equitable handling of referrals of individuals for
vocational rehabilitation services, including referrals of individuals made
through a one-stop center. The standards must include timelines for making good
faith efforts to inform these individuals of application requirements and to
gather information necessary to initiate an assessment for determining
eligibility and priority for services. (34 CFR 361.41(a))
B. Applications.
1. Once an individual has submitted an application for
vocational rehabilitation services, including applications made through
common intake procedures in one-stop centers under § 121 of the Workforce
Innovation and Opportunity Act, an eligibility determination shall be made
within 60 days, unless (i) exceptional and unforeseen circumstances beyond the
control of the department preclude making a determination within 60 days and
the department and the individual agree to a specific extension of time;
or (ii) an exploration of the individual's abilities, capabilities, and
capacity to perform in work situations is carried out or, if appropriate, an
extended evaluation is necessary. (34 CFR 361.41(b)(1)) in accordance
with 34 CFR 361.42(e). (34 CFR 361.41(b))
2. An individual is considered to have submitted an
application when the individual or the individual's representative, as
appropriate (i) has completed and signed an agency application form, a common
intake application form in a one-stop center requesting vocational
rehabilitation services, or has otherwise requested services from the
department; (ii) has provided information to the department that is necessary
to initiate an assessment to determine eligibility and priority for services;
and (iii) is available to complete the assessment process. (34 CFR
361.41(b)(2))
3. The department shall ensure that its application forms are
widely available throughout the state, particularly in the one-stop centers.
(34 CFR 361.41(b)(3))
22VAC30-20-30. Assessment for determining eligibility and
priority for services.
In order to determine whether an individual is eligible for
vocational rehabilitation services and the individual's priority under an order
of selection for services (if the state is operating under an order of
selection), the department shall conduct an assessment for determining
eligibility and priority for services. The assessment shall be conducted in the
most integrated setting possible, consistent with the individual's needs and
informed choice, and in accordance with the following provisions: this
section.
1. Eligibility requirements are applied without regard to race,
age, gender, color, or national origin;:
a. Race;
b. Age;
c. Sex;
d. Color;
e. National origin;
f. Particular service needs;
g. Anticipated costs of services required by an applicant;
h. Income level of applicant of applicant's family;
i. Type of expected employment outcome;
j. Source of referral for vocational rehabilitation
services;
k. Employment history;
l. Current employment status;
m. Educational status; or
n. Current educational credential.
2. No applicant or group of applicants is excluded or found
ineligible solely on the basis of the type of disability; and
3. The eligibility requirements are applied without regard
to the particular service needs or anticipated cost of services required by an
applicant or the income level of an applicant or applicant's family, or the
type of expected employment outcome, or the source of referral for vocational
rehabilitation services; and, or the applicant's employment history or current
employment status, or the applicant's educational status or current educational
credential; and
4. 3. No duration of residence requirement is
imposed that excludes from services any individual who is present in the state.
(34 CFR 361.42(c))
22VAC30-20-40. Eligibility requirements determination.
A. Basic requirements. The department's determination of an
applicant's eligibility for vocational rehabilitation services shall be based
only on the following requirements: (i) a determination by qualified personnel
that the applicant has a physical or mental impairment; (ii) a determination by
qualified personnel that the applicant's physical or mental impairment
constitutes or results in a substantial impediment to employment for the
applicant; (iii) a presumption, in accordance with subsection B of this
section, that the applicant can benefit in terms of an employment outcome from
the provision of vocational rehabilitation services; and (iv) a determination
by a qualified vocational rehabilitation counselor employed by the department
that the applicant requires vocational rehabilitation services to prepare for,
secure, retain, advance in, or regain employment consistent with the
applicant's unique strengths, resources, priorities, concerns,
abilities, capabilities, interests, and informed choice.
B. Presumption of benefit. The department shall presume that
an applicant who meets the basic eligibility requirements in clauses (i) and
(ii) of subsection A of this section can benefit in terms of an employment
outcome unless the department demonstrates, based on clear and convincing
evidence, that the applicant is incapable of benefiting in terms of an
employment from vocational rehabilitation services due to the severity of the
applicant's disability.
C. Presumption of eligibility for Social Security
beneficiaries. The department shall assure that if an applicant has
appropriate evidence, such as an award letter, that establishes the applicant's
eligibility for Social Security benefits under Title II or Title XVI of the
Social Security Act, the department shall presume that the applicant (i) meets
the eligibility requirements in clauses (i) and (ii) of subsection A of this
section and (ii) is an individual with a significant disability as defined in
22VAC30-20-10.
1. The department shall presume that any applicant who
demonstrates proof of being determined eligible for Social Security benefits
under Title II or Title XVI of the Social Security Act (i) meets the basic
eligibility requirement in clauses (i) and (ii) of subsection A of this section
and (ii) is considered an individual with a significant disability as defined
in 22VAC30-20-10.
2. If an applicant for vocational rehabilitation services
asserts that he is eligible for Social Security benefits under Title II or
Title XVI of the Social Security Act (and, therefore, is presumed eligible for
vocational rehabilitation services) but is unable to provide appropriate
evidence, such as an award letter, to support this assertion, the department
must verify the applicant's eligibility under Title II or Title XVI of the
Social Security Act by contacting the Social Security Administration. This
verification must be made within a reasonable period of time to enable the
department to determine the applicant's eligibility for vocational
rehabilitation services within 60 days of the individual submitting an
application for services in accordance with 22VAC30-20-20.
D. Achievement of an employment outcome. Any eligible
individual, including an individual whose eligibility for vocational rehabilitation
services is based on the individual being eligible for Social Security benefits
under Title II or Title XVI of the Social Security Act, must intend to achieve
an employment outcome that is consistent with the individual's unique
strengths, resources, priorities, concerns, abilities, capabilities, interests,
and informed choice.
1. The department shall be responsible for informing
individuals, through its application process for vocational rehabilitation
services, that individuals who receive services under the program must intend
to achieve an employment outcome.
2. The applicant's completion of the application process for
vocational rehabilitation services shall be sufficient evidence of the
individual's intent to achieve an employment outcome, and no additional
demonstration on the part of the applicant is required for purposes of
satisfying this section.
E. Interpretation of entitlement. Nothing in this section
shall be construed to create an entitlement to any vocational rehabilitation service.
F. Review and assessment of data for eligibility
determination. Except as provided in 22VAC30-20-60 subsection G of
this section, the department shall base its determination of each of the
basic eligibility requirements in subsection A of this section on:
1. A review and assessment of existing data, including
counselor observations, education records, information provided by the
individual or the individual's family, information used by the Social
Security Administration particularly information used by education
officials, and determinations made by officials of other agencies; and
2. To the extent existing data do not describe the current
functioning of the individual or are unavailable, insufficient, or
inappropriate to make an eligibility determination, an assessment of additional
data resulting from the provision of vocational rehabilitation services,
including trial work experiences, assistive technology devices and
services, personal assistance services, and worksite assessments,
any other support services that are necessary to determine whether an
individual is eligible.
G. Trial work experience for individuals with significant
disabilities. Prior to any determination that an individual with a disability
is incapable of benefiting unable to benefit from vocational
rehabilitation services in terms of an employment outcome because of the
severity of that individual's disability, the department shall explore conduct
an exploration of the individual's abilities, capabilities, and capacity to
perform in a realistic work situation in accordance with 34 CFR 361.42 to
determine whether or not there is clear and convincing evidence to support such
a determination. The department shall develop a written plan to assess
periodically the individual's abilities, capabilities, and capacity to perform
in competitive integrated work situations through the use of trial work
experiences, which must be provided in competitive integrated employment
settings to the maximum extent possible, consistent with the informed choice
and rehabilitation needs of the individual. The plan for trial work shall include:
1. Trial work experiences which may include:
a. Supported employment,
b. On-the-job training, and
c. Other experiences using realistic integrated work
settings.
2. Appropriate supports to accommodate the needs of the
individual during the trial work experiences that include:
a. Assistive technology devices and services, and
b. Personal assistance services.
3. Trial work experiences of sufficient variety and over a
sufficient period of time for the department to determine there is:
a. Sufficient evidence to conclude that the individual can
benefit from the provision of vocational rehabilitation services in terms of an
employment outcome; or
b. Clear and convincing evidence that due to the severity
of the individual's disability, the individual is incapable of benefitting from
the provision of vocational rehabilitation services in terms of an employment
outcome.
22VAC30-20-60. Extended evaluation for individuals with
significant disabilities. (Repealed.)
A. Under limited circumstances, if an individual cannot
take advantage of trial work experiences or if options for trial work
experiences have been exhausted before the department is able to make an
eligibility determination for vocational rehabilitation services, the
department shall conduct an extended evaluation to make the determination that
(i) there is sufficient evidence to conclude that the individual can benefit
from the provision of vocational rehabilitation services in terms of an
employment outcome or (ii) there is clear and convincing evidence that the
individual is incapable of benefiting from vocational rehabilitation services
in terms of an employment outcome due to the severity of the individual's
disability.
B. During the extended evaluation period, which may not
exceed 18 months, vocational rehabilitation services shall be provided in the
most integrated setting possible, consistent with the informed choice and
rehabilitation needs of the individual.
C. During the extended evaluation period, the department
shall develop a written plan for providing services that are necessary to make
the determinations in subsection A of this section. The department may provide
during this period only those services that are necessary to make these two
determinations. (34 CFR 361.42)
D. The department shall assess the individual's progress
as frequently as necessary, but at least once every 90 days, during the
extended evaluation period.
E. The department shall terminate extended evaluation
services at any point during the 18-month extended evaluation period if the
department determines that (i) there is sufficient evidence to conclude that
the individual can benefit from vocational rehabilitation services in terms of
an employment outcome or (ii) there is clear and convincing evidence that the
individual is incapable of benefiting from vocational rehabilitation services
in terms of an employment outcome.
22VAC30-20-70. Certification of eligibility.
A. For vocational rehabilitation services, before or at
the same time the applicant is accepted for services, the department shall
certify that the applicant has met the basic eligibility requirements as
specified in 22VAC30-20-40.
B. For extended evaluation, as a basis for providing an
extended evaluation to determine vocational rehabilitation potential, there
shall be certification that the applicant has met the requirements as specified
in 22VAC30-20-60.
Before developing an individualized plan for employment as
specified in 22VAC30-20-110, the department shall certify that the applicant
has met the basic eligibility requirements as specified in subsection A of
22VAC30-20-40.
22VAC30-20-80. Procedures for ineligibility determination.
A. Certification of ineligibility. If the department
determines that an applicant is ineligible for vocational rehabilitation
services or determines that an individual receiving services under an
individualized plan for employment is no longer eligible for services, the
department shall:
1. Make the determination only after providing an opportunity
for full consultation with the individual or, as appropriate, with the
individual's representative;
2. Inform the individual in writing, supplemented as necessary
by other appropriate modes of communication consistent with the informed choice
of the individual, of the ineligibility determination, including the reasons
for that determination, the requirements under this section and the means by
which the individual may express and seek remedy for any dissatisfaction,
including the procedures for review of a department personnel determination in
accordance with 22VAC30-20-181;
3. Provide the individual with a description of services
available under the Client Assistance Program and information on how to contact
that program;
4. Refer the individual (i) to other training or
employment-related programs that are part of the one-stop centers service
delivery system that can address the individual's training or employment
related needs or, (ii) if the ineligibility determination is
based on a finding that the individual is incapable of achieving or has
chosen not to pursue an employment outcome as defined in 22VAC30-20-10, to local
extended employment providers; and federal, state, or local programs or
service providers, including as appropriate, independent living programs and
extended employment providers, best suited to meet the individual's
rehabilitation needs; and
5. Review within 12 months and annually thereafter if
requested by the individual or, if appropriate, by the individual's
representative, any ineligibility determination that is based on a finding that
the individual is incapable of achieving an employment outcome. The review need
not be conducted in situations in which the individual has refused it, the
individual is no longer present in the state Virginia, the
individual's whereabouts are unknown, or the individual's medical condition is
rapidly progressive or terminal.
B. Case closure without eligibility determination. The
department shall not close an applicant's record of services prior to making an
eligibility determination unless the applicant declines to participate in, or
is unavailable to complete, an assessment for determining eligibility and
priority for services, and the department has made a reasonable number of
attempts to contact the applicant or, if appropriate, the applicant's
representative to encourage the applicant's participation.
22VAC30-20-95. Information and referral services.
A. The department shall implement an information and referral
system adequate to ensure that individuals with disabilities, including
eligible individuals who do not meet the department's order of selection
criteria for receiving vocational rehabilitation services if the department is
operating under an order of selection, are provided accurate vocational
rehabilitation information and guidance (which may include counseling and
referral for job placement) using appropriate modes of communication to assist
them in preparing for, securing, retaining, or regaining employment.
B. The department shall refer individuals with disabilities
to other appropriate federal and state programs, including other components of
the statewide workforce investment system. In making these referrals, the
department shall:
1. Refer the individuals to federal or state programs,
including programs carried out by other components of the statewide workforce investment
development system, best suited to address the specific rehabilitation,
independent living and employment needs of an individual with a disability who
makes an informed choice not to pursue an employment outcome under the
vocational rehabilitation program; and
2. Inform the individual that services under the vocational
rehabilitation program can be provided to eligible individuals in extended
employment if necessary for purposes of training or otherwise preparing for
employment in an integrated setting;
3. Inform the individual that if he initially chooses not
to pursue an employment outcome, he can seek services from the department at a
later date if, at that time, he chooses to pursue an employment outcome;
4. Refer the individual, as appropriate, to the
Social Security Administration in order to obtain information concerning the
ability of individuals with disabilities to work while receiving benefits from
the Social Security Administration; and
5. Provide the individual who is being referred (i) a
notice of the referral by the department to the agency carrying out the
program; (ii) information identifying a specific point of contact within the
agency to which the individual is being referred; and (iii) information and
advice regarding the most suitable services to assist the individual to prepare
for, secure, retain, or regain employment.
22VAC30-20-100. The individualized plan for employment
procedures.
A. General requirements.
1. An individualized plan for employment meeting the
requirements of this section shall be developed and implemented in a timely
manner for For each individual determined to be eligible for
vocational rehabilitation services or, if the department is operating under an
order of selection in accordance with 22VAC30-20-90, for each eligible
individual to whom the department is able to provide services. Services
shall be provided in accordance with the provisions of the individualized plan for
employment., an individualized plan for employment meeting the
requirements of this section shall be developed and implemented in a timely
manner, not to exceed 90 days after the individuals eligibility determination
date. This 90-day deadline for developing the individualized plan for
employment may be extended if the department and the eligible individual agree
to an extension of the deadline to a specific date by which the plan shall be
developed.
2. The individualized plan for employment must be designed
to achieve a specific employment outcome as defined in 22VAC30-20-10.
3. The department shall conduct an assessment for
determining vocational rehabilitation needs, if appropriate, for each eligible
individual, or if the department is operating under an order of selection, the
department shall conduct an assessment for each eligible individual to whom the
department is able to provide services. The purpose of this assessment is to
determine the employment outcome and the nature and scope of vocational
rehabilitation services to be included in the individualized plan for
employment.
a. To the extent possible, the employment outcome and the
nature and scope of rehabilitation services to be included in the
individualized plan for employment shall be determined based on data from
assessment of eligibility and priority of services under 22VAC30-20-30.
b. If additional data are necessary to determine the
employment outcome and the nature and scope of services, the department shall
conduct a comprehensive assessment of the unique strengths, resources,
priorities, concerns, abilities, capabilities, interests, and informed choice,
including the need for supported employment services, of the eligible
individual, in the most integrated setting possible. In preparing the
comprehensive assessment, the department shall use, to the maximum extent
possible and appropriate and in accordance with confidentiality requirements,
existing information that is current as of the date of the development of the
individualized plan for employment. This includes information (i) available
from other programs and providers, particularly information used by the
education system and the Social Security Administration; (ii) provided by the
individual and the individual's family; and (iii) obtained under the assessment
for determining the individual's eligibility and vocational needs.
3. 4. The individualized plan for employment
shall be a written document prepared on forms provided by the department.
4. 5. Vocational rehabilitation services shall
be provided in accordance with the provisions of the individualized plan for
employment. An eligible individual or, as appropriate, the individual's
representative may develop all or part of the individualized plan for
employment with or without assistance from the department or other entity. The
individualized plan for employment shall be approved and signed by the
qualified vocational rehabilitation counselor employed by the department and
the individual or, as appropriate, the individual's representative. The
department shall establish and implement standards for the prompt development
of individualized plans for employment for the individuals identified in
subdivision 1 of this subsection, including timelines that take into
consideration the needs of the individual.
5. 6. The department shall promptly provide each
individual or, as appropriate, the individual's representative a written copy
of the individualized plan for employment and its amendments in the native
language or appropriate mode of communication of the individual or, as
appropriate, the individual's representative.
6. 7. The department shall advise in writing
each individual or, as appropriate, the individual's representative of all
department procedures and requirements affecting the development and review of
an individualized plan for employment, including the availability of
appropriate modes of communication.
7. 8. The individualized plan for employment for
a student with a disability who is receiving special education services
must be coordinated with the developed in consideration of the
student's individualized education program for that individual in terms
of goals, objectives, and services identified in the individualized education
program. or services under § 504 of the Act, as applicable, and the
plans, policies, and procedures and terms of interagency agreement with the
state agency and education officials designed to facilitate the transition of
students with disabilities from the receipt of educational services to the
receipt of vocational rehabilitation services.
9. The department shall provide individuals entitled to
benefits under Title II or Title XVI of the Social Security Act information on
additional supports and assistance for individuals with disabilities desiring
to enter the workforce, including benefits planning.
B. Individualized plan for employment review. The department
shall review the plan with the individual or, as appropriate, the individual's
representative as often as necessary, but at least once each year to assess the
individual's progress in achieving the identified employment outcome. The plan
may be amended as necessary if there are substantive changes in the employment
outcome, the vocational rehabilitation services to be provided, or the
providers of the vocational rehabilitation services. Amendments to the plan do
not take effect until agreed to and signed by the individual or, as
appropriate, the individual's representative and by a qualified vocational
rehabilitation counselor employed by the department.
22VAC30-20-110. Individualized plan for employment content.
A. Regardless of the option in 22VAC30-20-100 chosen by the
eligible individual for developing the individualized plan for employment, each
plan for employment shall include the following:
1. A description of the employment outcome, as defined in
22VAC30-20-10, that is chosen by the eligible individual and is consistent with
the individual's unique strengths, resources, priorities, concerns, abilities,
capabilities, career interests, and informed choice of the individual, and
results in employment in an integrated setting; that is consistent with
the general goal of competitive integrated employment;
2. A description of the vocational rehabilitation services
provided under 22VAC30-20-120 that are needed to achieve the employment
outcome, (i) including, as appropriate, the provision of assistive
technology devices and services and personal assistance services, including
training in the management of those services, and providing in the most
integrated setting that is appropriate for the services involved and is
consistent with the informed choice of the eligible individual; (ii) in
the case of an eligible student or youth with a disability, the specific
transition and support services needed to achieve the employment outcome or
projected post-school employment outcome;
3. A provision for services to be provided in the most
integrated setting that is appropriated for the services involved and
consistent with the informed choice of the eligible individual;
3. 4. Timelines for the achievement of the
employment outcome and for the initiation of services;
4. 5. A description of the entity or entities
chosen by the eligible individual or, as appropriate, the individual's
representative that will provide the vocational rehabilitation services and the
methods used to procure those services;
5. 6. A description of the criteria that will be
used to evaluate progress toward achievement of the employment outcome;
6. 7. The terms and conditions of the
individualized plan for employment, including, as appropriate, information
describing (i) the responsibilities of the department, (ii) the
responsibilities the eligible individual shall assume in relation to achieving
the employment outcome, (iii) the extent of the eligible individual's
participation in paying for the cost of services, (iv) the
responsibility of the individual with regard to applying for and securing
comparable services and benefits as described in 22VAC30-20-170, and (v)
the responsibilities of other entities as the result of arrangements made
pursuant to the comparable services or benefits requirements in
22VAC30-20-170;
7. 8. A statement of the rights of the
individual under this chapter and the means by which the individual may express
and seek remedy for any dissatisfaction, including the opportunity for a review
of determinations made by department personnel;
8. 9. A statement of the availability of the
Client Assistance Program;
9. 10. The basis on which the individual has
been determined to have achieved an employment outcome;
10. 11. A statement concerning the expected need
for post-employment services prior to closing the record of services of an
individual who has achieved an employment outcome;
11. 12. A description of the terms and
conditions for the provision of any post-employment services; and
12. 13. If appropriate, a statement of how
post-employment services shall be provided or arranged through other entities
as the result of arrangements made pursuant to the comparable benefits and
services requirement.
B. Supported employment. In addition to the requirements in
subsection A of this section, the individualized plan for employment for an
individual with a most significant disability for whom supported employment has
been determined appropriate shall also:
1. Specify the supported employment services to be provided by
the department;
2. Specify the expected extended services needed, which may
include natural supports;
3. Identify the source of extended services or, to the extent
that it is not possible to identify the source of extended services at the time
the individualized plan for employment is developed, include a description of
the basis for concluding that there is a reasonable expectation that those
sources will become available;
4. Provide for periodic monitoring to ensure that the
individual is making satisfactory progress toward meeting the weekly work
requirement established in the individualized plan for employment by the time
of transition to extended services;
5. Provide for the coordination of services provided under an
individualized plan for employment with services provided under other
individualized plans established under other federal or state programs;
6. To the extent that job skills training is provided,
identify that the training shall be provided on site; and
7. Include placement in an integrated setting for the maximum
number of hours possible based on the unique strengths, resources, priorities,
concerns, abilities, capabilities, interests, and informed choice of
individuals with the most significant disabilities.
C. Student with a disability. In addition to the
requirements in subsection A of this section, the individualized plan for
employment for a student with a disability shall be coordinated with the
individualized education program or services under § 504 of the Act, as
applicable for that individual, in terms of the goals, objectives, and services
identified in the education program.
22VAC30-20-120. Scope of vocational rehabilitation services for
individuals.
A. Pre-employment transition services. The department, in
collaboration with the local education agencies involved, shall provide or
arrange for the provision of pre-employment transition services for all
students with disabilities as defined in 22VAC30-20-10 who are in need of such
services regardless of whether the student has applied or been determined
eligible for vocational rehabilitation service.
1. The department shall provide the following required
pre-employment transition services:
a. Job exploration counseling;
b. Work-based learning experiences, which may include
in-school or after school opportunities, or experience outside the traditional
school setting (including internships), provided in an integrated environment
to the maximum extent possible;
c. Counseling on opportunities for enrollment in
comprehensive transition or postsecondary educational programs at institutions
of higher education;
d. Workplace readiness training to develop social skills
and independent living; and
e. Instruction in self-advocacy (including instruction in person-centered
planning), which may include peer mentoring (including peer mentoring from
individuals with disabilities working in competitive integrated employment).
2. The department may provide the following authorized
pre-employment transition services if funds are available and remaining after
the provision of the required activities described in subdivision 1 of this
subsection:
a. Implement effective strategies to increase the
likelihood of independent living and inclusion in communities and competitive
integrated workplaces;
b. Develop and improve strategies for individuals with
intellectual disabilities and individuals with significant disabilities to (i)
live independently, (ii) participate in postsecondary education experiences,
and (iii) obtain, advance in, and retain competitive integrated employment;
c. Provide instruction to vocational rehabilitation
counselors, school transition personnel, and other persons supporting students
with disabilities;
d. Disseminate information about innovative, effective, and
efficient approached to achieve the goals of this subsection;
e. Coordinate activities with transition services provided
by local education agencies under the IDEA;
f. Apply evidence-based findings to improve policy,
procedure, practice, and the preparation of personnel in order to better
achieve the goals of this section;
g. Develop model transition demonstration projects;
h. Establish or support multistate or regional partnerships
involving states, local educational agencies, designated state units,
developmental disability agencies, private businesses, or other participants to
achieve the goals of this section; and
i. Disseminate information and strategies to improve the
transition to postsecondary activities of individuals who are members of
traditionally unserved and underserved populations.
3. Each local office of the department shall carry out the
responsibilities of:
a. Attending individualized education program meetings for
students with disabilities when invited;
b. Working with the local workforce development boards,
one-stop centers, and employers to develop work opportunities for students with
disabilities, including internships, summer employment, other employment
opportunities available throughout the school year, and apprenticeships;
c. Working with schools, including those carrying out
activities under § 614(d) of IDEA, to coordinate and ensure the provision of
pre-employment transition services under this section; and
d. When invited, attending person-centered planning
meetings for individuals receiving services under Title XIX of the Social
Security Act.
B. Services for individuals who have applied for or been
determined eligible for vocational rehabilitation services. As appropriate
to the vocational rehabilitation needs of each individual and consistent with
each individual's informed choice individualized plan for employment,
the department shall ensure that the following vocational rehabilitation
services are available to assist the individual with a disability in preparing
for, securing, retaining, advancing in, or regaining an employment
outcome that is consistent with the individual's strengths, resources,
priorities, concerns, abilities, capabilities, interests, and informed choice:
1. Assessment for determining eligibility and priority for
services and assessment for determining vocational rehabilitation needs by
qualified personnel including, if appropriate, an assessment by personnel
skilled in rehabilitation technology in accordance with 22VAC30-20-10.
2. Vocational rehabilitation counseling and guidance,
including information and support services to assist an individual in
exercising informed choice.
3. Referral and other services necessary to assist applicants
and eligible individuals to secure needed services from other agencies,
including other components of the statewide workforce investment development
system and to advise those individuals about the Client Assistance Program.
4. Physical and mental restoration services, in accordance
with the definition of in 22VAC30-20-10, to the extent that
financial support is not readily available from a source other than the
department (such as through health insurance or comparable services and
benefits as defined in 22VAC30-20-10).
a. Eligibility requirements.
(1) Stable or slowly progressive. The physical or mental
condition shall be stable or slowly progressive. The condition shall not be
acute or transitory, or of such recent origin that the resulting functional
limitations and the extent to which the limitations affect occupational
performance cannot be identified.
(2) Refusal of service. When an individual has a physical or
mental disability with resulting limitations that constitute a barrier to
employment, and when in the opinion of licensed medical personnel these
limitations can be removed by physical or mental restoration services without
injury to the individual, the individual shall not be eligible for any
rehabilitation services, except counseling, guidance and placement if he
refuses to accept the appropriate physical or mental restoration services. A
second opinion may be provided at the individual's request. In the event of
conflicting medical opinions, the department shall secure a third opinion and
the decision shall be made on the two concurring opinions.
b. Provision of physical and mental restoration services.
These services shall be provided only when:
(1) Recommended by a licensed practitioner;
(2) Services are not available from another source; and
(3) They are provided in conjunction with counseling and
guidance, and other services, as deemed appropriate.
The department shall not make case expenditures for acute or
intermediate medical care except for medical complications and emergencies that
are associated with or arise out of the provision of vocational rehabilitation
services under an individualized plan for employment and that are inherent in
the condition under treatment.
c. Services not sponsored by the department. The department,
in consultation with appropriate medical resources, shall determine those
restoration services that shall be provided by the department. The following
procedures shall not be provided:
(1) Experimental procedures;
(2) High risk procedures;
(3) Procedures with limited vocational outcomes or procedures
not related to the vocational outcome; and
(4) Procedures with uncertain outcomes.
5. Vocational and other training services, including personal
and vocational adjustment training, advanced training in, but not limited
to, a field of science, technology engineering, mathematics (including computer
science), medicine, law, or business; books, tools, and other training
materials, except that no training or training services in institutions of
higher education (universities, colleges, community or junior colleges,
vocational schools, technical institutes, or hospital schools of nursing)
nursing, or any other postsecondary education institution) may be
paid for with funds under this section unless maximum efforts have been made by
the department and the individual to secure grant assistance in whole or in
part from other sources to pay for that training.
All training services provided shall be related to attainment
of the vocational objective or provide for the determination of eligibility for
vocational rehabilitation services. Vocational training includes any organized
form of instruction that provides the knowledge and skills essential for
performing the tasks involved in an occupation. Vocational training may be obtained
in institutions such as colleges, universities, business schools, nursing
schools, and trade and technical schools. It may also be obtained by on-the-job
training, apprenticeship programs, tutorial training, or correspondence study.
a. Approved training institutions. Only training institutions
approved in accordance with the department's vendor approval process shall be
used.
b. College and university academic training.
(1) Academic requirements. The individual shall take
sufficient academic credit hours based on the requirement of the college
attended for classification as a full-time student, unless this is, in the
opinion of the department, contraindicated by the individual's disability.
Courses shall meet the institution's requirement towards toward
the obtainment of the degree or certificate. Continuation of financial
assistance by the department shall be dependent upon the individual maintaining
the grade average required by the institution for the particular course of
study. When the institution has no grade requirement, continuation of financial
assistance by the department shall be dependent upon the individual maintaining
a "C" average calculated over the academic year. When the individual
fails to maintain the required academic grade average, assistance may be
discontinued. The department's assistance may be reinstated when the individual
completes one semester or quarter with the minimum required grade average.
Each individual shall be advised that failure to provide
grades to the department shall be grounds for termination of departmental
financial assistance.
(2) Graduate degree program. The department shall assist
eligible individuals in securing a graduate degree only when it is judged
essential to achieving an employment goal agreed to by the department and the
individual.
(3) Virginia colleges and universities. Vocational training,
including college or university training, shall be provided by the department
in department-approved institutions located within the boundaries of the
Commonwealth, unless such training is not available within the Commonwealth.
Institutions in the areas of Washington, D.C.; Bristol-Johnson City-Kingsport,
Tennessee; the city of Bluefield, West Virginia; and other cities where the
services may be provided more effectively and economically and shall be treated
as if located in Virginia.
(4) Tuition and mandatory fees. The department may pay tuition
for college and university training in an amount not in excess of the highest
amount charged for tuition by a state-supported institution or the rate
published in the catalog, whichever is less, except where out-of-state or
private college is necessary. Published tuition costs in excess of the highest
amount charged by a state-supported institution may be necessary and may be
paid by the department if no state-supported institution is available that
offers the degree program needed to achieve the established employment goal, if
no state-supported program offers disability-related supports to enable the
individual to achieve the established employment goal, or if an out-of-state or
private program is more economical for the department.
(5) Scholarships and grants. Training services in
institutions of higher education shall be paid for with departmental funds only
after maximum efforts have been made by the individual to secure assistance in
whole or in part from other sources; however, any individual eligible for
vocational rehabilitation training services but not meeting the financial need
test of the department may be provided an assistance grant annually in an
amount not to exceed the equivalent of one quarter's tuition of a full-time
community college student.
c. Correspondence study. The correspondence study training may
be authorized only when:
(1) The individual requires specific preliminary training in
order to enter a training program or training cannot be arranged by any other
method; and
(2) Satisfactory progress is maintained.
d. On-the-job training. The department may enter into
agreements with employers in the private or public sector to provide on-the-job
training services. The terms and conditions of each individual agreement shall
be established by the department.
e. Part-time training. Part-time training may be utilized only
when the severity of the individual's disability shall not allow the individual
to pursue training on a full-time basis. Part-time training shall be authorized
only at department-approved facilities and schools.
f. Work adjustment training. Work adjustment training may be
provided if needed for the individual to engage in subsequent vocational
rehabilitation services as indicated by the thorough diagnostic study
assessment of medical, vocational, psychological, and other factors. This
service may be provided only by the department or approved vendors.
g. Prevocational training. Prevocational training may be
provided if needed for the individual to engage in subsequent vocational
rehabilitation services as indicated by the thorough diagnostic study
assessment of medical, vocational, psychological, and other factors. This
service may be provided only by the department or approved vendors.
h. Tutorial training. Tutorial training may be provided if
needed for the individual to achieve a vocational goal as indicated by the
thorough diagnostic study assessment of medical, vocational, psychological, and
other factors. This service may be provided only by the department or approved
vendors.
i. Other higher education training concerns.
(1) Required textbooks and supplies. The maximum amount of
departmental financial assistance for required textbooks and supplies (pencils,
paper, etc.) shall not exceed the amount determined by the institution for
books and supplies in the student's school budget.
(2) Required training materials. Training materials may be
provided when required by the instructor.
6. Maintenance in accordance with the definition of that term
in 22VAC30-20-10.
a. Clothes. Clothes shall be provided when specifically
required for participation in a training program or for placement in a
specialized job area as determined by the department.
b. Room, board, and utilities. The maximum rate paid for room,
board, and utilities shall be established annually by the department.
(1) Training cases. The maximum amount of departmental
financial assistance for room and board at a training institution (college,
vocational school, rehabilitation center facility), when the institution is
able to provide room and board, shall not exceed the published room and board
rates charged by the institution, or the actual cost, whichever is less.
(2) While living at home. Maintenance shall be provided for an
individual living at home only when the individual's income supports the family
unit of the individual, when it is more cost effective for the department, or
when it is in the best interest of the individual's vocational rehabilitation
program based on mutual agreement of the rehabilitation counselor and the
individual.
7. Transportation in connection with the rendering of any
vocational rehabilitation service and in accordance with the definition of that
term in 22VAC30-20-10. Transportation may include relocation and moving
expenses necessary for achieving a vocational rehabilitation objective.
a. Transportation costs. The department shall pay the most
economical rate for accessible public transportation. When public
transportation is not available, or the individual, because of disability,
cannot travel by public transportation, transportation may be provided at a
rate established by the department.
b. For and during training services. When the individual must
live at the training location, the department may only pay for a one-way trip
from the residence to the training location at the beginning of the training
and a one-way trip from the training location to the residence or job site at
the conclusion of the training program. Transportation may be paid to and from
the residence in case of emergency (severe illness or death in family;,
acute business emergency, or prolonged school closing such as Christmas
holidays). Local bus fare also may be provided. When the individual's physical
condition is such that travel by public conveyance is impossible, taxi fare may
be allowed from place of residence to training site and return. When the
individual lives at home and the training site requires daily transportation,
the cost of such transportation may be paid.
8. Vocational rehabilitation services to family members of an
applicant or eligible individual if necessary to enable the applicant or
eligible individual to achieve an employment outcome. Services to family
members of the individual may be provided when such services may be expected to
contribute substantially to the determination of vocational rehabilitation
potential or to the rehabilitation of the individual. In order for the
department to furnish these services, they shall not be available from any
other source.
a. Family member is defined in 22VAC30-20-10.
b. Day care services for dependent children. The department
may pay up to the amount paid per child, per day, by the local social services
department in the locality in which the child is located. When more than one
child is involved, rates for the additional children may be lower. When satisfactory
accommodations can be secured at a rate lower than that paid by the local
social services department, the lower rate shall be paid by the department.
9. Interpreter services, including sign language and oral
interpreter services for individuals who are deaf or hard of hearing; tactile
interpreting services for individuals who are deaf-blind provided by
qualified personnel; and reader services, rehabilitation teaching services,
and orientation and mobility services for individuals who are blind.
a. Upon request of the individual or as needed, these services
may be provided at any stage during the rehabilitation process. Interpreting
may be primarily in the form of sign language (manual method) or oral
interpretation (oral method).
b. The department shall pay for interpreting services when
these services contribute to the individual's vocational rehabilitation
program.
c. The interpreter shall hold at least one of the credentials
approved by the Virginia Department for the Deaf and Hard-of-Hearing pursuant
to § 51.5-113 of the Code of Virginia.
d. When individuals with deafness are in a training program,
the department shall arrange for note taking or reader services, unless the
individual indicates such service is not needed or desired.
10. Rehabilitation technology, in accordance with the
definition of that term in 22VAC30-20-10, including vehicular modification,
telecommunications, sensory, and other technological aids and devices.
a. Telecommunications system. Services related to use of a telecommunications
system shall meet established federal or state health and safety standards and
be consistent with written state policies.
b. Sensory and other technological aids and devices. The
department may provide electronic or mechanical pieces of equipment or hardware
intended to improve or substitute for one or more of the human senses, or for
impaired mobility, or motor coordination.
Services related to use of sensory and other technological
aids and devices shall meet established federal or state health and safety
standards and be consistent with state law and regulations.
(1) An otological evaluation may be required, and an
audiological examination shall be required before the department may purchase a
hearing aid.
(2) The department shall purchase hearing aids only for those
individuals identified as benefiting in terms of employability as a direct
result of such aid.
11. Technical assistance and other consultation services to
conduct market analyses, develop business plans, and otherwise provide
resources, to the extent those resources are authorized to be provided through
the statewide workforce investment development system, to
eligible individuals who are pursuing self-employment or telecommuting or
establishing a small business operation as an employment outcome.
12. Job related services, including job search and
placement assistance and, job retention services, follow-up
services, and follow-along services. Placement shall be in accordance with the
mutually agreed upon vocational objective and is the responsibility of both the
individual and the department.
13. Post-employment services, in accordance with the
definition of that term in 22VAC30-20-10.
a. Selection criteria. All individuals whose vocational
rehabilitation cases have been closed as achieving an employment outcome may be
considered for post-employment services. The department may evaluate with each
individual the need for such services.
b. All of the following criteria shall be met for an
individual to receive post-employment services:
(1) The individual shall have been determined to have achieved
an employment outcome;
(2) The disabling medical condition shall be stable or slowly
progressive;
(3) Post-employment services shall be necessary to assist the
individual in maintaining employment; and
(4) The problem interfering with the individual maintaining
employment does not require a complex or comprehensive rehabilitation effort,
that is, a new and distinct disabling condition has not occurred that requires
a new application.
If needed services exceed any of the conditions in
subdivisions 13 b (1) through 13 b (4) of this section subsection,
the department may take a new application.
14. Supported employment services, as defined in
22VAC30-20-10.
a. An individual with a most significant disability,
including a youth with a most significant disability, shall be eligible for
supported employment services if he meets all of the following criteria:
(1) Has not worked, or has worked only intermittently, in
competitive employment;
(2) Has been determined on the basis of any evaluation of
rehabilitation and career needs, including a consideration of whether supported
employment is a possible vocational outcome, to meet the eligibility criteria
established in 22VAC30-20-40; and
(3) Has a need for ongoing support services in order to
perform competitive work.
(1) Competitive integrated employment has not historically
occurred; or
(2) Competitive integrated employment has been interrupted
or intermittent as a result of a significant disability; and
(3) The nature and severity of the disability results in
the need for intensive supported employment services and extended services
after the transition from support provided by the department in order to
perform the work.
b. The following activities shall be authorized under the
supported employment program:
(1) Evaluation of rehabilitation and career needs of
individuals with the most significant disabilities in terms of a supported
employment outcome;
(2) Development of and placement in jobs for individuals with
the most significant disabilities; and
(3) Provision of time-limited services needed to support
individuals with the most significant disabilities in employment, including:
(a) Intensive on-the-job skills training provided by skilled
job trainers, coworkers, and other qualified individuals;
(b) Ongoing support services needed to support and maintain an
individual's supported employment placement that shall include, at a minimum,
twice monthly monitoring to assess the individual's employment stability;
(c) Extended services designed to reinforce and stabilize the
job placement; and
(d) Customized employment as appropriate; and
(e) Discrete post-employment services unavailable from
the extended services provider that are necessary to maintain or regain
the job placement or advance in employment, including but not limited
to job station redesign, repair and maintenance of assistive technology,
and replacement of prosthetic and orthotic devices.
c. Transitional employment services for individuals with
chronic mental illness may be provided under the supported employment program.
Transitional employment means a series of temporary job placements in
competitive work in an integrated work setting with ongoing support services.
Ongoing support services shall include continuing sequential job placements
until job permanency is achieved.
d. c. The department shall provide for the
transition of an individual with the most significant disabilities to extended
services no later than 18 24 months after placement in supported
employment, unless a longer period to achieve job stabilization has been
established in the individualized plan for employment before an individual with
a most significant disability makes the transition to extended services as
defined in 22VAC30-20-10. is needed to achieve the employment outcome in
the individualized plan for employment and the eligible individual and the
department jointly agree to extend the time.
d. The department may provide extended services as defined
in 22VAC30-20-10 to a youth with the most significant disability for a period
of time not to exceed four years, or until such time that a youth reaches the
age of 25 years and no longer meets the definition of youth with a disability
under 22VAC30-20-10.
15. Occupational licenses,
tools, equipment, initial stocks (including livestock), and supplies.
a. Licenses. Licenses required for entrance into selected
vocations may be provided. These may be occupational or business licenses as
required by the local governing body, state board examinations required by the
Department of Professional and Occupational Regulation, and motor vehicle
operator's license.
b. Tools and equipment. Tools and equipment shall be provided
for an individual when:
(1) They are required for a job or occupation that is best
suited to the utilization of the individual's abilities and skills;
(2) The employer does not ordinarily furnish these articles;
and
(3) They are for the exclusive use of the individual.
Such articles shall be for the individual's own use in the
performance of his work and must remain in his possession and under his control
as long as he engages in the job or occupation for which they are provided.
If the individual alleges that tools and equipment are stolen,
the individual shall file a stolen property report with the local police.
Computer equipment and software shall be provided if required
as indicated in subdivisions 15 b (1), 15 b (2), and 15 b (3) of this section
subsection, or if it is necessary for vocational training.
c. Title retention and release. The department shall comply
with state laws and regulations on the retention of title and release of title
of equipment to individuals.
d. Repossession of tools and equipment. The department shall
repossess all occupational tools and equipment to which the department retains
title when they are no longer being used for the purposes intended by the
individual for whom they were purchased.
16. Transition services, in accordance with the definition
of that term in 22VAC30-20-10. for students and youth with disabilities
that facilitate the transition from school to postsecondary life, such as
achievement of an employment outcome in competitive integrated employment or
pre-employment transition services for students.
17. Personal assistance services, in accordance with the
definition of that term in 22VAC30-20-10.
18. Other goods and services determined necessary for the
individual with a disability to achieve an employment outcome. These include,
but are not limited to, such services as peer counseling, independent
living skills training, attendant care, and attendant training. The department
shall not purchase or participate in the purchase of automotive vehicles.
19. Customized employment in accordance with the definition
of that term in 22VAC30-20-10.
19. 20. Services to groups. The department may
provide vocational rehabilitation services to groups of individuals with
disabilities when the services may contribute substantially to the needs of the
group; although the services are not related directly to the individualized
employment plan of any one person with a disability.
22VAC30-20-130. Individuals determined to have achieved an
employment outcome.
An individual is determined to have achieved an employment
outcome and the record of service may be closed only if all of the
following requirements are met:
1. The provision of services under the individual's
individualized plan for employment has contributed to the achievement of an
employment outcome;
2. The employment outcome is consistent with the employment
outcome described in the individualized plan for employment and with the
individual's unique strengths, resources, priorities, concerns,
abilities, capabilities, interests, and informed choice;
3. The employment outcome is in an a competitive
integrated setting;
4. The individual has maintained the employment outcome for a
period of at least 90 days; and
5. At the end of the applicable period under this section, the
individual and the rehabilitation counselor or coordinator consider the
employment outcome to be satisfactory and agree that the individual is
performing well on the job; and
6. The individual is informed through the appropriate modes
of communication of the availability of post-employment services.
22VAC30-20-150. Written standards for facilities and providers
of services.
The department shall establish, maintain, make available to
the public, and implement written minimum standards for the various types of
facilities and providers of services used by the department in providing
vocational rehabilitation services, in accordance with the following
requirements:
1. Accessibility of facilities. Any facility in which
vocational rehabilitation services are provided must be accessible to
individuals receiving services and must comply with the requirements of the
Architectural Barriers Act of 1968, the Americans with Disabilities Act of
1990, and § 504 of the Act, as amended, and regulations implementing these
laws.
2. Personnel standards.
a. Qualified personnel. Providers of vocational rehabilitation
services shall use qualified personnel, in accordance with any applicable
national or state approved or recognized certification, licensing, or
registration requirements or, in the absence of these requirements, other
comparable requirements (including state personnel requirements) that apply to
the profession or discipline in which that category of personnel is providing
vocational rehabilitation services.
b. Affirmative action. Providers of vocational rehabilitation
services shall take affirmative action to employ and advance in employment
qualified individuals with disabilities covered under and on the same terms
and conditions as in § 503 of the Act.
c. Special communication needs personnel. Providers of
vocational rehabilitation services shall include among their personnel, or
obtain the services of, individuals able to communicate in the native languages
of applicants and eligible individuals who have limited English speaking
ability; and ensure that appropriate modes of communication for all
applicants and eligible individuals are used.
3. Fraud, waste, and abuse. Providers of vocational
rehabilitation services shall have adequate and appropriate policies and
procedures to prevent fraud, waste, and abuse.
22VAC30-20-170. Availability of comparable services and
benefits.
A. Prior to providing any vocational rehabilitation services
to an eligible individual or to members of the individual's family, except
those services listed in subsection D of this section, the department shall
determine whether comparable services and benefits as defined in 22VAC30-20-10
exist under any other program and whether those services and benefits are
available to the individual.
B. If comparable services or benefits exist under any other
program and are available to the eligible individual at the time needed to
achieve the rehabilitation objectives in the individual's individualized plan
for employment, the department shall use those comparable services or benefits
to meet, in whole or in part, the cost of vocational rehabilitation services.
C. If comparable services or benefits exist under any other
program but are not available to the individual at the time needed to ensure
the progress of the individual toward achieving the employment outcome in the
individual's individualized plan for employment, the department shall provide
vocational rehabilitation services until those comparable services and benefits
become available.
D. The following services shall be exempt from a
determination of the availability of comparable services and benefits under
subsection A of this section: assessment for determining eligibility and
priority for services; assessment for determining vocational rehabilitation
needs; vocational rehabilitation counseling, guidance, and referral services;
job-related services, including job search and placement services; job
retention services; follow-up services; rehabilitation technology; and
post-employment services consisting of those services listed in this
subsection.
E. The requirements of subsection A of this section also
shall not apply if the determination of the availability of comparable services
and benefits under any other program would interrupt or delay (i) the
progress of the individual toward achieving the employment outcome identified
in the individualized plan for employment; (ii) an immediate job placement; or
(iii) the provision of vocational rehabilitation services to any individual
who is determined to be at extreme medical risk based on medical evidence
provided by an appropriate qualified medical professional; or an immediate
job placement would be lost due to a delay in the provision of comparable
services and benefits.
22VAC30-20-181. Review of determinations made by the
department.
A. An applicant, an eligible individual, a
recipient of services, or, if appropriate, an individual's
representative who is dissatisfied with any determination made by department
personnel that affects the provision of vocational rehabilitation services may
request a timely review of the determination.
B. Informal dispute resolution.
1. A request for review shall be made within 60 days after the
determination. The applicant, eligible individual, or, if appropriate, the
individual's representative may request a meeting with the supervisor of the
staff member who made the determination and request an informal administrative
review conducted by the supervisor. Recipients of services who are not
receiving vocational rehabilitation services may be offered access to the
informal dispute resolution process at the discretion of the supervisor.
2. Within 10 working days of the request, the supervisor shall
send a written decision and grounds to the applicant or eligible individual,
with a copy to the individual's representative, if applicable, and it shall
become part of the case record.
3. The informal dispute resolution process shall not be used
to deny or delay the right to proceed directly to a hearing conducted and
concluded within the time period established under subdivision D 1 of this
section.
C. Mediation.
1. The department shall provide a mediation process conducted by
a qualified and impartial mediator as defined in 22VAC30-20-10, who shall be
selected from a list of qualified and impartial mediators maintained by the
department. Mediation shall be requested within 60 days after a determination
or informal administrative review decision. The department shall include in the
mediation process the guardian of an applicant or, eligible
individual, or recipient of services who has been judged incompetent.
Participation in the mediation process is voluntary on the part of the
applicant or eligible individual and on the part of the department. Mediation
may be requested while a hearing is pending but shall not be used to deny or
delay the applicant or eligible individual's right to a hearing conducted and
concluded within the time period established under subdivision D 1 of this
section.
2. The mediator shall schedule and conduct the mediation
sessions in a timely manner and in a location convenient to the parties in
dispute. The mediator shall afford both parties an opportunity to be
represented by counsel or other advocate and to submit evidence or other
information. Discussions that occur during mediation remain confidential and
shall not be used as evidence in any subsequent hearing or civil proceeding,
and parties shall be required to sign a confidentiality pledge prior to
mediation. Either party or the mediator may terminate mediation at any time,
and the applicant, eligible individual, or the department may seek resolution
through a hearing.
3. Any agreement reached by the parties in a mediation shall
be described in a written mediation agreement. Both parties to the dispute
shall have an opportunity to review the agreement with their representative,
supervisor, or legal advisor before signing it. An agreement signed by both
parties shall become part of the case record, with a copy given to the
applicant or eligible individual and any representative.
4. The cost of the mediation process shall be paid by the
department, but the department is not required to pay for any costs related to
the representation of an applicant or eligible individual.
D. Due Impartial due process hearing.
1. The applicant, eligible individual, recipient of
services, or, if appropriate, individual's representative may request a
hearing within 60 days after the determination to be reviewed, meeting or
informal administrative review decision under subsection B of this section, or
mediation refusal or mediation termination date. Department personnel may
request a hearing within 60 days after termination of the mediation process
under subsection C of this section.
a. The hearing shall be scheduled and conducted by a qualified
and impartial hearing officer as defined and selected according to subdivision
2 of this subsection.
b. The hearing officer shall conduct the hearing within 60
days of the department receiving an individual's request, unless informal
resolution is achieved before the 60th day, or the parties agree to a specific
extension of time, or the hearing officer grants a postponement request for
good cause that would result in a fair representation of the issues.
c. The hearing officer shall provide both parties to the
dispute an opportunity to present evidence, information, and witnesses; to be
represented by counsel or other appropriate advocate; and to examine all
witnesses, information, and evidence. All testimony shall be given under oath.
Hearsay testimony and redundant evidence may be admitted at the discretion of
the hearing officer. Because the hearing officer cannot issue subpoenas, the
department shall be responsible for the appearance of current department
personnel on the witness list of either party.
d. Within 30 days after the hearing, the hearing officer shall
issue a written decision with a full report of the findings and grounds for the
decision to the applicant, eligible individual, individual's representative,
and the department. The decision shall be based on the provisions of the
approved state plan, the Act, federal vocational rehabilitation regulations,
and state regulations and policies that are consistent with federal
requirements. The hearing officer's decision shall be final, except that a
party may request an impartial administrative review if the state has
established procedures for review, and a party may bring a civil action under
subsection G of this section.
2. The hearing officer for a particular case shall be selected
randomly by the department from among the pool of persons qualified to be an
impartial hearing officer, as defined in 34 CFR 361.5(b)(22) and 29 USC §
722(b) and (d), who are identified jointly by the commissioner and those
members of the State Rehabilitation Council designated in § 102(d)(2)(C)
of the Act (29 USC § 722(b) and (d)).
E. Administrative review of hearing officer decision.
1. If the state has established procedures for an
administrative review, the request and statutory, regulatory, or policy grounds
for the request shall be made in writing to the department within 20 days of
the hearing decision date mailing of the impartial hearing officer's
decision. The review shall be a paper review of the entire hearing record
and shall be conducted by a designee of the Governor's office who shall not
delegate the review to any personnel of the department.
2. The reviewing official shall provide both parties an
opportunity to submit additional written evidence and information relevant to
the final decision concerning the matter under review. The reviewing official
may not overturn or modify the hearing officer's decision, or any part of that
decision, that supports the position of the applicant or eligible individual, unless
the reviewing official concludes, based on clear and convincing evidence, that
the hearing officer's decision is clearly erroneous on the basis of being
contrary to the approved state plan, the Act, federal vocational rehabilitation
regulations, and state regulations and policies that are consistent with
federal requirements.
3. Within 30 days after the request, the reviewing official
shall issue an independent decision and full report of the findings and the
statutory, regulatory, or policy grounds for the decision to the applicant,
eligible individual, individual's representative, and department. The decision
of the reviewing official is final and shall be implemented pending review by
the court if either party chooses under subsection G of this section to bring a
civil action regarding the matter in dispute.
F. Informing affected individuals. The department shall
inform, through appropriate modes of communication, all applicants and eligible
individuals of their right to request a review of a determination made by
department personnel that affects provision of vocational rehabilitation
services, including the names and addresses of individuals with whom mediation
and hearing requests may be filed and how the mediator and hearing officer
shall be selected; their right to proceed directly to a hearing; their right to
an informal administrative review; their right to pursue mediation; and their
right to contact the Client Assistance Program to assist during mediation and
hearing processes. Notification shall be provided in writing at the time of
application for vocational rehabilitation services; assignment to a priority
category if the department is operating under an order of selection;
individualized plan for employment development; and reduction, suspension, or
termination of services.
G. Civil action. Any party who disagrees with the findings or
decision of an impartial hearing officer under subsection D of this section or
an administrative review under subsection E of this section shall have the right
to bring a civil action with respect to the matter in dispute. The action may
be brought in any state court of competent jurisdiction or in a district court
of the United States of competent jurisdiction without regard to the amount in
controversy. In any action brought under this subsection, the court receives
the records related to the impartial due process hearing and the records
related to the administrative review, if applicable; hears additional evidence
at the request of a party; and basing its decision on the preponderance of the
evidence, grants the relief that the court determines to be appropriate.
22VAC30-20-190. Protection, use, and release of personal
information.
A. Purpose. The purpose is to establish policies and
procedures to protect current and stored personal information and for
the proper dissemination of this information in accordance with the
statutes of the Code of Virginia, Virginia Freedom of Information Act, and
Virginia Privacy Protection Act, and the Workforce Innovation and Opportunity
Act. Hereafter clients Clients shall be referred to as data
subjects in this section.
B. Application. This applies to all employees of the
department, consultants, affiliates and volunteers.
C. Policies. The department shall:
1. Comply with state statutes when releasing any information
regarding data subjects by:
a. Disclosing information or records to the data subject who
is 18 years old, except:
(1) If data subject has been legally declared as incompetent
then the right to access information has been granted to the individual or
committee which has been appointed as guardian, authorized agent or
agents, or representative or representatives.
(2) When the treating physician has written on a mental or
medical record: "In my opinion a review of such records by the data
subject would be injurious to the data subject's physical or mental health or
well being." This does not preclude access to that report by authorized
agents or representatives. The treating physician is the only professional who,
by statute, has the authority to label and deny access to a mental record by
the data subject. Access to other information is not restricted.
b. Disclosing information or records only to the parent or
guardian for the data subject who is under 18 years old.;
2. Follow procedures which ensure that all records and other
personal, identifying data are treated as confidential information, meaning
that other than regular access authority and the exceptions which are permitted
by code and statutes, no expressed personal or documented information shall be
released to a third party without the written, informed consent of the data
subject or his authorized agent or by court order;
3. Obtain and document only that information which is
necessary to plan and deliver rehabilitation services;
4. Maintain and post the department's access list which
designates staff positions of those who have the privilege of reviewing and
checking out records;
5. Assign to all individuals as defined in subsection B of
this section and acknowledge written requests for information which are
identified and occur after a data subject's application for services;
6. Charge for copies of information unless the request is from
those who need information to assist data subject in the rehabilitation
program. The rate shall be $.15 per page or the actual cost, whichever is less;
and
7. Keep records in offices unless in accordance with a court
order, statute, or by special authorization from the department representative.
D. Procedures for disclosing information.
1. Handling disclosures.
a. Each request to disclose information shall be handled
during normal business hours.
b. Each written request shall be responded to within 14
working days.
c. Before an employee releases information to a person or
organization other than those identified on the access list, written, informed
consent must be given by data subject or the authorized agent.
When there is need to release information regarding data
subjects, informed consent forms should be initiated through the data subject's
counselor. Forms are completed prior to releasing information and filed in data
subject's record.
d. Any employee who releases information after informed
consent is obtained must document data subject's record with employee's name,
date, the purpose for giving specific information, and to whom information was
given. These statements are also documented when the record has been reviewed
by or copied for the data subject.
2. Accessing information for specific situations.
a. A data subject's request to review personal record.
(1) When a data subject requests a review of their his
case records, the individual should be referred to their counselor, or in his
absence, the counselor's supervisor. This employee is responsible for
confirming the data subject's age, and competency status to access information
in his own behalf.
(2) For those data subjects who are under younger
than age 18 years or who have been declared incompetent, the
department shall explain right to access and assist data subject by
coordinating the desired review with parent or authorized agent.
(3) For data subjects who have the right to access
information, the department should obtain the case record and review contents
to learn if there are any mental records which a treating physician has
identified as not to be reviewed. These are the only reports which can and must
be removed before access.
(4) The department gives data subject their case record and is
available throughout the review to interpret reports or to assist the data
subject, who may wish to seek additional information regarding contents. The
data subject may choose to review their case record without interpretation.
b. Access by parents, guardians, or authorized agents.
(1) When a data subject is a minor or has been legally
declared as incompetent, the parent, guardian, or authorized agent, is expected
to furnish personal identification and sign a statement regarding their
relationship to data subject.
(2) When a data subject is 18 years or older and there is a
parent who wants to review information or accompany data subject to a data
subject oriented meeting, the data subject shall sign an "Authorization
for Release of Information," form prior to disclosure.
c. Access by "significant others" (other family
members or friends).
(1) When a data subject is a minor or has been legally
declared as incompetent, the parent, guardian, or authorized agent, shall give
written, informed consent prior to disclosure.
(2) When a data subject is 18 years or older, he shall give
written, informed consent prior to disclosure.
d. Access by third parties.
(1) Unless required by law, or this the
department, no disclosure shall be made to third parties without written,
informed consent from the data subject or the legally authorized agent. Upon
disclosure, third parties shall be advised to maintain confidentiality with no
redisclosure of information.
(2) The following information is either required by law or
permitted by mission of the agency and shall be disclosed without the data
subject's authorization:
(a) Within the department, employees shall be given
information which is relevant to case management or research requirements.
(b) The department's medical consultants may release
information to another physician for consultation or hospitalization purposes.
(c) For emergencies:
(1) (i) Telephone and face-to-face disclosure
may be made to any person for an emergency when it is reasonable to believe
that a delay shall result in serious bodily injury, death or deterioration of
the physical or mental condition of data subject. Examples: (i) an emergency
admission or commitment to a hospital; (ii) an inquiry from an acute care
hospital, data is limited to answers for specific information from the data
subject's case record; and (iii) an inquiry by law-enforcement officials
regarding an emergency situation. Information is limited to that which is
necessary to deal with the emergency.
(2) (ii) When it becomes necessary to release
information in these circumstances, the responsible department party shall
enter the following in the data subject's case record: (i) the date the
information was released; (ii) the person to whom information was released;
(iii) the reason the information was released; (iv) the reason written,
informed consent could not be obtained; and (v) the specific information which
was released.
(d) For court orders and subpoena, all requests for
information by court orders shall be processed by the data subject's counselor
unless there is some question about the need for legal advice. In those
situations, the department representative shall decide if contact needs to be
made with the department representative in the Attorney General's office prior
to compliance. This contact shall be made by the commissioner's designee.
(e) The Virginia Department of Social Services shall be given,
upon request, information about the location, income, and property of data
subjects who have abandoned, deserted, or failed to support children and their
caretakers who are receiving public assistance. No other information may be
released.
(f) The Virginia Department of Health shall be given access to
medical records in the course of an investigation, research, or studies of diseases
or deaths which are of public health importance.
(g) The Virginia Department of Health may be provided with
abstracts of records of data subjects having malignant tumors or cancers. Such
abstracts may include the name, address, sex, race, and any other medical
information required by law.
(h) Information may be released as requested for a formal
investigation to the Virginia Department of Health, State Medical Examiner.
e. Access by special interest third parties.
(1) Release of information shall include a written, informed
consent.
(2) Except for public events, no data other than directory
information shall be released to the news media without the written, informed
consent of the data subject or the authorized agent.
(3) No information shall be released to law-enforcement
officers without the written, informed consent of the data subject or the
authorized agent, or without judicial order.
(4) Audio tapes, video tapes, computerized data or other media
reproduction are considered as confidential records and shall be treated like
written material.
E. Procedure for changing a record.
1. Revoking an authorization of consent.
a. If anyone, such as an attorney, has a data subject sign an
authorization which rescinds all prior authorizations, this negates all
previous authorizations. The department shall make this a part of the case
record.
b. When the revocation clause appears in the record, the
department no longer has the authority to disseminate additional information
other than to those on the regulation department access list.
c. If the data subject is currently a client, their counselor
shall record any authorization which includes a revocation clause. This means
that all routines for forwarding reports to those not on department's access
list shall be stopped.
d. The rehabilitation counselor shall notify the Wilson
Workforce and Rehabilitation Center (WWRC) counselor or sponsor of
the situation and inform the data subject of the restriction.
e. The department shall acknowledge and comply with the
attorney's request for information. A separate letter shall also advise the
attorney that this clause denies access of information to persons or
organizations which are responsible for continuing rehabilitation services. The
department shall advise the attorney of the need to be provided with an
additional statement which reinstates communication and correspondence.
2. Reinstating consent. When a satisfactory reinstatement
statement and new consent is received from the attorney and the data subject,
the department shall file the additional authorization and inform appropriate
department counterparts about the new release.
3. Challenging and correcting a record by the data subject or
agent.
a. The data subject or agent has a right to contest the
accuracy or completeness of any personal record, except access to challenging
or correcting a treating physician's mental record which has been identified as
not to be reviewed by the data subject.
b. Data subjects who are currently clients shall be instructed
by their counselor that any request to correct, amend, or delete information is
to be done in writing, giving specific reasons why information is being
contested.
c. The counselor shall submit this statement to their immediate
supervisor.
d. The Supervisor shall interview staff, as necessary,
examine pertinent records, and submit a written recommendation to their
regional or center director. This recommendation is to include a statement and
rationale to either uphold or to change existing records.
e. When the regional or center director determines that
information which is being disputed is, in fact, incomplete, inaccurate, not
pertinent, untimely, or unnecessary to be retained, that individual shall
instruct the original writer to amend the report in question. If the originator
is no longer an employee, the regional or center director or a designee shall
prepare the amended report. A copy of the amended report shall be sent to the
local office for the client's file.
f. The department shall disseminate the amended version of the
report to any previous recipients and as part of the record for all further
requests for information.
g. The department shall notify the data subject in writing of
the decision. A copy of that notice is to be filed in data subject's local
office file.
h. If the investigation does not change the record or resolve
the dispute, the data subject may file a statement stating what he believes to
be an accurate or complete version of that information. This statement becomes
a permanent part of the record. The department shall forward a copy to all
previous recipients who have access to the information being disputed.
F. Procedures of safeguarding records.
1. Maintaining security of records.
a. Data subject records are the property of the department and
are entrusted to personnel who safeguard records from loss, defacement, or use
by unauthorized persons.
b. No record is to be defaced by marking, underlining, or
entering notations by anyone other than the originator of any document.
c. When a record is requested, either by court or a directive
from the commissioner, a certified copy of the record shall be provided by the
counselor.
d. Whoever removes records has the responsibility to assure
confidentiality of content while it is out. It must never be left unattended in
areas which are accessible to unauthorized individuals.
e. Confidentiality shall be maintained in work areas where casework
documents are being prepared, filed, or distributed.
2. Violating confidentiality. Individuals who violate security
standards or the confidentiality code by releasing information without
obtaining or following procedures may be subject to their name being removed
from the access list and to discipline under the standards of conduct.
G. Department's access list. The following have been approved
to have access to the case records of clients served by the department:
1. Administrative and supervisory staff engaged in dutiful
performance of their job which requires access to individual client files;
2. Service delivery personnel including, but not limited
to, rehabilitation counselors, vocational evaluators, or psychiatrists; and
3. Clerical personnel as appropriate.
22VAC30-20-195. Youth with disabilities seeking subminimum
wage employment.
A. Prior to youth with disabilities starting subminimum
wage employment, the department shall provide youth with disabilities
documentation upon completion of the following actions:
1. Appropriate pre-employment transition services available
to a student with a disability under subsection A of 22VAC30-20-120 or
transition services under IDEA.
2. Application for vocational rehabilitation services in
accordance with subsection B of 22VAC30-20-20 with the result that the
individual was determined:
a. Ineligible for vocational rehabilitation services in
accordance with 22VAC30-20-80; or
b. Eligible for vocational rehabilitation services in
accordance with 22VAC30-20-40 and (i) has an approved individualized plan for
employment in accordance with 22VAC30-20-110; (ii) was unable to achieve the
employment outcome specified in the individualized plan for employment despite
working toward the employment outcome with reasonable accommodations and
appropriate supports for a reasonable period of time; and (iii) the case record
of service with vocational rehabilitation for the youth with a disability has
been closed.
3. Receipt of career counseling and information and
referral from the department to state, federal, and other resources in the
individual's geographic area that offer employment related services and
supports designed to enable the individual to explore and obtain competitive
integrated employment. The career counseling and information and referral
services shall:
a. Be provided in a manner that facilitates informed choice
and decision making by the youth or the youth's representative as appropriate;
b. Not be for subminimum wage employment and did not
directly result in employment compensated at a subminimum wage; and
c. Be provided within 30 calendar days of closure of the
vocational rehabilitation case record of service.
B. The department, in consultation with the state
education agency, shall implement a process that includes the following steps
to document the completion of the actions described in this section:
1. The appropriate school official responsible for the
provision of transition services shall provide the department documentation of
completion of appropriate transition services under IDEA and under 34 CFR
397.30; and
2. The department shall provide documentation of completion
of transition services and documentation of completed appropriate
pre-employment transition services to the youth with a disability.
C. The documentation, which is provided to the youth with
a disability, shall be in a form and manner that is accessible for the youth
and shall contain the following:
1. Youth's name;
2. Determination made, including a summary of the reasons
for the determination, or description of the service or activity completed;
3. Name of the individual making the determination or the
provider of the required activity;
4. Date of the determination made or required service or
activity completed;
5. Signature and date of signature of the department or
educational personnel making the determination or documenting completion of the
required service;
6. Signature of the department personnel transmitting the
documentation to the youth with a disability;
7. Date and method (e.g., hand-delivered, faxed, mailed,
emailed, etc.) by which the documentation was transmitted to the youth; and
8. A coversheet that itemizes the contents of the documents
that have been provided to the youth.
D. The department shall provide to the youth documentation
of completion of each action required in subsection A of this section (i)
within 45 calendar days after the completion the action or (ii) within 90
calendar days if additional time is necessary due to extenuating circumstances.
E. In the event that a youth with a disability or, as
applicable, the youth's parent or guardian refuses through informed choice to
participate in any action required by this section, the department shall
provide the youth within 10 calendar days of the refusal documentation that
contains:
1. Youth's name;
2. A description and reason for the refusal;
3. Signature of the youth or, as applicable, the youth's
parent or guardian;
4. Signature and date of signature of the department or
educational personnel documenting the youth's refusal; and
5. Date and method (e.g., hand-delivered, faxed, mailed,
emailed, etc.) by which documentation was transmitted to the youth.
22VAC30-20-200. Review of extended employment and other
employment under special certificate provisions of the Fair Labor Standards
Act.
A. For the first two years after an individual's
record of services is closed (and thereafter if requested by the individual
or, if appropriate, the individual's representative), the department shall annually
semiannually review and reevaluate the status of each individual (i)
determined by the department to have achieved an employment outcome in which
the individual is compensated in accordance with § 14(c) of the Fair Labor
Standards Act or; (ii) whose record of services is closed while
the individual is in extended employment on the basis that the individual is
unable to achieve an employment outcome consistent with 22VAC30-20-10;
or the individual (iii) who made an informed choice to remain in
extended employment. After the first two years, the reviews shall be
conducted annually. The annual review and reevaluation shall include
input from the individual or, if appropriate, the individual's representative
to determine the interests, priorities, and needs of the individual with
respect to competitive integrated employment.
B. The department shall make maximum effort, including the
identification of vocational rehabilitation services, reasonable
accommodations, and other support services, to enable the eligible individual
to engage in competitive integrated employment.
C. The department shall obtain the signed acknowledgment of
the individual, or, as appropriate, the individual's representative,
that the annual review and reevaluations have been conducted.
22VAC30-20-210. Agency responsibilities to individuals with
disabilities during subminimum wage employment.
A. The department shall provide individuals with
disabilities, regardless of age, who are known to the department to be employed
at subminimum wage the following:
1. Counseling and information services that (i) are
provided in a manner understandable to the individual with a disability, (ii)
facilitate the independent decision making and informed choice as the
individual makes decisions regarding opportunities for competitive integrated
employment, particularly with respect to supported employment and customized
employment, and (iii) may include benefits counseling, particularly with regard
to the impact of earned income on income-based financial, medical, and other
benefits.
2. For individuals with a disability, information about (i)
self-advocacy, (ii) self-determination, and (iii) peer mentoring training
opportunities available in the community within 30 calendar days of being
referred by an employer, or contractor or subcontractor of that employer, that
holds special wage certificate described in § 14(c) of the federal Fair Labor
Standards Act and has fewer than 15 employees.
B. Required intervals.
1. For individuals hired at subminimum wage on or after
July 22, 2016, the services required by this section must be carried
out once every six months for the first year of the individual's
subminimum wage employment and annually thereafter for the duration of such
employment.
2. For individuals already employed at subminimum wage
prior to July 22, 2016, the services required by this section must be carried
out once by July 22, 2016, and annually thereafter for the duration of such
employment.
3. With regard to intervals required by subdivisions 1 and
2 of this subsection, the department's responsibility to provide the services
in this section to those in subminimum wage shall be (i) calculated on the date
of the closure for those with closed vocational rehabilitation case records of
services or (ii) calculated based upon the date the individual becomes known to
the department for those individuals without closed case records.
4. An individual with a disability becomes
"known" to the department through self-identification, referral by a
third party, through the individual's involvement with the vocational
rehabilitation process, or any other method.
C. Documentation.
1. The department shall provide documentation to the
individual (i) within 45 calendar days after completion of the activities
required under subsection B of this section or (ii) within 90 calendar days if
additional time is necessary due to extenuating circumstances, after completion
of the actions required in subsection B of this section.
2. Documentation shall include the following:
a. Name of the individual;
b. Description of the service or activity completed;
c. Name of the provider of the required activity;
d. Date required service or activity was completed;
e. Signature and date of signature of individual
documenting completion of the required service or activity;
f. Signature of department personnel (if different from
subdivision 2 e of this subsection); and
g. Date and method (e.g., hand-delivered, faxed, mailed,
emailed, etc.) by which the document was transmitted to the individual with a
disability.
3. In the event an individual with a disability or, as
applicable, the individual's representative refuses through informed choice, to
participate in the activities required by this section, documentation shall
contain:
a. Name of the individual;
b. Description of the refusal and reason for the refusal;
c. Signature of the individual with a disability or, as
applicable, the individual's representative;
d. Signature and date of signature of department personnel
documenting the individual's refusal; and
e. Date and method (e.g., hand-delivered, faxed, mailed,
emailed, etc.) by which the document was transmitted to the individual with a
disability.
4. The department shall retain a copy of all documentation
required by this section consistent with the department's case management
system.
D. The department may contract with other public or
private services providers, as appropriate, to fulfill the requirements of this
section. However, the contractor providing the services on behalf of the
department shall not be an entity holding a special wage certificate under § 14(c)
of the federal Fair Labor Standards Act.
VA.R. Doc. No. R19-5227; Filed August 8, 2018, 1:58 p.m.